167208ac9482e4d8648cd22dfbaf03d42a4ac36b
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
45 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.75"
49 .set version "4.77"
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54
55 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
56 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
57 . provided in the xfpt library.
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59
60 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
61
62 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
63
64 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
65 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
66
67 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
68 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
69
70 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
71 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
72 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
73 . --- index entry.
74
75 .macro option
76 .arg 5
77 .oindex "&%$5%&"
78 .endarg
79 .arg -5
80 .oindex "&%$1%&"
81 .endarg
82 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
83 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
84 .endtable
85 .endmacro
86
87 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
88 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
89 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
90
91 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
92 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
93 .endmacro
94
95 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
96 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
97 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
98
99 .macro irow
100 .arg 4
101 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
102 .endarg
103 .arg -4
104 .arg 3
105 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
106 .endarg
107 .arg -3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
109 .endarg
110 .endarg
111 .endmacro
112
113 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
114 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
115 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
116 . --- ID that ties them together.
117
118 .macro cindex
119 &<indexterm role="concept">&
120 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
121 .arg 2
122 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
123 .endarg
124 &</indexterm>&
125 .endmacro
126
127 .macro scindex
128 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
129 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
130 .arg 3
131 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
132 .endarg
133 &</indexterm>&
134 .endmacro
135
136 .macro ecindex
137 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
138 .endmacro
139
140 .macro oindex
141 &<indexterm role="option">&
142 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
143 .arg 2
144 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
145 .endarg
146 &</indexterm>&
147 .endmacro
148
149 .macro vindex
150 &<indexterm role="variable">&
151 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
152 .arg 2
153 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
154 .endarg
155 &</indexterm>&
156 .endmacro
157
158 .macro index
159 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
160 .endmacro
161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
162
163
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
166 . output formats.
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168
169 .literal xml
170 <bookinfo>
171 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
172 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
173 <date>06 May 2011</date>
174 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
175 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
176 <revhistory><revision>
177 <revnumber>4.77</revnumber>
178 <date>10 Oct 2011</date>
179 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
180 </revision></revhistory>
181 <copyright><year>2011</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
182 </bookinfo>
183 .literal off
184
185
186 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
187 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
188 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
189 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
191
192 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
193 .literal xml
194
195 <indexterm role="variable">
196 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
197 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
198 </indexterm>
199 <indexterm role="concept">
200 <primary>address</primary>
201 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
202 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
203 </indexterm>
204 <indexterm role="concept">
205 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
206 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
207 </indexterm>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
211 </indexterm>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>CR character</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
215 </indexterm>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CRL</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
219 </indexterm>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>delivery</primary>
222 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
223 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
224 </indexterm>
225 <indexterm role="concept">
226 <primary>dialup</primary>
227 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
228 </indexterm>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>exiscan</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
232 </indexterm>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>failover</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
236 </indexterm>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>fallover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
240 </indexterm>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>filter</primary>
243 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
244 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
245 </indexterm>
246 <indexterm role="concept">
247 <primary>ident</primary>
248 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
249 </indexterm>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>LF character</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
253 </indexterm>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>maximum</primary>
256 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
257 </indexterm>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>monitor</primary>
260 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
261 </indexterm>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
264 <see>entry for xxx</see>
265 </indexterm>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>NUL</primary>
268 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
269 </indexterm>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>passwd file</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
273 </indexterm>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>process id</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
277 </indexterm>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>RBL</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
281 </indexterm>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>redirection</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
285 </indexterm>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>return path</primary>
288 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
289 </indexterm>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>scanning</primary>
292 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
293 </indexterm>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>SSL</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
297 </indexterm>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>string</primary>
300 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
301 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
302 </indexterm>
303 <indexterm role="concept">
304 <primary>top bit</primary>
305 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
306 </indexterm>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>variables</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
310 </indexterm>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
314 </indexterm>
315
316 .literal off
317
318
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
320 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
321 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
322 . chapter "Introduction"
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
324
325 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
326 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
327 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
328 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
329
330 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
331 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
332 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
333 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
334 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
335 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
336 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
337
338 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
339 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
340 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
341
342 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
343 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
344 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
345
346 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
347 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
348 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
349 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
350 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
351
352 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
353 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
354 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
355 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
356 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
357
358 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
359 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
360 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
361 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
362 contributors.
363
364
365 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
366 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
367
368 .new
369 .cindex "documentation"
370 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
371 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
372 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
373 capable of showing a change indicator.
374 .wen
375
376 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
377 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
378 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
379 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
380 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
381 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
382 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
383 very wide interest.
384
385 .cindex "books about Exim"
386 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
387 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
388 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
389 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
390
391 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
392 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
393 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
394 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
395
396 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
397 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
398 Debian-specific features in the file
399 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
400 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
401 information.
402
403 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
404 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
405 .cindex "change log"
406 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
407 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
408 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
409 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
410 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
411
412 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
413 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
414 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
415 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
416
417 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
418 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
419
420 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
421 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
422 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
423 directory are:
424
425 .table2 100pt
426 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
427 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
428 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
429 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
430 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
431 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
432 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
433 .endtable
434
435 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
436 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
437 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438
439
440
441 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
442 .cindex "web site"
443 .cindex "FTP site"
444 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
445 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
446 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
447 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
448 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
449 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
450
451 .cindex "wiki"
452 .cindex "FAQ"
453 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
454 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
455 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
456 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
457 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
458
459 .cindex Bugzilla
460 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
461 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
462 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
463
464
465
466 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
467 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
468 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
469
470 .table2 140pt
471 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
475 .endtable
476
477 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
478 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
479 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
480 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
481 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
482 via this web page:
483 .display
484 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
485 .endd
486 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
487 lists.
488
489 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
490 .cindex "training courses"
491 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
492 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
493 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
494 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
495
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "FTP site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510 .display
511 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
512 .endd
513 This is mirrored by
514 .display
515 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
516 .endd
517 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
518 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
519 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520
521 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
522 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
523 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
524 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
525 .display
526 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
528 .endd
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
532
533 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
534 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
535 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
536 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
537 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
538 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
539 in:
540 .display
541 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
543 .endd
544 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
545 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
546 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
547
548 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
549 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
550 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
551 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
552 .display
553 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
554 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557 .endd
558 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
559 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
560
561
562 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
563 .ilist
564 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
565 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
566 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
567 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
568 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
569 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
570 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
571 .next
572 .cindex "domainless addresses"
573 .cindex "address" "without domain"
574 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
575 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
576 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
577 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
578 arrival.
579 .next
580 .cindex "transport" "external"
581 .cindex "external transports"
582 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
583 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
584 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
585 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
586 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
587 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
588 .next
589 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
590 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
591 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
592 other means.
593 .next
594 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
595 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
596 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
597 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
598 a number of common scanners are provided.
599 .endlist
600
601
602 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
603 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
604 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
605 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
606 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
607 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
608
609
610 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
612 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
613 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
614 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
615 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
616 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
617 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
618 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
619 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
620 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
621 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
622
623 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
624 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
625 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
626 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
627
628
629
630 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
631 .cindex "terminology definitions"
632 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
633 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
634 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
635 below) by a blank line.
636
637 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
638 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
639 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
640 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
641 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
642 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
643 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
644 rise to further bounce messages.
645
646 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
647 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
648 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
649 otherwise.
650
651 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
652 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
653 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
654 until a later time.
655
656 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
657 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
658 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
659
660 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
661 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
662 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
663 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
664 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
665 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
666 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
667 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
668
669 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
670 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
671 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
672 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
673 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
674 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
675 line.
676
677 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
678 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
679 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
680 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
681 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
682
683 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
684 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
685 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
686 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
687 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
688 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
689
690 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
691 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
692 message's envelope.
693
694 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
695 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
696 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
697 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
698 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
699
700 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
701 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
702 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
703 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
704 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
705
706 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
707 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
708 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
709 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
710 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
711 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
712
713
714
715
716
717
718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
720
721 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
722 .cindex "incorporated code"
723 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
724 .cindex "PCRE"
725 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
726
727 .ilist
728 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
729 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
730 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
731 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
732 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
733 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
734 .next
735 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
736 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
737 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
738 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
739 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
740 following statements:
741
742 .blockquote
743 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
744
745 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
746 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
747 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
748 version.
749 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
750 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
751 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
752 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
753 restrictions applied to it).
754 .endblockquote
755 .next
756 .cindex "SPA authentication"
757 .cindex "Samba project"
758 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
759 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
760 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
761 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
762 under the Gnu GPL.
763 .next
764 .cindex "Cyrus"
765 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
766 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
767 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
768 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
769 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
770 conditions expressed therein.
771
772 .blockquote
773 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
774
775 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
776 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
777 are met:
778
779 .olist
780 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
781 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
782 .next
783 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
784 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
785 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
786 distribution.
787 .next
788 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
789 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
790 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
791 details, please contact
792 .display
793 Office of Technology Transfer
794 Carnegie Mellon University
795 5000 Forbes Avenue
796 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
797 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
798 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
799 .endd
800 .next
801 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
802 acknowledgment:
803
804 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
805 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
806
807 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
808 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
809 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
810 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
811 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
812 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
813 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
814 .endlist
815 .endblockquote
816
817 .next
818 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
819 .cindex "X-windows"
820 .cindex "Athena"
821 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
822 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
823 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
824 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
825
826 .blockquote
827 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
828 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
829
830 All Rights Reserved
831
832 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
833 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
834 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
835 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
836 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
837 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
838 software without specific, written prior permission.
839
840 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
841 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
842 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
843 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
844 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
845 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
846 SOFTWARE.
847 .endblockquote
848
849 .next
850 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
851 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
852 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
853 .endlist
854
855
856
857
858
859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
861
862 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
863 "Receiving and delivering mail"
864
865
866 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
867 .cindex "design philosophy"
868 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
869 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
870 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
871 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
872 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
873 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
874
875
876 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
877 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
878 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
879 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
880 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
881 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
882 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
883
884 .ilist
885 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
886 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
887 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
888 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
889 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
890 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
891 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
892 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
893 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
894 error code.
895 .next
896 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
897 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
898 .next
899 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
900 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
901 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
902 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
903 .next
904 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
905 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
906 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
907 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
908 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
909 .next
910 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
911 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
912 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
913 .next
914 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
915 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
916 runs at the start of every delivery process.
917 .endlist
918
919
920
921 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
922 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
923 .cindex "Sieve filter"
924 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
925 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
926 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
927 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
928 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
929 of filtering are available:
930
931 .ilist
932 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
933 by RFC 3028.
934 .next
935 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
936 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
937 .endlist
938
939 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
940
941
942
943 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
944 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
945 .cindex "format" "of message id"
946 .cindex "id of message"
947 .cindex "base62"
948 .cindex "base36"
949 .cindex "Darwin"
950 .cindex "Cygwin"
951 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
952 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
953 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
954 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
955 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
956 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
957 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
958 not always case-sensitive.
959
960 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
961 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
962 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
963 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
964 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
965 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
966 somewhat eccentric:
967
968 .ilist
969 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
970 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
971 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
972 way of representing the date and time of day).
973 .next
974 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
975 received the message.
976 .next
977 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
978 .olist
979 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
980 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
981 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
982 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
983 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
984 .next
985 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
986 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
987 (1/100) of a second.
988 .endlist
989 .endlist
990
991 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
992 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
993 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
994 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
995 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
996
997
998 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
999 .cindex "receiving mail"
1000 .cindex "message" "reception"
1001 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1002 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1003 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1004 there are several possibilities:
1005
1006 .ilist
1007 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1008 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1009 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1010 .next
1011 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1012 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1013 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1014 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1015 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1016 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1017 .next
1018 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1019 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1020 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1021 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1022 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1023 .next
1024 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1025 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1026 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1027 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1028 .endlist
1029
1030
1031 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1032 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1033 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1034 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1035 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1036 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1037 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1038 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1039 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1040 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1041 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1042 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1043 users to change sender addresses.
1044
1045 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1046 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1047 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1048 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1049 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1050 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1051 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1052
1053 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1054 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1055 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1056 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1057 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1058 message is received.
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1065 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1066 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1067 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1068 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1069 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1070 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1071 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1072
1073 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1074 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1075 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1076 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1077 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1078 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1079 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1080 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1081 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1082 affect file system performance.
1083
1084 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1085 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1086 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1087 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1088 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1089
1090 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1091 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1092 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1093 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1094 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1095 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1096 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1097 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1098 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1099 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1100 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1101 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1102
1103
1104
1105 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1106 .cindex "message" "life of"
1107 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1108 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1109 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1110 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1111 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1112 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1113 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1114
1115 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1116 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1117 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1118 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1119 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1120 to be sent.
1121
1122 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1123 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1124 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1125 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1126 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1127
1128 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1129 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1130 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1131 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1132 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1133 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1134 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1135 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1136 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1137 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1138 systems.
1139
1140 .cindex "journal file"
1141 .cindex "file" "journal"
1142 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1143 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1144 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1145 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1146 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1147 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1148 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1149 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1150
1151 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1152 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1153 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1154 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1155 deliveries caused by crashes.
1156
1157
1158
1159 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1160 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1161 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1163 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1164 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1165 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1166 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1167 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1168
1169 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1170 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1171 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1172 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1173 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1174 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1175 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1176 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1177 the driver's features in general.
1178
1179 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1180 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1181 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1182 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1183 to be bounced.
1184
1185 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1186 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1187 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1188 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1189 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1190 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1191
1192 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1193 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1194 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1195 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1196 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1197 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1198
1199 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1200 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1201 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1202 configuration.
1203
1204 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1205 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1206 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1207 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1208 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1209 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1210 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1211 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1212 configured to fail the address.
1213
1214 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1215 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1216 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1217 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1218 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1219 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1220
1221 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1222 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1223 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1224 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1225 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1226 the address is bounced.
1227
1228
1229
1230 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1231 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1232 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1233 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1234 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1235 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1236 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1237 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1238
1239 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1240 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1241 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1242 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1243 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1244 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1245 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1246 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1247
1248
1249
1250
1251 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1252 .cindex "router" "running details"
1253 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1254 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1255 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1256 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1257 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1258 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1259 the following:
1260
1261 .ilist
1262 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1263 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1264 original address ceases,
1265 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1266 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1267 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1268 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1269 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1270 end of routing.
1271
1272 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1273 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1274 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1275 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1276 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1277 .next
1278 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1279 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1280 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1281 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1282 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1283 .next
1284 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1285 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1286 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1287 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1288 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1289 .next
1290 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1291 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1292 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1293 .next
1294 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1295 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1296 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1297 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1298 .next
1299 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1300 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1301 .endlist
1302
1303 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1304 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1305 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1306 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1307 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1308
1309 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1310 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1311 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1312 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1313 facility for this purpose.
1314
1315
1316 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1317 .cindex "case of local parts"
1318 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1319 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1320 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1321 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1322 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1323 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1324 routed addresses are shown.
1325
1326
1327
1328 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1329 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1330 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1331 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1332 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1333 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1334
1335 .ilist
1336 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1337 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1338 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1339 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1340 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1341 of any other conditions.
1342 .next
1343 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1344 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1345 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1346 address.
1347 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1348 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1349 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1350 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1351 .next
1352 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1353 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1354 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1355 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1356 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1357 .next
1358 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1359 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1360 .next
1361 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1362 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1363 .next
1364 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1365 of domains that it defines.
1366 .next
1367 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1368 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1369 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1370 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1371 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1372 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1373 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1374 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1375 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1376 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1377 .next
1378 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1379 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1380 .vindex "&$home$&"
1381 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1382 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1383 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1384 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1385 remaining preconditions.
1386 .next
1387 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1388 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1389 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1390 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1391 could lead to confusion.
1392 .next
1393 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1394 set of addresses that it defines.
1395 .next
1396 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1397 specified files is tested.
1398 .next
1399 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1400 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1401 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1402 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1403 .endlist
1404
1405
1406 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1407 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1408 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1409 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1410 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1411 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1412 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1413
1414
1415
1416 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1417 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1418 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1419
1420 .ilist
1421 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1422 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1423 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1424 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1425 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1426 filtering'&.
1427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1428 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1429
1430 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1431 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1432 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1433 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1434 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1435 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1436 filter.
1437 .next
1438 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1439 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1440 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1441 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1442 processed entirely independently of each other.
1443 .next
1444 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1445 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1446 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1447 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1448 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1449 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1450 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1451 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1452 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1453 .next
1454 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1455 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1456 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1457 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1458 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1459 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1460 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1461 addresses to the same domain.
1462 .next
1463 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1464 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1465 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1466 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1467 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1468 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1469 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1470 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1471 .next
1472 .cindex "queue runner"
1473 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1474 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1475 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1476 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1477 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1478 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1479 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1480 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1481 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1482 .next
1483 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1484 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1485 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1486 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1487 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1488 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1489 .next
1490 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1491 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1492 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1493 messages to other addresses.
1494 .next
1495 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1496 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1497 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1498 &'deferred'&.
1499 .next
1500 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1501 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1502 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1503 .endlist
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1509 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1510 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1511 .cindex "queue runner"
1512 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1513 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1514 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1515 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1516 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1517 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1518 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1519 passed its retry time.
1520 You can run several queue runners at once.
1521
1522 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1523 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1524 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1525 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1526 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1527 as permanent.
1528
1529
1530
1531 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1532 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1533 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1534 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1535 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1536 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1537 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1538 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1539 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1540 also apply.
1541
1542 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1543 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1544 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1545 deferred,
1546 .cindex "hints database"
1547 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1548 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1549 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1550 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1551 one connection.
1552
1553
1554
1555 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1556 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1557 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1558 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1559 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1560 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1561 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1562 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1563 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1564 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1565 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1566
1567 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1568 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1569 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1570 automatically.
1571
1572 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1573 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1574 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1575 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1576 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1577 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1578 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1579 of the list.
1580
1581
1582
1583 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1584 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1585 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1586 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1587 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1588 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1589 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1590 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1598
1599 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1600 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1601
1602 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1603 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1604 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1605 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1606
1607 .table2 140pt
1608 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1609 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1610 documented"
1611 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1612 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1613 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1614 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1615 instructions"
1616 .endtable
1617
1618 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1619 following subdirectories are created:
1620
1621 .table2 140pt
1622 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1623 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1624 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1625 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1626 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1627 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1628 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1629 .endtable
1630
1631 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1632 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1633 that may be useful to some sites.
1634
1635
1636 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1637 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1638 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1639 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1640 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1641 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1642 system.
1643 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1644 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1645 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1646 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1647 overridden if necessary.
1648
1649
1650 .new
1651 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1652 .cindex "PCRE library"
1653 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1654 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1655 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1656 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1657 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1658 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1659 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1660 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1661 If your operating system has no
1662 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1663 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1664 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1665 .wen
1666
1667 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1668 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1669 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1670 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1671 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1672 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1673 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1674
1675 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1677 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1678 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1679 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1680 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1681 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1682 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1683
1684 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1685 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1686 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1687 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1688 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1689 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1690 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1691 Berkeley DB library.
1692
1693 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1694 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1695 possibilities:
1696
1697 .olist
1698 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1699 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1700 .next
1701 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1702 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1703 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1704 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1705 file name is used unmodified.
1706 .next
1707 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1708 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1709 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1710 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1711 .next
1712 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1713 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1714 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1715 .next
1716 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1717 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1718 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1719 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1720 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1721 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1722 .next
1723 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1724 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1725 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1726 operates on a single file.
1727 .endlist
1728
1729 .cindex "USE_DB"
1730 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1731 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1732 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1733 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1734 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1735 .code
1736 USE_DB=yes
1737 .endd
1738 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1739 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1740
1741 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1742 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1743 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1744 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1745 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1746 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1747
1748 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1749 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1750 in one of these lines:
1751 .code
1752 DBMLIB = -ldb
1753 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1754 .endd
1755 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1756 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1757 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1758 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1759 this example:
1760 .code
1761 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1762 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1763 .endd
1764 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1765 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1766
1767
1768
1769 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1770 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1771 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1772 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1773 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1774 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1775 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1777 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1778 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1779 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1780 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1781
1782 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1783 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1784 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1785 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1786 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1787 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1788
1789 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1790 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1791 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1792 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1793 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1794 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1795 be logged.
1796
1797 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1798 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1799 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1800 facilities, you need to set
1801 .code
1802 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1803 .endd
1804 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1805 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1806
1807
1808 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1809 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1810 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1811 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1812 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1813 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1814 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1815
1816 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1817 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1818 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1819 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1820 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1821 do this.
1822
1823
1824
1825 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1826 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1827 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1828 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1829 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1830 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1831 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1832 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1833 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1834 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1835
1836 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1837 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1838 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1839 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1840 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1841 .code
1842 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1843 .endd
1844 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1845
1846
1847
1848 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1849 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1850 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1851 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1852 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1853 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1854 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1855 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1856 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1857 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1858 line option).
1859
1860 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1861 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1862 implementing SSL.
1863
1864 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1865 .code
1866 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1867 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1868 .endd
1869 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1870 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1871 .code
1872 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1873 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1874 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1875 .endd
1876 .new
1877 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1878 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1879 .code
1880 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1881 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1882 .endd
1883 .wen
1884 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1885 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1886 .code
1887 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1888 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1889 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1890 .endd
1891 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1892 library and include files. For example:
1893 .code
1894 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1895 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1898 .endd
1899 .new
1900 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1901 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1902 .code
1903 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1904 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1905 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1906 .endd
1907 .wen
1908
1909 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1910 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1911 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1912
1913
1914
1915
1916 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1917
1918 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1919 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1920 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1921 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1922 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1923 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1924 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1925 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1926 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1927 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1928 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1929 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1930 you might have
1931 .code
1932 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1933 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1934 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1935 .endd
1936 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1937 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1938 .code
1939 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1940 .endd
1941 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1942 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1943 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1944 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1945 in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1946 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1947 further details.
1948
1949
1950 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1951 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1952 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1953 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1954 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1955 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1956 library files.
1957
1958 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1959 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1960 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1961 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1962 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1963 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1964 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1965 support has not been tested for some time.
1966
1967
1968
1969 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1970 .cindex "lookup modules"
1971 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1972 .cindex ".so building"
1973 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1974 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1975 on demand.
1976 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1977 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1978 dependencies.
1979 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1980
1981 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1982 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1983 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
1984 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
1985 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
1986 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
1987
1988 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
1989 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
1990 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
1991 on demand:
1992 .code
1993 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
1994 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
1995 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
1996 .endd
1997
1998
1999 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2000 .cindex "build directory"
2001 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2002 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2003 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2004 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2005 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2006 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2007 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2008
2009 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2010 building process fails if it is set.
2011
2012 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2013 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2014 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2015 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2016 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2017 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2018 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2019 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2020
2021 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2022 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2023 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2024
2025
2026
2027 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2028 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2029 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2030 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2031 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2032 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2033 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2034 .code
2035 FULLECHO='' make -e
2036 .endd
2037 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2038 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2039 given in addition to the short output.
2040
2041
2042
2043 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2044 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2045 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2046 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2047 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2048 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2049 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2050 order:
2051 .display
2052 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2053 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2054 &_Local/Makefile_&
2055 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2056 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2057 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2058 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2059 .endd
2060 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2061 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2062 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2063 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2064 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2065 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2066 and are often not needed.
2067
2068 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2069 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2070 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2071 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2072 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2073 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2074 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2075 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2076 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2077
2078
2079 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2080 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2081 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2082 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2083 default values are.
2084
2085
2086 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2087 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2088 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2089 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2090 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2091 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2092 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2093 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2094 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2095 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2096 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2097 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2098 containing the lines
2099 .code
2100 CC=cc
2101 CFLAGS=-std1
2102 .endd
2103 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2104 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2105
2106 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2107 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2108 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2109
2110
2111 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2112 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2113 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2114 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2115 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2116 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2117 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2118 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2119 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2120 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2121 .code
2122 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2123 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2124 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2125 .endd
2126 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2127 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2128 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2129 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2130 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2131 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2132 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2133 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2134 errors.
2135
2136 .new
2137 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2138 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2139 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2140 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2141 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2142 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2143 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2144 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2145 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2146 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2147 syntax. For instance:
2148 .code
2149 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2150 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2151 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2152 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2153 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2154 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2155 .endd
2156 .wen
2157
2158 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2159 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2160 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2161 .code
2162 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2163 .endd
2164 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2165 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2166
2167 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2168 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2169 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2170 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2171 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2172 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2173 .code
2174 X11=/usr/X11R6
2175 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2176 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2177 .endd
2178 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2179 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2180 .code
2181 X11=/usr/openwin
2182 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2183 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2184 .endd
2185 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2186 definition of all three of these variables into your
2187 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2188
2189 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2190 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2191 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2192 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2193 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2194
2195 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2196 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2197 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2198 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2199 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2200 libraries.
2201
2202 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2203 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2204 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2205 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2206 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2207
2208
2209 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2210 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2211 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2212 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2213 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2214 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2215 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2216 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2217
2218
2219
2220 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2221 .cindex "building Eximon"
2222 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2223 where the files that are involved are
2224 .display
2225 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2226 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2227 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2228 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2229 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2230 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2231 .endd
2232 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2233 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2234 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2235 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2236 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2237 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2238 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2239 .ecindex IIDbuex
2240
2241
2242 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2243 .cindex "installing Exim"
2244 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2245 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2246 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2247 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2248 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2249 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2250 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2251 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2252 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2253 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2254 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2255 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2256
2257 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2258 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2259 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2260 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2261 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2262 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2263 alternative files, no default is installed.
2264
2265 .cindex "system aliases file"
2266 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2267 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2268 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2269 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2270 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2271 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2272 and outputs a comment to the user.
2273
2274 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2275 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2276 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2277 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2278 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2279
2280 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2281 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2282 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2283 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2284 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2285 over SMTP.
2286
2287 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2288 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2289 command such as
2290 .code
2291 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2292 .endd
2293 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2294 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2295 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2296 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2297 but this usage is deprecated.
2298
2299 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2300 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2301 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2302 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2303 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2304 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2305
2306 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2307 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2308 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2309 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2310 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2311 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2312 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2313
2314 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2315 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2316 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2317 command:
2318 .code
2319 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2320 .endd
2321 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2322 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2323 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2324 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2325 command:
2326 .code
2327 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2328 .endd
2329 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2330 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2331
2332 .ilist
2333 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2334 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2335 .next
2336 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2337 installed binary.
2338 .endlist
2339
2340 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2341 .code
2342 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2343 .endd
2344 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2345 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2346 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2347 .code
2348 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2349 .endd
2350
2351
2352
2353 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2354 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2355 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2356 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2357 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2358 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2359
2360 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2361 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2362 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2363
2364
2365
2366 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2367 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2368 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2369 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2370 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2371 necessary.
2372
2373
2374
2375
2376 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2377 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2378 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2379 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2380 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2381 .code
2382 exim -bV
2383 .endd
2384 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2385 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2386 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2387 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2388 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2389 example,
2390 .display
2391 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2392 .endd
2393 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2394 .display
2395 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2396 .endd
2397 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2398 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2399 user agent. For example:
2400 .code
2401 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2402 From: user@your.domain.example
2403 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2404 Subject: Testing Exim
2405
2406 This is a test message.
2407 ^D
2408 .endd
2409 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2410 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2411 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2412
2413 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2414 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2415 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2416 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2417 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2418 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2419 .display
2420 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2421 .endd
2422 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2423 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2424 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2425 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2426 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2427
2428 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2429 .cindex "lock files"
2430 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2431 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2432 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2433 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2434 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2435 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2436 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2437 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2438 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2439 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2440 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2441 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2442
2443 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2444 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2445 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2446 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2447 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2448 incoming SMTP mail.
2449
2450 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2451 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2452 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2453 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2454 production version.
2455
2456
2457 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2458 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2459 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2460 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2461 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2462 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2463 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2464 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2465 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2466 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2467 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2468 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2469 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2470
2471 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2472 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2473 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2474 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2475 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2476 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2477 as follows:
2478 .code
2479 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2480 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2481 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2482 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2483 .endd
2484 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2485 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2486 favourite user agent.
2487
2488 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2489 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2490 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2491 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2492 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2493 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2494
2495
2496
2497 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2498 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2499 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2500 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2501 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2502 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2503 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2504 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2505 configuration file.
2506
2507
2508
2509
2510 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2511 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2512 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2513 .code
2514 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2515 .endd
2516 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2517 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2518 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2519 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2520 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2521 .code
2522 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2523 .endd
2524 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2525
2526 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2527 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2528 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2529
2530
2531
2532
2533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2534 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2535
2536 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2537 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2538 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2539 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2540 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2541 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2542 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2543 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2544 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2545
2546
2547 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2548 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2549 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2550 were present before any other options.
2551 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2552 standard output.
2553 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2554 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2555 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2556
2557 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2558 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2559 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2560 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2561 format.
2562
2563 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2564 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2565 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2566 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2567
2568 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2569 .cindex "queue runner"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2571 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2572 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2573
2574 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2575 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2576 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2577 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2578 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2579 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2580 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2581 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2582
2583
2584 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2585 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2586 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2587 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2588 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2589 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2590
2591 .ilist
2592 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2593 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2594 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2595 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2596 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2597 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2598
2599 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2600 .cindex "envelope sender"
2601 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2602 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2603 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2604 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2605 users to set envelope senders.
2606
2607 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2608 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2609 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2610 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2611 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2612
2613 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2614 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2615 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2616 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2617 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2618 that are available to trusted users.
2619 .next
2620 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2621 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2622 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2623 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2624 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2625
2626 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2627 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2628 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2629 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2630
2631 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2632 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2633 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2634 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2635
2636 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2637 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2638 false.
2639 .endlist
2640
2641
2642 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2643 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2644 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2645 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2646
2647
2648
2649
2650 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2651 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2652 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2653 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2654 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2655 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2656 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2657 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2658
2659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2660 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2661 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2662 . creates a man page for the options.
2663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2664
2665 .literal xml
2666 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2667 .literal off
2668
2669
2670 .vlist
2671 .vitem &%--%&
2672 .oindex "--"
2673 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2674 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2675 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2676 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2677
2678 .vitem &%--help%&
2679 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2680 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2681 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2682 no arguments.
2683
2684 .vitem &%--version%&
2685 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2686 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2687 displayed.
2688
2689 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2690 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2691 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2692 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2693 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2694 clean; it ignores this option.
2695
2696 .vitem &%-bd%&
2697 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2698 .cindex "daemon"
2699 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2700 .cindex "queue runner"
2701 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2702 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2703 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2704
2705 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2706 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2707 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2708 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2709
2710 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2711 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2712 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2713 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2714
2715 When a listening daemon
2716 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2717 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2718 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2719 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2720 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2721 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2722 running as root.
2723
2724 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2725 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2726 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2727
2728 The SIGHUP signal
2729 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2730 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2731 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2732 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2733 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2734 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2735 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2736 because these are reread each time they are used.
2737
2738 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2739 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2740 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2741 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2742
2743 .vitem &%-be%&
2744 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2745 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2746 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2747 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2748 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2749 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2750 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2751
2752 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2753 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2754 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2755 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2756 test data. A line history is supported.
2757
2758 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2759 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2760 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2761 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2762 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2763 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2764 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2765
2766 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2767 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2768 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2769 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2772 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2776 of a file. For example:
2777 .code
2778 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2779 .endd
2780 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2781 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2782 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2783 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2784 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2785 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2786 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2787 &%-be%&).
2788
2789 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2790 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2791 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2792 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2793 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2794 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2795 system filters are recognized.
2796
2797 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2798 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2799 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2800 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2801 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2802 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2803 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2804 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2805 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2806 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2807 supplied.
2808
2809 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2810 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2811 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2812 .code
2813 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2814 .endd
2815 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2816 variables that are used by the user filter.
2817
2818 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2819 .code
2820 # Exim filter
2821 # Sieve filter
2822 .endd
2823 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2824 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2825 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2826 redirection lists.
2827
2828 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2829 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2830 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2831 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2832
2833 When testing a filter file,
2834 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2835 .cindex "envelope sender"
2836 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2837 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2838 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2839 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2840 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2841 options).
2842
2843 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2844 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2845 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2846 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2847 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2848 &$qualify_domain$&.
2849
2850 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2851 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2852 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2853 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2854 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2855 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2856 actually being delivered.
2857
2858 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2859 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2860 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2861 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2862 prefix.
2863
2864 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2865 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2866 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2867 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2868 suffix.
2869
2870 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2871 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2872 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2873 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2874 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2875 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2876 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2877 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2878 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2879 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2880 after a full stop. For example:
2881 .code
2882 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2883 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2884 .endd
2885 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2886 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2887 conversion to the canonical form is
2888 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2889
2890 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2891 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2892 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2893 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2894 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2895
2896 &*Warning 1*&:
2897 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2898 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2899 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2900 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2901 connection.
2902
2903 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2904 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2905 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2906
2907 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2908 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2909 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2910 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2911 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2912 session were authenticated.
2913
2914 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2915 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2916 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2917
2918 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2919 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2920 specialized SMTP test program such as
2921 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2922
2923 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2924 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2925 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2926 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2927 updating the callout cache database.
2928
2929 .vitem &%-bi%&
2930 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2931 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2932 .cindex "building alias file"
2933 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2934 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2935 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2936 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2937 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2938 recognized.
2939
2940 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2941 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2942 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2943 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2944 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2945 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2946 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2947
2948 .vitem &%-bm%&
2949 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
2950 .cindex "local message reception"
2951 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2952 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2953 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2954 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2955 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2956 if no other conflicting option is present.
2957
2958 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2959 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2960 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2961 suppressing this for special cases.
2962
2963 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2964 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2965
2966 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2967 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2968 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2969
2970 The format
2971 .cindex "message" "format"
2972 .cindex "format" "message"
2973 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2974 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2975 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2976 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2977 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2978 .code
2979 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2980 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2981 .endd
2982 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2983 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2984 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2985 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2986 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2987
2988 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2989 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2990 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2991 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2992 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2993
2994 .vitem &%-bnq%&
2995 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
2996 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2997 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2998 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2999 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3000 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3001 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3002 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3003
3004 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3005 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3006 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3007 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3008 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3009
3010 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3011 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3012 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3013 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3014
3015
3016 .vitem &%-bP%&
3017 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3018 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3019 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3020 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3021 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3022 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3023 arguments, for example:
3024 .code
3025 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3026 .endd
3027 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3028 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3029 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3030 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3031 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3032 users, the output is as in this example:
3033 .code
3034 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3035 .endd
3036 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3037 configuration file is output.
3038 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3039 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3040
3041 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3042 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3043 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3044 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3045 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3046 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3047 written directly into the spool directory.
3048
3049 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3050 .code
3051 exim -bP +local_domains
3052 .endd
3053 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3054 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3055
3056 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3057 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3058 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3059 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3060 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3061 that driver are output. For example:
3062 .code
3063 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3064 .endd
3065 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3066 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3067 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3068 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3069 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3070 &%authenticators%&.
3071
3072 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3073 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3074 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3075 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3076 The output format is one item per line.
3077
3078 .vitem &%-bp%&
3079 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3080 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3081 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3082 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3083 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3084 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3085 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3086 to allow any user to see the queue.
3087
3088 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3089 .code
3090 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3091 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3092 <other addresses>
3093 .endd
3094 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3095 .cindex "size" "of message"
3096 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3097 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3098 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3099 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3100 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3101 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3102 before the sender address.
3103
3104 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3105 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3106 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3107
3108 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3109 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3110 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3111 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3112 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3113 complete.
3114
3115
3116 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3117 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3118 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3119 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3120 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3121 of just &"D"&.
3122
3123
3124 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3125 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3126 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3127 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3128 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3129 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3130
3131
3132 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3133 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3134 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3135 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3136 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3137 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3138
3139 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3140 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3141 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3142
3143 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3144 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3145 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3146
3147
3148 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3149 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3150 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3151 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3152 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3153 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3154
3155
3156 .vitem &%-brt%&
3157 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3158 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3159 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3160 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3161 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3162 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3163 .code
3164 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3165 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3166 .endd
3167 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3168 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3169 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3170 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3171 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3172 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3173 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3174 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3175 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3176 .code
3177 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3178 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3179 .endd
3180
3181 .vitem &%-brw%&
3182 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3183 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3184 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3185 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3186 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3187 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3188 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3189 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3190
3191 .vitem &%-bS%&
3192 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3193 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3194 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3195 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3196 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3197 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3198 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3199 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3200 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3201 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3202
3203 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3204 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3205 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3206
3207 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3208 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3209 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3210 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3211
3212 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3213 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3214 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3215
3216 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3217 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3218 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3219 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3220 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3221
3222 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3223 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3224
3225 .vitem &%-bs%&
3226 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3227 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3228 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3229 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3230 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3231 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3232 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3233 messages to the MTA.
3234
3235 In
3236 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3237 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3238 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3239 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3240 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3241 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3242 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3243
3244 .cindex "inetd"
3245 The
3246 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3247 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3248 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3249 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3250 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3251 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3252 the listening daemon.
3253
3254 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3255 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3256 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3257 .cindex "malware scan test"
3258 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3259 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3260 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3261 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3262 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3263 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3264
3265 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3266 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3267 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3268 This option requires admin privileges.
3269
3270 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3271 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3272 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3273
3274 .vitem &%-bt%&
3275 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3276 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3277 .cindex "address" "testing"
3278 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3279 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3280 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3281 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3282 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3283
3284 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3285 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3286
3287 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3288 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3289 security issues.
3290
3291 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3292 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3293 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3294 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3295 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3296 program.
3297
3298 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3299 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3300 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3301 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3302
3303 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3304 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3305 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3306 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3307 always shown.
3308
3309 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3310 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3311 message,
3312 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3313 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3314 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3315 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3316 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3317 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3318 doing such tests.
3319
3320 .vitem &%-bV%&
3321 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3322 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3323 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3324 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3325 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3326 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3327 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3328
3329 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3330 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3331 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3332 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3333 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3334 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3335 dynamic testing facilities.
3336
3337 .vitem &%-bv%&
3338 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3339 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3340 .cindex "address" "verification"
3341 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3342 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3343 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3344 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3345 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3346 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3347
3348 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3349 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3350 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3351
3352 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3353 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3354
3355 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3356 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3357 security issues.
3358
3359 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3360 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3361 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3362 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3363 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3364
3365 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3366 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3367 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3368 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3369 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3370 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3371 to succeed.
3372
3373 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3374 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3375 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3376
3377 The
3378 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3379 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3380 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3381 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3382
3383 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3384 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3385 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3386 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3387
3388 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3389 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3390 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3391 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3392 might happen.
3393
3394 .vitem &%-bw%&
3395 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3396 .cindex "daemon"
3397 .cindex "inetd"
3398 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3399 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3400 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3401 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3402
3403 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3404 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3405 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3406 each port only when the first connection is received.
3407
3408 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3409 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3410
3411 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3412 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3413 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3414 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3415 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3416 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3417 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3418 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3419 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3420 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3421 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3422
3423 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3424 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3425 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3426 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3427 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3428 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3429 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3430 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3431 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3432
3433 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3434 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3435 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3436 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3437 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3438 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3439 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3440
3441 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3442 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3443 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3444 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3445 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3446 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3447 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3448
3449 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3450 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3451 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3452 configuration file.
3453
3454 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3455 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3456 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3457 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3458 specified by this option.
3459
3460
3461 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3462 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3463 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3464 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3465 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3466 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3467 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3468 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3469
3470 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3471 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3472 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3473 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3474 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3475 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3476 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3477
3478 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3479 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3480 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3481 synonymous:
3482 .code
3483 exim -DABC ...
3484 exim -DABC= ...
3485 .endd
3486 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3487 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3488 example:
3489 .code
3490 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3491 .endd
3492 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3493
3494
3495 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3496 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3497 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3498 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3499 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3500 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3501 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3502 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3503 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3504 return code.
3505
3506 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3507 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3508 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3509 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3510 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3511 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3512 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3513 are:
3514 .display
3515 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3516 &`auth `& authenticators
3517 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3518 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3519 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3520 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3521 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3522 &`filter `& filter handling
3523 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3524 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3525 &`ident `& ident lookup
3526 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3527 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3528 &`load `& system load checks
3529 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3530 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3531 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3532 &`memory `& memory handling
3533 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3534 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3535 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3536 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3537 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3538 &`retry `& retry handling
3539 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3540 &`route `& address routing
3541 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3542 &`tls `& TLS logic
3543 &`transport `& transports
3544 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3545 &`verify `& address verification logic
3546 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3547 .endd
3548 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3549 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3550 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3551 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3552 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3553 turn everything off.
3554
3555 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3556 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3557 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3558 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3559 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3560 rather than stderr.
3561
3562 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3563 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3564 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3565 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3566 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3567 run in parallel.
3568
3569 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3570 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3571 in processing.
3572
3573 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3574 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3575
3576 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3577 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3578 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3579 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3580 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3581 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3582
3583 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3584 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3585 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3586 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3587 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3588
3589 .vitem &%-E%&
3590 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3591 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3592 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3593 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3594 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3595 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3596 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3597 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3598 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3599
3600 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3601 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3602 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3603 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3604 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3605 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3606
3607 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3608 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3609 .cindex "sender" "name"
3610 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3611 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3612 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3613 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3614 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3615 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3616
3617 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3618 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3619 .cindex "sender" "address"
3620 .cindex "address" "sender"
3621 .cindex "trusted users"
3622 .cindex "envelope sender"
3623 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3624 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3625 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3626 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3627 users to use it.
3628
3629 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3630 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3631 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3632 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3633 domain.
3634
3635 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3636 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3637 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3638 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3639 examples of shell commands:
3640 .code
3641 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3642 exim -f "" user@domain
3643 .endd
3644 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3645 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3646 &%-bv%& options.
3647
3648 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3649 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3650 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3651 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3652
3653 White
3654 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3655 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3656 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3657 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3658 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3659 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3660
3661 .vitem &%-G%&
3662 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3663 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3664 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3665
3666 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3667 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3668 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3669 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3670 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3671 headers.)
3672
3673 .vitem &%-i%&
3674 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3675 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3676 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3677 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3678 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3679 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3680 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3681
3682 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3683 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3684 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3685 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3686 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3687 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3688 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3689 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3690 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3691
3692 Retry
3693 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3694 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3695 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3696 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3697 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3698 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3699
3700 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3701 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3702 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3703 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3704
3705 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3706 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3707 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3708 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3709 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3710 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3711 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3712 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3713 can be used only by an admin user.
3714
3715 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3716 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3717 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3718 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3719 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3720 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3721 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3722 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3723 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3724 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3725 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3726
3727 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3728 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3729 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3730 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3731 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3732
3733 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3734 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3735 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3736 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3737 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3738
3739 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3740 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3741 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3742 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3743 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3744 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3745 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3746 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3747
3748 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3749 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3750 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3751 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3752 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3753 connection.
3754
3755 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3756 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3757 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3758 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3759 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3760
3761 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3762 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3763 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3764 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3765 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3766 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3767 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3768 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3769 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3770 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3771 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3772 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3773 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3774 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3775 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3776
3777 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3778 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3779 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3780 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3781 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3782 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3783 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3784 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3785 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3786 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3787
3788 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3789 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3790 .cindex "freezing messages"
3791 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3792 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3793 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3794 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3795 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3796 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3797 user.
3798
3799 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3800 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3801 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3802 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3803 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3804 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3805 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3806 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3807 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3808 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3809 user.
3810
3811 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3812 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3813 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3814 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3815 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3816 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3817 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3818
3819 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3820 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3821 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3822 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3823 .cindex "removing recipients"
3824 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3825 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3826 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3827 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3828 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3829 can be used only by an admin user.
3830
3831 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3832 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3833 .cindex "removing messages"
3834 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3835 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3836 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3837 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3838 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3839 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3840 placed on the queue.
3841
3842 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3843 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3844 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3845 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3846 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3847 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3848 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3849 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3850 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3851 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3852 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3853
3854 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3855 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3856 .cindex "thawing messages"
3857 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3858 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3859 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3860 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3861 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3862 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3863 by an admin user.
3864
3865 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3866 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3867 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3868 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3869 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3870 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3871
3872 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3873 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3874 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3875 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3876 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3877 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3878 only by an admin user.
3879
3880 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3881 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3882 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3883 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3884 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3885 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3886 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3887
3888 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3889 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3890 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3891 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3892 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3893 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3894
3895 .vitem &%-m%&
3896 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3897 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3898 treats it that way too.
3899
3900 .vitem &%-N%&
3901 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3902 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3903 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3904 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3905 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3906 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3907 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3908 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3909 than &"=>"&.
3910
3911 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3912 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3913 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3914 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3915 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3916 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3917 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3918 for that message.
3919
3920 .vitem &%-n%&
3921 .oindex "&%-n%&"
3922 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3923 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3924 by Exim.
3925
3926 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3927 .oindex "&%-O%&"
3928 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3929 Exim.
3930
3931 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3932 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
3933 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3934 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3935 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3936 description above.
3937
3938 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3939 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
3940 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3941 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3942 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3943 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3944 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3945 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3946
3947 .vitem &%-odb%&
3948 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
3949 .cindex "background delivery"
3950 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3951 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3952 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3953 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3954 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3955 processes to finish.
3956
3957 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3958 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3959 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3960 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3961
3962 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3963 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3964 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3965 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3966
3967 .vitem &%-odf%&
3968 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
3969 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3970 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3971 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3972 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3973 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3974 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3975
3976 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3977 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3978 during deliveries.
3979
3980 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3981 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3982
3983 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3984 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3985 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3986 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3987
3988
3989 .vitem &%-odi%&
3990 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
3991 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3992 Sendmail.
3993
3994 .vitem &%-odq%&
3995 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
3996 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3997 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3998 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3999 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4000 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4001 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4002 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4003 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4004 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4005 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4006 forces queueing.
4007
4008 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4009 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4010 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4011 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4012 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4013 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4014 configuration file is in effect.
4015
4016 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4017 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4018 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4019 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4020 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4021 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4022 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4023 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4024 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4025 &%-qq%& option.
4026
4027 .vitem &%-oee%&
4028 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4029 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4030 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4031 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4032 message.
4033
4034 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4035 Provided
4036 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4037 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4038 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
4039 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4040
4041 .vitem &%-oem%&
4042 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4043 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4044 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4045 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4046 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4047 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4048
4049 .vitem &%-oep%&
4050 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4051 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4052 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4053 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4054 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4055 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4056
4057 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4058 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4059 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4060 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4061 effect as &%-oep%&.
4062
4063 .vitem &%-oew%&
4064 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4065 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4066 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4067 effect as &%-oem%&.
4068
4069 .vitem &%-oi%&
4070 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4071 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4072 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4073 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4074 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4075 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4076 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4077
4078 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4079 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4080 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4081
4082 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4083 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4084 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4085 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4086 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4087 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4088 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4089 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4090
4091 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4092 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4093 .code
4094 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4095 .endd
4096 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4097 followed by a colon and the port number:
4098 .code
4099 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4100 .endd
4101 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4102 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4103 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4104 whichever one is last.
4105
4106 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4107 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4108 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4109 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4110 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4111 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4112 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4113 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4114
4115 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4116 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4117 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4118 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4119 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4120 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4121 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4122 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4123
4124 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4125 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4126 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4127 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4128 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4129 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4130 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4131 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4132 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4133 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4134
4135 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4136 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4137 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4138 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4139 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4140 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4141 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4142
4143 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4144 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4145 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4146 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4147 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4148 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4149 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4150 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4151 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4152 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4153 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4154 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4155
4156 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4157 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4158 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4159 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4160 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4161 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4162 uses the name it is given.
4163
4164 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4165 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4166 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4167 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4168 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4169 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4170 used, when there is no default.
4171
4172 .vitem &%-om%&
4173 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4174 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4175 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4176 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4177 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4178
4179 .vitem &%-oo%&
4180 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4181 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4182 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4183 whatever that means.
4184
4185 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4186 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4187 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4188 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4189 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4190 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4191 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4192 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4193 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4194
4195 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4196 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4197 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4198 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4199 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4200 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4201 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4202
4203 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4204 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4205 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4206 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4207 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4208 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4209 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4210 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4211
4212 .vitem &%-ov%&
4213 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4214 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4215
4216 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4217 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4218 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4219 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4220 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4221 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4222 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4223 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4224 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4225 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4226
4227 .vitem &%-pd%&
4228 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4229 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4230 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4231 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4232 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4233 needed.
4234
4235 .vitem &%-ps%&
4236 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4237 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4238 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4239 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4240 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4241 started.
4242
4243 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4244 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4245 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4246 .display
4247 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4248 .endd
4249 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4250 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4251 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4252 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4253 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4254
4255 .vitem &%-q%&
4256 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4257 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4258 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4259 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4260 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4261 and &%-S%& options).
4262
4263 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4264 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4265 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4266 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4267 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4268 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4269
4270 If
4271 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4272 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4273 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4274 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4275 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4276 proceeding.
4277
4278 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4279 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4280 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4281 this to be repeated periodically.
4282
4283 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4284 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4285 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4286 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4287
4288 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4289 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4290 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4291
4292 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4293 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4294 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4295 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4296
4297 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4298 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4299 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4300 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4301 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4302 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4303 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4304 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4305 transports are run.
4306
4307 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4308 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4309 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4310 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4311 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4312 delivered down a single SMTP
4313 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4314 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4315 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4316 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4317 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4318 intermittently.
4319
4320 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4321 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4322 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4323 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4324 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4325 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4326 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4327
4328 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4329 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4330 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4331 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4332 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4333 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4334 their retry times are tried.
4335
4336 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4337 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4338 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4339 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4340 frozen or not.
4341
4342 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4343 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4344 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4345 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4346 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4347 for later delivery.
4348
4349 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4350 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4351 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4352 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4353 starting message id. For example:
4354 .code
4355 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4356 .endd
4357 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4358 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4359 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4360 .code
4361 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4362 .endd
4363 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4364 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4365 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4366 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4367 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4368 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4369
4370 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4371 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4372 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4373 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4374 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4375 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4376 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4377 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4378 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4379 .code
4380 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4381 .endd
4382 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4383 process every 30 minutes.
4384
4385 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4386 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4387
4388 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4389 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4390 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4391 compatibility.
4392
4393 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4394 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4395 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4396
4397 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4398 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4399 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4400 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4401 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4402 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4403 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4404 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4405 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4406
4407 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4408 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4409 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4410 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4411 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4412 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4413
4414 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4415 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4416 .code
4417 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4418 .endd
4419 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4420 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4421 applied to each queue run.
4422
4423 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4424 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4425 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4426 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4427 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4428 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4429 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4430 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4431 address will be skipped.
4432
4433 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4434 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4435 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4436 &'ff'& is present.
4437
4438 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4439 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4440 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4441 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4442 an arbitrary command instead.
4443
4444 .vitem &%-r%&
4445 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4446 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4447
4448 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4449 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4450 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4451 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4452 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4453 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4454 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4455 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4456
4457 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4458 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4459 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4460 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4461 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4462
4463 .vitem &%-t%&
4464 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4465 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4466 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4467 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4468 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4469 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4470 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4471 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4472 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4473 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4474
4475 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4476 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4477 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4478 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4479 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4480 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4481 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4482 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4483 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4484 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4485 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4486
4487 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4488 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4489 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4490 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4491 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4492 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4493
4494 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4495 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4496 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4497 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4498 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4499 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4500 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4501 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4502 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4503
4504 .vitem &%-ti%&
4505 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4506 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4507 compatibility with Sendmail.
4508
4509 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4510 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4511 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4512 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4513 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4514 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4515 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4516 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4517
4518
4519 .vitem &%-U%&
4520 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4521 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4522 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4523 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4524 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4525 set. Exim ignores this option.
4526
4527 .vitem &%-v%&
4528 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4529 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4530 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4531 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4532 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4533 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4534 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4535 unconditional.
4536
4537 .vitem &%-x%&
4538 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4539 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4540 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4541 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4542 this option.
4543 .endlist
4544
4545 .ecindex IIDclo1
4546 .ecindex IIDclo2
4547
4548
4549 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4550 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4551 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4552 . creates a man page for the options.
4553 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4554
4555 .literal xml
4556 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4557 .literal off
4558
4559
4560
4561
4562
4563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4564 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4565
4566
4567 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4568 "The runtime configuration file"
4569
4570 .cindex "run time configuration"
4571 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4572 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4573 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4574 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4575 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4576 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4577 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4578 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4579 control.
4580
4581 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4582 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4583 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4584 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4585 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4586 actually alter the string.
4587
4588 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4589 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4590 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4591 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4592 existing file in the list.
4593
4594 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4595 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4596 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4597 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4598 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4599 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4600 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4601 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4602 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4603 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4604 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4605
4606 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4607 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4608 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4609 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4610 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4611
4612 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4613 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4614 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4615 compromise the Exim user account.
4616
4617 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4618 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4619 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4620 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4621 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4622 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4623 configuration.
4624
4625
4626
4627 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4628 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4629 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4630 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4631 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4632 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4633 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4634 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4635 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4636 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4637 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4638
4639 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4640 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4641 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4642 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4643 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4644 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4645 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4646 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4647 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4648 &%-M%&).
4649
4650 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4651 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4652 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4653 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4654 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4655
4656 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4657 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4658 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4659 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4660 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4661 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4662
4663 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4664 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4665 necessarily be discarded.
4666 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4667 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4668 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4669 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4670 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4671 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4672
4673 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4674 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4675 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4676 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4677 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4678 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4679 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4680
4681 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4682 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4683 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4684
4685
4686
4687 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4688 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4689 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4690 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4691 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4692 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4693 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4694 optional parts are:
4695
4696 .ilist
4697 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4698 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4699 .next
4700 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4701 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4702 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4703 .next
4704 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4705 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4706 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4707 .next
4708 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4709 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4710 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4711 .next
4712 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4713 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4714 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4715 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4716 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4717 .next
4718 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4719 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4720 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4721 .next
4722 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4723 want to use this feature, you must set
4724 .code
4725 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4726 .endd
4727 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4728 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4729 .endlist
4730
4731 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4732 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4733 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4734 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4735
4736 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4737 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4738 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4739 and does not introduce a comment.
4740
4741 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4742 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4743 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4744 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4745 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4746
4747 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4748 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4749 change settings as required.
4750
4751 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4752 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4753 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4754 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4755 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4756 described.
4757
4758
4759
4760 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4761 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4762 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4763 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4764 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4765 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4766 using this syntax:
4767 .display
4768 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4769 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4770 .endd
4771 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4772 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4773 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4774 name is required.
4775
4776 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4777 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4778 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4779 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4780
4781 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4782 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4783 for example:
4784 .code
4785 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4786 .include /some/file
4787 .endd
4788 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4789 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4790 inclusion appears.
4791
4792
4793
4794 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4795 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4796 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4797 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4798 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4799 definition, and must be of the form
4800 .display
4801 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4802 .endd
4803 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4804 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4805 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4806 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4807 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4808
4809 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4810 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4811 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4812
4813 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4814 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4815 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4816 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4817 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4818 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4819 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4820 define
4821 .display
4822 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4823 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4824 .endd
4825 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4826 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4827 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4828 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4829 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4830 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4831
4832
4833 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4834 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4835 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4836 &'='&. For example:
4837 .code
4838 MAC = initial value
4839 ...
4840 MAC == updated value
4841 .endd
4842 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4843 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4844 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4845 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4846 .code
4847 MAC = initial value
4848 ...
4849 MAC == MAC and something added
4850 .endd
4851 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4852 from a number of other files.
4853
4854 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4855 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4856 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4857 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4858 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4859 file to be ignored.
4860
4861
4862
4863 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4864 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4865 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4866 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4867 .code
4868 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4869 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4870 .endd
4871 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4872 .code
4873 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4874 .endd
4875 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4876 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4877 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4878
4879
4880 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4881 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4882 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4883 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4884 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4885 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4886 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4887
4888 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4889 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4890 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4891 line. Thus:
4892 .code
4893 .ifdef AAA
4894 message_size_limit = 50M
4895 .else
4896 message_size_limit = 100M
4897 .endif
4898 .endd
4899 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4900 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4901 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4902 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4903
4904 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4905 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4906 in this line"& will always be true.
4907
4908 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4909 to clarify complicated nestings.
4910
4911
4912
4913 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4914 .cindex "common option syntax"
4915 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4916 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4917 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4918 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4919 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4920 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4921 space) and then the value. For example:
4922 .code
4923 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4924 .endd
4925 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4926 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4927 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4928 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4929 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4930 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4931 word &"hide"&. For example:
4932 .code
4933 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4934 .endd
4935 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4936 .code
4937 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4938 .endd
4939 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4940 all instances of the same driver.
4941
4942 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4943 that are found in option settings.
4944
4945
4946 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4947 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4948 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4949 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4950 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4951 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4952 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4953 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4954 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4955 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4956 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4957 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4958 .code
4959 queue_only
4960 queue_only = true
4961 .endd
4962 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4963 .code
4964 no_queue_only
4965 queue_only = false
4966 .endd
4967 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4968
4969
4970
4971
4972 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4973 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4974 .cindex "format" "integer"
4975 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4976 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4977 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4978 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4979 hexadecimal number.
4980
4981 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4982 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4983 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4984 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4985 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4986 used.
4987
4988
4989 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4990 .cindex "integer format"
4991 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4992 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4993 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4994 Such options are always output in octal.
4995
4996
4997 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4998 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4999 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5000 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5001 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5002
5003
5004
5005 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5006 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5007 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5008 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5009 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5010
5011 .table2 30pt
5012 .irow &%s%& seconds
5013 .irow &%m%& minutes
5014 .irow &%h%& hours
5015 .irow &%d%& days
5016 .irow &%w%& weeks
5017 .endtable
5018
5019 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5020 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5021 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5022
5023
5024
5025 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5026 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5027 .cindex "format" "string"
5028 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5029 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5030 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5031 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5032 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5033 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5034 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5035 therefore equivalent:
5036 .code
5037 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5038 trusted_users = uucp:\
5039 # This comment line is ignored
5040 mail
5041 .endd
5042 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5043 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5044 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5045 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5046 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5047
5048 .table2 100pt
5049 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5050 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5051 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5052 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5053 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5054 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5055 character"
5056 .endtable
5057
5058 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5059 character, that character replaces the pair.
5060
5061 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5062 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5063 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5064 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5065 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5066 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5067
5068
5069 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5070 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5071 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5072 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5073 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5074 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5075 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5076 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5077 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5078 within a quoted configuration string.
5079
5080
5081 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5082 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5083 .cindex "format" "user name"
5084 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5085 .cindex "format" "group name"
5086 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5087 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5088 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5089 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5090
5091
5092 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5093 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5094 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5095 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5096 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5097 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5098 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5099 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5100 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5101 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5102 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5103
5104 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5105 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5106 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5107 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5108 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5109 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5110 example, the list
5111 .code
5112 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5113 .endd
5114 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5115
5116 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5117 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5118 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5119 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5120
5121 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5122 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5123 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5124 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5125 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5126 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5127 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5128 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5129 .code
5130 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5131 .endd
5132 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5133 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5134 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5135
5136 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5137 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5138 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5139 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5140 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5141 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5142 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5143 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5144 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5145 .code
5146 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5147 .endd
5148 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5149 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5150 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5151 the value in quotes. For example:
5152 .code
5153 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5154 .endd
5155 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5156 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5157 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5158 enclosing an empty list item.
5159
5160
5161
5162 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5163 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5164 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5165 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5166 .code
5167 senders = user@domain :
5168 .endd
5169 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5170 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5171 items, the second of which is empty:
5172 .code
5173 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5174 .endd
5175 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5176 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5177 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5178 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5179 .code
5180 senders = :
5181 .endd
5182 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5183 is at the end of the list.
5184
5185
5186
5187
5188 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5189 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5190 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5191 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5192 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5193 a sequence of lines like this:
5194 .display
5195 <&'instance name'&>:
5196 <&'option'&>
5197 ...
5198 <&'option'&>
5199 .endd
5200 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5201 followed by three options settings:
5202 .code
5203 localuser:
5204 driver = accept
5205 check_local_user
5206 transport = local_delivery
5207 .endd
5208 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5209 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5210 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5211 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5212 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5213 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5214
5215 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5216 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5217
5218 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5219 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5220 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5221 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5222 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5223 server.
5224
5225 .cindex "generic options"
5226 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5227 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5228 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5229 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5230 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5231 .cindex "private options"
5232 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5233 they all have default values.
5234
5235 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5236 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5237 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5238
5239 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5240 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5241 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5242 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5243 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5244 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5245 configuration lines:
5246 .code
5247 remote_smtp:
5248 driver = smtp
5249 .endd
5250 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5251 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5252 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5253 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5254 thus:
5255 .code
5256 special_smtp:
5257 driver = smtp
5258 port = 1234
5259 command_timeout = 10s
5260 .endd
5261 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5262 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5263 lines.
5264
5265 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5266 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5267 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5268 option.
5269
5270
5271
5272
5273
5274
5275 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5277
5278 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5279 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5280 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5281 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5282 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5283 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5284 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5285 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5286 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5287 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5288 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5289
5290
5291
5292 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5293 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5294 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5295 the line
5296 .code
5297 # primary_hostname =
5298 .endd
5299 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5300 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5301 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5302 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5303
5304 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5305 .code
5306 domainlist local_domains = @
5307 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5308 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5309 .endd
5310 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5311 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5312 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5313 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5314
5315 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5316 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5317 on the local host.
5318
5319 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5320 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5321 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5322 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5323 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5324 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5325
5326 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5327 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5328 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5329 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5330 domain is permitted.
5331
5332 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5333 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5334 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5335 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5336 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5337 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5338
5339 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5340 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5341 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5342
5343 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5344 .code
5345 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5346 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5347 .endd
5348 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5349 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5350 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5351 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5352 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5353 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5354 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5355 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5356 contents of a message to be checked.
5357
5358 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5359 .code
5360 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5361 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5362 .endd
5363 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5364 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5365 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5366 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5367
5368 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5369 .code
5370 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5371 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5372 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5373 .endd
5374 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5375 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5376 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5377 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5378 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5379 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5380 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5381
5382 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5383 .code
5384 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5385 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5386 .endd
5387 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5388 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5389 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5390 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5391 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5392 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5393 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5394 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5395 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5396 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5397 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5398 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5399 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5400 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5401 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5402 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5403
5404 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5405 .code
5406 # qualify_domain =
5407 # qualify_recipient =
5408 .endd
5409 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5410 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5411 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5412 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5413 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5414 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5415
5416 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5417 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5418 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5419 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5420 .code
5421 # allow_domain_literals
5422 .endd
5423 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5424 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5425 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5426 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5427 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5428 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5429
5430 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5431 .code
5432 never_users = root
5433 .endd
5434 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5435 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5436 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5437 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5438 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5439 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5440 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5441 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5442
5443 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5444 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5445 line,
5446 .code
5447 host_lookup = *
5448 .endd
5449 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5450 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5451 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5452 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5453 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5454 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5455 unreachable.
5456
5457 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5458 1413 (hence their names):
5459 .code
5460 rfc1413_hosts = *
5461 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5462 .endd
5463 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5464 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5465 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5466 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5467 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5468 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5469 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5470
5471 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5472 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5473 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5474 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5475 .code
5476 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5477 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5478 .endd
5479 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5480 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5481
5482 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5483 .code
5484 # percent_hack_domains =
5485 .endd
5486 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5487 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5488 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5489
5490 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5491 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5492 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5493 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5494 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5495 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5496 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5497 always bounce messages.
5498 .code
5499 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5500 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5501 .endd
5502 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5503 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5504 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5505 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5506 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5507
5508
5509
5510 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5511 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5512 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5513 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5514 It starts with the line
5515 .code
5516 begin acl
5517 .endd
5518 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5519 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5520 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5521
5522 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5523 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5524 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5525 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5526 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5527 result of the ACL processing.
5528 .code
5529 acl_check_rcpt:
5530 .endd
5531 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5532 ACL, and names it.
5533 .code
5534 accept hosts = :
5535 .endd
5536 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5537 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5538 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5539 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5540 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5541 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5542
5543 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5544 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5545 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5546 manner.
5547 .code
5548 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5549 domains = +local_domains
5550 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5551
5552 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5553 domains = !+local_domains
5554 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5555 .endd
5556 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5557 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5558 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5559 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5560 in Internet mail addresses.
5561
5562 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5563 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5564 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5565 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5566 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5567 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5568 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5569 policy of being as safe as possible.
5570
5571 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5572 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5573 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5574 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5575 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5576 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5577
5578 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5579 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5580 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5581 have to modify this rule.
5582
5583 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5584 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5585 common convention of local parts constructed as
5586 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5587 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5588 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5589 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5590 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5591 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5592
5593 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5594 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5595 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5596 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5597 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5598 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5599 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5600 .code
5601 accept local_parts = postmaster
5602 domains = +local_domains
5603 .endd
5604 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5605 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5606 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5607 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5608 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5609
5610 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5611 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5612 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5613 .code
5614 require verify = sender
5615 .endd
5616 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5617 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5618 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5619 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5620 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5621 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5622 discusses the details of address verification.
5623 .code
5624 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5625 control = submission
5626 .endd
5627 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5628 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5629 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5630 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5631 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5632 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5633 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5634 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5635 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5636 .code
5637 accept authenticated = *
5638 control = submission
5639 .endd
5640 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5641 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5642 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5643 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5644 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5645 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5646 .code
5647 require message = relay not permitted
5648 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5649 .endd
5650 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5651 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5652 .code
5653 require verify = recipient
5654 .endd
5655 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5656 fails, the address is rejected.
5657 .code
5658 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5659 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5660 # $dnslist_text
5661 # dnslists = black.list.example
5662 #
5663 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5664 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5665 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5666 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5667 .endd
5668 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5669 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5670 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5671 line.
5672 .code
5673 # require verify = csa
5674 .endd
5675 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5676 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5677 records.
5678 .code
5679 accept
5680 .endd
5681 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5682 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5683 .code
5684 acl_check_data:
5685 .endd
5686 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5687 of this ACL are commented out:
5688 .code
5689 # deny malware = *
5690 # message = This message contains a virus \
5691 # ($malware_name).
5692 .endd
5693 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5694 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5695 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5696 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5697 .code
5698 # warn spam = nobody
5699 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5700 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5701 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5702 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5703 .endd
5704 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5705 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5706 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5707 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5708 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5709 whatever the spam score.
5710 .code
5711 accept
5712 .endd
5713 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5714
5715
5716 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5717 .cindex "default" "routers"
5718 .cindex "routers" "default"
5719 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5720 by the line
5721 .code
5722 begin routers
5723 .endd
5724 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5725 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5726 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5727 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5728 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5729 .code
5730 # domain_literal:
5731 # driver = ipliteral
5732 # domains = !+local_domains
5733 # transport = remote_smtp
5734 .endd
5735 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5736 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5737 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5738 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5739 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5740 .code
5741 dnslookup:
5742 driver = dnslookup
5743 domains = ! +local_domains
5744 transport = remote_smtp
5745 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5746 no_more
5747 .endd
5748 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5749 domains. This is specified by the line
5750 .code
5751 domains = ! +local_domains
5752 .endd
5753 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5754 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5755 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5756 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5757 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5758 passed on to the following routers.
5759
5760 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5761 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5762 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5763 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5764 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5765
5766 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5767 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5768 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5769 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5770 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5771 the address fails and is bounced.
5772
5773 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5774 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5775 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5776 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5777 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5778 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5779 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5780 out.
5781 .code
5782 system_aliases:
5783 driver = redirect
5784 allow_fail
5785 allow_defer
5786 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5787 # user = exim
5788 file_transport = address_file
5789 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5790 .endd
5791 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5792 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5793 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5794 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5795 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5796 the next router.
5797
5798 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5799 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5800 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5801 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5802 .code
5803 userforward:
5804 driver = redirect
5805 check_local_user
5806 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5807 # local_part_suffix_optional
5808 file = $home/.forward
5809 # allow_filter
5810 no_verify
5811 no_expn
5812 check_ancestor
5813 file_transport = address_file
5814 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5815 reply_transport = address_reply
5816 .endd
5817 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5818 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5819 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5820 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5821 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5822 namely:
5823 .code
5824 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5825 # local_part_suffix_optional
5826 .endd
5827 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5828 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5829 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5830 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5831 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5832 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5833 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5834
5835 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5836 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5837 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5838 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5839
5840 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5841 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5842 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5843 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5844 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5845 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5846 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5847
5848 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5849 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5850 There are two reasons for doing this:
5851
5852 .olist
5853 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5854 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5855 unnecessary work.
5856 .next
5857 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5858 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5859 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5860 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5861 this time.
5862 .endlist
5863
5864 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5865 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5866 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5867 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5868
5869 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5870 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5871 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5872 .code
5873 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5874 .endd
5875 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5876 transport.
5877 .code
5878 localuser:
5879 driver = accept
5880 check_local_user
5881 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5882 # local_part_suffix_optional
5883 transport = local_delivery
5884 .endd
5885 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5886 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5887 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5888 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5889 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5890
5891
5892 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5893 .cindex "default" "transports"
5894 .cindex "transports" "default"
5895 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5896 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5897 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5898 .code
5899 begin transports
5900 .endd
5901 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5902 .code
5903 remote_smtp:
5904 driver = smtp
5905 .endd
5906 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5907 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5908 .code
5909 local_delivery:
5910 driver = appendfile
5911 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5912 delivery_date_add
5913 envelope_to_add
5914 return_path_add
5915 # group = mail
5916 # mode = 0660
5917 .endd
5918 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5919 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5920 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5921 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5922 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5923 show how this can be done.
5924
5925 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5926 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5927 similarly-named options above.
5928 .code
5929 address_pipe:
5930 driver = pipe
5931 return_output
5932 .endd
5933 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5934 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5935 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5936 sender.
5937 .code
5938 address_file:
5939 driver = appendfile
5940 delivery_date_add
5941 envelope_to_add
5942 return_path_add
5943 .endd
5944 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5945 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5946 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5947 .code
5948 address_reply:
5949 driver = autoreply
5950 .endd
5951 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5952 filter files.
5953
5954
5955
5956 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5957 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5958 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5959 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5960 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5961 introduced by the line
5962 .code
5963 begin retry
5964 .endd
5965 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5966 errors:
5967 .code
5968 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5969 .endd
5970 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5971 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5972 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5973 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5974
5975 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5976 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5977 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5978
5979
5980 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5981 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5982 .code
5983 begin rewrite
5984 .endd
5985 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5986 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5987
5988
5989
5990 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5991 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5992 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5993 .code
5994 begin authenticators
5995 .endd
5996 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5997 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5998 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5999 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6000 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6001 to support most MUA software.
6002
6003 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6004 .code
6005 #PLAIN:
6006 # driver = plaintext
6007 # server_set_id = $auth2
6008 # server_prompts = :
6009 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6010 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
6011 .endd
6012 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6013 .code
6014 #LOGIN:
6015 # driver = plaintext
6016 # server_set_id = $auth1
6017 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6018 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6019 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
6020 .endd
6021
6022 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6023 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6024 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6025 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6026 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6027 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6028 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6029 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6030
6031 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6032 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6033 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6034 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6035
6036 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6037 usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
6038 covers both.
6039
6040 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6041
6042
6043
6044 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6045 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6046
6047 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6048
6049 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6050 .cindex "PCRE"
6051 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6052 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6053 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6054 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6055 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6056 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6057
6058 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6059 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6060 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6061 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6062 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6063 case-insensitive.
6064
6065 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6066 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6067 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6068 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6069 .code
6070 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6071 .endd
6072 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6073 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6074 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6075 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6076 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6077 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6078 matched.
6079
6080 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6081 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6082 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6083 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6084 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6085 match anywhere in the subject string.
6086
6087 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6088 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6089 .code
6090 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6091 .endd
6092 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6093 You need to use:
6094 .code
6095 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6096 .endd
6097 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6098 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6099
6100
6101
6102 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6103 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6104
6105 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6106 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6107 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6108 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6109 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6110 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6111
6112 .olist
6113 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6114 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6115 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6116 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6117 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6118 .next
6119 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6120 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6121 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6122 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6123 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6124 .endlist
6125
6126 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6127 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6128 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6129 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6130 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6131 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6132
6133 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6134 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6135 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6136 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6137 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6138 .code
6139 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6140 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6141 .endd
6142 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6143 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6144 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6145 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6146 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6147 .code
6148 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6149 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6150 .endd
6151 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6152 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6153
6154 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6155 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6156 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6157 .code
6158 domain1:
6159 domain2:
6160 .endd
6161 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6162 matches the list item.
6163
6164 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6165 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6166 .code
6167 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6168 .endd
6169 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6170 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6171 causes a second lookup to occur.
6172
6173 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6174 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6175 lookup is permitted.
6176
6177
6178 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6179 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6180 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6181 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6182
6183 .ilist
6184 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6185 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6186 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6187 .next
6188 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6189 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6190 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6191 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6192 .endlist
6193
6194 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6195 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6196 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6197 .code
6198 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6199 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6200 .endd
6201 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6202 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6203 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6204
6205
6206
6207
6208 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6209 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6210 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6211 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6212
6213 .ilist
6214 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6215 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6216 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6217 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6218 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6219 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6220 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6221 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6222 be found in several places:
6223 .display
6224 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6225 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6226 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6227 .endd
6228 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6229 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6230 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6231 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6232 .next
6233 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6234 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6235 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6236 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6237 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6238 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6239 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6240
6241 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6242 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6243 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6244 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6245 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6246 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6247 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6248 .new
6249 .next
6250 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6251 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6252 .cindex "sasldb2"
6253 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6254 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6255 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6256 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6257 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6258 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6259 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6260 .wen
6261 .next
6262 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6263 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6264 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6265 .cindex "Courier"
6266 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6267 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6268 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6269 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6270 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6271 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6272 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6273 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6274 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6275 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6276 .next
6277 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6278 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6279 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6280 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6281 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6282 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6283 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6284 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6285 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6286 .next
6287 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6288 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6289 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6290 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6291 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6292 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6293 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6294 .code
6295 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6296 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6297 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6298 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6299 .endd
6300 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6301 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6302 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6303 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6304 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6305
6306 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6307 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6308 lookup types support only literal keys.
6309
6310 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6311 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6312 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6313 .next
6314 .cindex "linear search"
6315 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6316 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6317 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6318 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6319 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6320 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6321 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6322 in the file is used.
6323
6324 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6325 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6326 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6327 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6328 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6329 colon, for example:
6330 .code
6331 baduser: :fail:
6332 .endd
6333 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6334 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6335 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6336 wildcarding of any kind.
6337
6338 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6339 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6340 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6341 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6342 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6343 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6344 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6345 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6346 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6347
6348 .next
6349 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6350 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6351 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6352 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6353 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6354 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6355 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6356 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6357
6358 .next
6359 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6360 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6361 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6362 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6363 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6364 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6365 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6366 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6367 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6368
6369 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6370 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6371 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6372 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6373
6374 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6375 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6376
6377 .olist
6378 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6379 .code
6380 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6381 *fish data for anythingfish
6382 .endd
6383 .next
6384 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6385 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6386 .code
6387 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6388 .endd
6389 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6390 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6391 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6392 .code
6393 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6394 .endd
6395 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6396 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6397 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6398 .code
6399 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6400 .endd
6401
6402 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6403 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6404 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6405 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6406 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6407
6408 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6409 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6410 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6411 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6412 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6413
6414 .next
6415 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6416 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6417 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6418 example:
6419 .code
6420 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6421 .endd
6422 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6423 .endlist olist
6424
6425 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6426 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6427 be followed by optional colons.
6428
6429 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6430 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6431 lookup types support only literal keys.
6432 .endlist ilist
6433
6434
6435 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6436 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6437 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6438 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6439 many of them are given in later sections.
6440
6441 .ilist
6442 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6443 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6444 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6445 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6446 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6447 .next
6448 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6449 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6450 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6451 .next
6452 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6453 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6454 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6455 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6456 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6457 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6458 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6459 .next
6460 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6461 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6462 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6463 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6464 .next
6465 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6466 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6467 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6468 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6469 .next
6470 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6471 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6472 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6473 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6474 .next
6475 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6476 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6477 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6478 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6479 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6480 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6481 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6482 password value. For example:
6483 .code
6484 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6485 .endd
6486 .next
6487 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6488 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6489 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6490 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6491
6492 .next
6493 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6494 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6495 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6496 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6497
6498 .next
6499 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6500 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6501 .next
6502 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6503 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6504 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6505 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6506 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6507 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6508 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6509 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6510 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6511 .code
6512 require condition = \
6513 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6514 .endd
6515 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6516 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6517 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6518 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6519 .endlist
6520
6521
6522
6523 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6524 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6525 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6526 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6527 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6528 options such as a list of local domains.
6529
6530 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6531 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6532 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6533 or may give up altogether.
6534
6535
6536
6537 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6538 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6539 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6540 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6541 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6542 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6543 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6544 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6545
6546 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6547 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6548 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6549
6550 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6551 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6552 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6553
6554 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6555 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6556 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6557 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6558 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6559 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6560 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6561 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6562 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6563 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6564 .code
6565 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6566 .endd
6567 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6568 looks up these keys, in this order:
6569 .code
6570 jane@eyre.example
6571 *@eyre.example
6572 *
6573 .endd
6574 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6575 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6576 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6577 Exim move on to try the next key.
6578
6579
6580
6581 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6582 .cindex "partial matching"
6583 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6584 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6585 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6586 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6587 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6588 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6589 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6590 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6591 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6592 a key in a DBM file is
6593 .code
6594 *.dates.fict.example
6595 .endd
6596 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6597 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6598 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6599 file.
6600
6601 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6602 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6603 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6604
6605 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6606 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6607 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6608 partial matching keys
6609 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6610 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6611 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6612
6613 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6614 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6615 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6616 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6617 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6618 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6619 remains.
6620
6621 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6622 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6623 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6624 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6625 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6626 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6627 .code
6628 2250.dates.fict.example
6629 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6630 *.dates.fict.example
6631 *.fict.example
6632 .endd
6633 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6634 finishes.
6635
6636 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6637 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6638 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6639 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6640 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6641 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6642 .code
6643 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6644 .endd
6645 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6646 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6647 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6648 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6649 .code
6650 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6651 .endd
6652 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6653 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6654
6655 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6656 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6657 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6658
6659 .ilist
6660 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6661 .next
6662 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6663 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6664 .next
6665 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6666 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6667 for &"*"& on its own.
6668 .next
6669 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6670 .endlist
6671
6672
6673 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6674 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6675 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6676 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6677 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6678 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6679 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6680
6681 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6682 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6683 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6684 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6685 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6686
6687
6688
6689
6690 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6691 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6692 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6693 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6694 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6695 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6696 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6697
6698 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6699 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6700 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6701 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6702 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6703 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6704
6705 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6706 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6707 complete.
6708
6709
6710
6711
6712 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6713 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6714 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6715 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6716 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6717 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6718 .code
6719 [name=$local_part]
6720 .endd
6721 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6722 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6723 .code
6724 [name="$local_part"]
6725 .endd
6726 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6727 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6728 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6729 of the following form is provided:
6730 .code
6731 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6732 .endd
6733 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6734 .code
6735 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6736 .endd
6737 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6738 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6739 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6740
6741
6742
6743
6744 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6745 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6746 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6747 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6748 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6749 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6750 an expansion string could contain:
6751 .code
6752 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6753 .endd
6754 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6755 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6756 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6757 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6758
6759 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6760 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6761 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6762 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6763 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6764 .code
6765 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6766 .endd
6767 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6768 altered and nothing is added.
6769
6770 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6771 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6772 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6773 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6774 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6775
6776 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6777 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6778 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6779 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6780 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6781 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6782 .code
6783 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6784 .endd
6785 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6786 white space is ignored.
6787
6788 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6789 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6790 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6791 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6792 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6793 .code
6794 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6795 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6796 .endd
6797 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6798 white space is ignored.
6799
6800 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6801 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6802 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6803 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6804 the pseudo-type MXH:
6805 .code
6806 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6807 .endd
6808 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6809 returned.
6810
6811 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6812 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6813 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6814 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6815 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6816 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6817 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6818 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6819 .code
6820 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6821 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6822 .endd
6823 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6824 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6825 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6826
6827 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6828 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6829 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6830 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6831 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6832 such a list.
6833
6834 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6835 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6836 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6837 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6838 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6839 result of a successful lookup such as:
6840 .code
6841 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6842 .endd
6843 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6844 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6845 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6846
6847
6848 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6849 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6850 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6851 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6852 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6853 .code
6854 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6855 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6856 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6857 .endd
6858 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6859 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6860 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6861 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6862
6863 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6864 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6865 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6866
6867 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6868 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6869 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6870 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6871 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6872 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6873 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6874 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6875 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6876 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6877 .code
6878 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6879 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6880 .endd
6881 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6882 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6883
6884
6885
6886
6887 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6888 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6889 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6890 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6891 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6892 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6893 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6894 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6895 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6896 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6897 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6898 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6899 .code
6900 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6901 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6902 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6903 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6904 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6905 .endd
6906 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6907 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6908
6909 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6910 the way they handle the results of a query:
6911
6912 .ilist
6913 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6914 gives an error.
6915 .next
6916 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6917 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6918 .next
6919 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6920 from all of them are returned.
6921 .endlist
6922
6923
6924 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6925 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6926 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6927 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6928
6929
6930 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6931 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6932 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6933 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6934 .code
6935 data = ${lookup ldap \
6936 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6937 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6938 .endd
6939 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6940 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6941 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6942 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6943
6944 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
6945 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
6946 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
6947
6948
6949 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6950 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6951 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6952 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6953 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6954 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6955
6956 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6957 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6958 the string:
6959 .code
6960 * => \2A
6961 ( => \28
6962 ) => \29
6963 \ => \5C
6964 .endd
6965 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6966 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6967 .code
6968 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
6969 .endd
6970 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6971 .code
6972 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6973 .endd
6974 yields
6975 .code
6976 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6977 .endd
6978 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6979 .code
6980 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6981 .endd
6982 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6983 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6984 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6985 .code
6986 , + " \ < > ;
6987 .endd
6988 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6989 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6990 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6991 .code
6992 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6993 .endd
6994 yields
6995 .code
6996 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6997 .endd
6998 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6999 .code
7000 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7001 .endd
7002 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7003 authentication below.
7004
7005
7006 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7007 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7008 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7009 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7010 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7011 by starting it with
7012 .code
7013 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7014 .endd
7015 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7016 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7017 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7018 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7019 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7020 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7021 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7022 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7023 failures, and timeouts.
7024
7025 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7026 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7027 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7028 doubled. For example
7029 .code
7030 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7031 .endd
7032 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7033 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7034 the local host) is used.
7035
7036 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7037 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7038 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7039 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7040 not available.
7041
7042 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7043 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7044 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7045 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7046 .code
7047 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7048 .endd
7049 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7050 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7051 .code
7052 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7053 .endd
7054 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7055 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7056 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7057 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7058 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7059 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7060 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7061 backup host.
7062
7063 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7064 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7065 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7066
7067 .ilist
7068 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7069 interface.
7070 .next
7071 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7072 .endlist
7073
7074
7075 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7076 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7077
7078
7079
7080 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7081 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7082 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7083 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7084 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7085 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7086 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7087 them. The following names are recognized:
7088 .display
7089 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7090 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7091 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7092 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7093 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7094 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7095 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7096 .endd
7097 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7098 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7099 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7100 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7101
7102 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7103 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7104 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7105 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7106 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7107 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7108 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7109 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7110 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7111
7112 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7113 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7114
7115
7116 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7117 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7118 .code
7119 ${lookup ldap
7120 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7121 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7122 {$value}fail}
7123 .endd
7124 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7125 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7126 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7127 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7128
7129 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7130 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7131 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7132
7133 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7134 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7135 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7136 quoting has two advantages:
7137
7138 .ilist
7139 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7140 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7141 .next
7142 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7143 .endlist
7144
7145 For example, a setting such as
7146 .code
7147 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7148 .endd
7149 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7150
7151 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7152 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7153 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7154 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7155 .code
7156 PASS=${quote:$3}
7157 .endd
7158 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7159 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7160 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7161
7162
7163
7164 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7165 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7166 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7167 as a sequence of values, for example
7168 .code
7169 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7170 .endd
7171 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7172 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7173 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7174 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7175 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7176 directory.
7177
7178 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7179 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7180 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7181
7182 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7183 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7184 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7185 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7186 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7187 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7188 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7189
7190 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7191 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7192 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7193 .code
7194 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7195 value1.1, value1.2
7196
7197 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7198 value two
7199
7200 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7201 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7202
7203 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7204 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7205 .endd
7206 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7207 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7208 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7209 results of LDAP lookups.
7210
7211
7212
7213
7214 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7215 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7216 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7217 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7218 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7219 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7220 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7221 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7222 .code
7223 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7224 .endd
7225 might return the string
7226 .code
7227 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7228 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7229 .endd
7230 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7231 .code
7232 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7233 .endd
7234 would just return
7235 .code
7236 Martin Guerre
7237 .endd
7238 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7239 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7240 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7241
7242
7243
7244 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7245 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7246 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7247 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7248 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7249 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7250 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7251 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7252 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7253 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7254 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7255 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7256 might be
7257 .code
7258 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7259 {$value}fail}
7260 .endd
7261 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7262 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7263 .code
7264 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7265 {$value}}
7266 .endd
7267 might be
7268 .code
7269 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7270 .endd
7271 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7272 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7273 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7274 .code
7275 Mister X
7276 .endd
7277 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7278 with a newline between the data for each row.
7279
7280
7281 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7282 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7283 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7284 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7285 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7286 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7287 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7288 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7289 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7290 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7291 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7292 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7293 information.
7294 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7295 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7296 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7297 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7298 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7299 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7300 .code
7301 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7302 .endd
7303 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7304 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7305 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7306 .code
7307 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7308 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7309 .endd
7310 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7311 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7312 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7313 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7314 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7315 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7316
7317 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7318 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7319 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7320 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7321 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7322 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7323 characters are not special.
7324
7325 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7326 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7327 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7328 done by starting the query with
7329 .display
7330 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7331 .endd
7332 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7333 .olist
7334 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7335 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7336 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7337 taken from there.
7338 .next
7339 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7340 .endlist
7341 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7342 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7343 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7344
7345 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7346 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7347 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7348 like this:
7349 .code
7350 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7351 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7352 master/db/name/pw
7353 .endd
7354 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7355 .code
7356 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7357 .endd
7358 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7359 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7360 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7361 .code
7362 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7363 .endd
7364
7365
7366 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7367 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7368 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7369 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7370 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7371 .display
7372 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7373 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7374 .endd
7375 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7376 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7377
7378 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7379 the queries.
7380
7381 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7382 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7383
7384 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7385 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7386 is zero because no rows are affected.
7387
7388
7389 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7390 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7391 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7392 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7393 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7394 looks like this:
7395 .code
7396 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7397 .endd
7398 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7399 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7400 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7401
7402 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7403 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7404 affected.
7405
7406 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7407 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7408 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7409 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7410 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7411 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7412 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7413 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7414 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7415 .code
7416 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7417 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7418 .endd
7419 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7420 .code
7421 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7422 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7423 .endd
7424 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7425 quote, which it doubles.
7426
7427 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7428 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7429 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7430 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7431 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7432 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7433 option.
7434 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7435 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7436
7437
7438 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7440
7441 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7442 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7443 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7444 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7445 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7446 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7447 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7448 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7449 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7450
7451 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7452 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7453 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7454 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7455
7456
7457
7458 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7459 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7460 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7461 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7462 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7463 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7464 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7465 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7466
7467
7468 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7469 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7470 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7471
7472 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7473 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7474 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7475 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7476 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7477 .code
7478 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7479 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7480 .endd
7481 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7482 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7483 senders based on the receiving domain.
7484
7485
7486
7487
7488 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7489 .cindex "list" "negation"
7490 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7491 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7492 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7493 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7494 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7495 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7496
7497 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7498 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7499 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7500 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7501 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7502 .code
7503 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7504 .endd
7505 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7506 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7507 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7508 .code
7509 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7510 .endd
7511 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7512 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7513 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7514
7515 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7516 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7517 item.
7518
7519
7520
7521 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7522 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7523 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7524 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7525 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7526 file names are not allowed,
7527 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7528 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7529 lines:
7530
7531 .ilist
7532 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7533 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7534 .next
7535 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7536 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7537 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7538 .code
7539 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7540 .endd
7541 .endlist
7542
7543 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7544 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7545 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7546 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7547
7548 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7549 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7550 .code
7551 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7552 .endd
7553 and the file contains the lines
7554 .code
7555 !a.b.c
7556 *.b.c
7557 .endd
7558 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7559 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7560
7561
7562
7563 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7564 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7565 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7566 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7567 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7568 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7569 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7570 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7571
7572 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7573 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7574 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7575 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7576
7577
7578
7579
7580 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7581 .cindex "named lists"
7582 .cindex "list" "named"
7583 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7584 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7585 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7586 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7587 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7588 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7589 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7590 .code
7591 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7592 .endd
7593 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7594 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7595 configured with the line
7596 .code
7597 domains = +local_domains
7598 .endd
7599 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7600 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7601 .code
7602 dnslookup:
7603 driver = dnslookup
7604 domains = ! +local_domains
7605 transport = remote_smtp
7606 no_more
7607 .endd
7608 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7609 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7610 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7611 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7612 .code
7613 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7614 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7615 .endd
7616 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7617 .code
7618 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7619 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7620 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7621 .endd
7622 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7623 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7624 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7625 .code
7626 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7627 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7628 .endd
7629 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7630 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7631 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7632 .code
7633 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7634 .endd
7635 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7636 referenced lists if you can.
7637
7638 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7639 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7640 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7641 .code
7642 domains = +local_domains
7643 .endd
7644 on several of your routers
7645 or in several ACL statements,
7646 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7647 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7648 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7649 the same each time they are referenced.
7650
7651 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7652 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7653 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7654 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7655
7656
7657
7658 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7659 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7660 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7661 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7662 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7663 write
7664 .code
7665 ALIST = host1 : host2
7666 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7667 .endd
7668 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7669 .code
7670 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7671 .endd
7672 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7673 list, and write
7674 .code
7675 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7676 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7677 .endd
7678 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7679 .code
7680 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7681 .endd
7682
7683
7684 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7685 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7686 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7687 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7688 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7689 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7690 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7691 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7692 message. For example:
7693 .code
7694 domainlist special_domains = \
7695 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7696 .endd
7697 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7698 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7699 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7700 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7701 same list each time.
7702
7703 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7704 cache the result anyway. For example:
7705 .code
7706 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7707 .endd
7708 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7709 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7710
7711
7712
7713 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7714 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7715 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7716 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7717 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7718
7719 .ilist
7720 .cindex "primary host name"
7721 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7722 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7723 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7724 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7725 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7726 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7727 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7728 differ only in their names.
7729 .next
7730 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7731 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7732 .cindex "domain literal"
7733 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7734 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7735 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7736 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7737 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7738 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7739 .next
7740 .cindex "@mx_any"
7741 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7742 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7743 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7744 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7745 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7746 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7747 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7748 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7749 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7750 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7751 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7752
7753 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7754 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7755 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7756 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7757 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7758
7759 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7760 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7761 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7762 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7763 on a router). For example:
7764 .code
7765 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7766 .endd
7767 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7768 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7769
7770 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7771 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7772 contain negative items.
7773
7774 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7775 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7776 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7777 .code
7778 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7779 an.other.domain : ...
7780 .endd
7781 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7782 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7783 .code
7784 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7785 an.other.domain ? ...
7786 .endd
7787 .next
7788 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7789 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7790 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7791 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7792 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7793 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7794 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7795 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7796 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7797 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7798
7799 .next
7800 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7801 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7802 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7803 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7804 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7805 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7806 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7807 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7808 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7809
7810 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7811 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7812 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7813 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7814 expression by expansion, of course).
7815 .next
7816 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7817 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7818 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7819 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7820 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7821 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7822 .code
7823 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7824 .endd
7825 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7826 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7827 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7828 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7829 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7830 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7831 other statements in the same ACL.
7832
7833 .next
7834 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7835 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7836 .code
7837 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7838 .endd
7839 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7840 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7841
7842 .next
7843 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7844 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7845 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7846 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7847 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7848 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7849 expansion variable.
7850 .next
7851 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7852 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7853 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7854 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7855 .code
7856 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7857 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7858 .endd
7859 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7860 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7861 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7862 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7863 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7864 .next
7865 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7866 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7867 between the pattern and the domain.
7868 .endlist
7869
7870 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7871 .code
7872 domainlist funny_domains = \
7873 @ : \
7874 lib.unseen.edu : \
7875 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7876 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7877 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7878 nis;domains.byname : \
7879 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7880 .endd
7881 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7882 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7883 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7884 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7885 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7886 patterns earlier.
7887
7888
7889
7890 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7891 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7892 .cindex "list" "host list"
7893 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7894 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7895 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7896 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7897 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7898 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7899 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7900
7901
7902 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7903 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7904 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7905 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7906 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7907 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7908 not used.
7909
7910 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7911 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7912 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7913
7914
7915
7916 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7917 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7918 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7919 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7920 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7921 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7922 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7923 concerns.)
7924
7925 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7926 inspecting its IP address:
7927
7928 .ilist
7929 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7930 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7931 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7932 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7933 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7934 with the IP address of the subject host.
7935
7936 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7937 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7938 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7939 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7940 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7941
7942 .next
7943 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7944 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7945 domain name, as just described.
7946
7947 .next
7948 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7949 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7950 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7951 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7952 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7953 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7954 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7955 that can never match a client host.
7956
7957 .next
7958 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7959 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7960 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7961 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7962 .code
7963 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7964 accept hosts = @[]
7965 .endd
7966 .next
7967 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7968 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7969 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7970 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7971 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7972 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7973 significant end of the address.
7974
7975 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7976 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7977 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7978 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7979 .code
7980 192.168.23.236/31
7981 .endd
7982 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7983 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7984 matches.
7985
7986 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7987 .code
7988 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7989 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7990 .endd
7991 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7992 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7993 For example:
7994 .code
7995 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7996 .endd
7997 could make use of a file containing
7998 .code
7999 172.16.0.0/12
8000 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8001 .endd
8002 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8003 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8004 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8005 .code
8006 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8007 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8008 .endd
8009 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8010 list.
8011 .endlist
8012
8013
8014
8015 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8016 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8017 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8018 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8019 address, the pattern takes this form:
8020 .display
8021 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8022 .endd
8023 For example:
8024 .code
8025 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8026 .endd
8027 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8028 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8029 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8030 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8031 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8032 returned by the lookup is not used.
8033
8034 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8035 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8036 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8037 patterns of this form:
8038 .display
8039 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8040 .endd
8041 For example:
8042 .code
8043 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8044 .endd
8045 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8046 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8047 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8048 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8049 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8050
8051 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8052 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8053 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8054 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8055 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8056 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8057 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8058 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8059 addresses are always used.
8060
8061 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8062 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8063 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8064 configurations.
8065
8066 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8067 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8068 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8069 case the IP address is used on its own.
8070
8071
8072
8073 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8074 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8075 .cindex "unknown host name"
8076 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8077 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8078 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8079 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8080 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8081 above.)
8082
8083 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8084 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8085 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8086 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8087 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8088 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8089 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8090
8091 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8092 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8093
8094 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8095 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8096 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8097 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8098 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8099 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8100 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8101 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8102 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8103
8104 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8105 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8106
8107 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8108 .cindex "alias for host"
8109 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8110 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8111
8112 .ilist
8113 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8114 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8115 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8116 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8117 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8118 expression.
8119 .next
8120 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8121 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8122 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8123 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8124 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8125 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8126 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8127 example,
8128 .code
8129 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8130 .endd
8131 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8132 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8133 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8134 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8135 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8136 .code
8137 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8138 .endd
8139 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8140 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8141 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8142 required.
8143 .endlist
8144
8145
8146
8147
8148 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8149 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8150 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8151 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8152 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8153 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8154
8155 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8156 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8157
8158 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8159 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8160 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8161 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8162 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8163 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8164
8165 .ilist
8166 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8167 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8168 .code
8169 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8170 .endd
8171 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8172 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8173
8174 .next
8175 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8176 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8177 example:
8178 .code
8179 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8180 192.168.4.5
8181 .endd
8182 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8183 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8184 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8185 .endlist
8186
8187 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8188 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8189 list.
8190
8191
8192 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8193 "SECTtemdnserr"
8194 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8195 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8196 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8197 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8198 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8199 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8200 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8201 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8202 host lists such as whitelists.
8203
8204
8205
8206 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8207 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8208 .cindex "unknown host name"
8209 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8210 If a pattern is of the form
8211 .display
8212 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8213 .endd
8214 for example
8215 .code
8216 dbm;/host/accept/list
8217 .endd
8218 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8219 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8220 is not used.
8221
8222 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8223 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8224 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8225 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8226 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8227 lookup, both using the same file.
8228
8229
8230
8231 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8232 If a pattern is of the form
8233 .display
8234 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8235 .endd
8236 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8237 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8238 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8239 .code
8240 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8241 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8242 .endd
8243 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8244 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8245 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8246 operator.
8247
8248 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8249 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8250 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8251
8252 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8253 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8254 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8255 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8256 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8257 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8258
8259
8260
8261 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8262 "SECTmixwilhos"
8263 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8264 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8265 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8266 ACL you could have:
8267 .code
8268 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8269 .endd
8270 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8271 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8272 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8273 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8274 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8275 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8276
8277 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8278 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8279 .code
8280 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8281 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8282 .endd
8283 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8284 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8285
8286
8287
8288
8289
8290 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8291 .cindex "list" "address list"
8292 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8293 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8294 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8295 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8296 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8297 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8298 using this option setting:
8299 .code
8300 senders = :
8301 .endd
8302 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8303 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8304 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8305 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8306
8307 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8308 example:
8309 .code
8310 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8311 .endd
8312 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8313 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8314 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8315 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8316 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8317 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8318 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8319 .code
8320 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8321 *@+hostile_domains:\
8322 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8323 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8324 .endd
8325 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8326 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8327 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8328 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8329 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8330
8331 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8332 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8333 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8334 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8335 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8336 .code
8337 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8338 .endd
8339
8340 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8341 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8342 senders:
8343
8344 .ilist
8345 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8346 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8347 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8348 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8349 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8350 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8351 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8352 .code
8353 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8354 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8355 .endd
8356 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8357 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8358
8359 .next
8360 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8361 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8362 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8363 example:
8364 .code
8365 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8366 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8367 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8368 .endd
8369 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8370 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8371 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8372 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8373
8374 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8375 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8376 panic log.
8377 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8378 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8379 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8380 default. For example, with this lookup:
8381 .code
8382 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8383 .endd
8384 the file could contains lines like this:
8385 .code
8386 user1@domain1.example
8387 *@domain2.example
8388 .endd
8389 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8390 that are tried is:
8391 .code
8392 nimrod@jaeger.example
8393 *@jaeger.example
8394 *
8395 .endd
8396 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8397 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8398
8399 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8400 .code
8401 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8402 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8403 .endd
8404 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8405 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8406 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8407 .endlist
8408
8409
8410 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8411 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8412 always fails.
8413
8414
8415 .ilist
8416 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8417 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8418 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8419 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8420 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8421 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8422 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8423 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8424 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8425
8426 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8427 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8428 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8429 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8430 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8431 with
8432 .code
8433 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8434 .endd
8435 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8436 .code
8437 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8438 .endd
8439 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8440
8441 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8442 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8443 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8444 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8445 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8446 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8447 .code
8448 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8449 spammer3 : spammer4
8450 .endd
8451 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8452 doubling.
8453
8454 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8455 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8456 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8457 might have entries like
8458 .code
8459 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8460 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8461 *: ^\d{8}$
8462 .endd
8463 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8464 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8465 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8466 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8467
8468 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8469 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8470 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8471
8472 .next
8473 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8474 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8475 can only return a single list of local parts.
8476 .endlist
8477
8478 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8479 in these two examples:
8480 .code
8481 senders = +my_list
8482 senders = *@+my_list
8483 .endd
8484 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8485 example it is a named domain list.
8486
8487
8488
8489
8490 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8491 .cindex "case of local parts"
8492 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8493 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8494 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8495 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8496 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8497 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8498 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8499 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8500 default.
8501
8502 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8503 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8504 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8505 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8506 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8507 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8508 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8509 case-independent.
8510
8511 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8512 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8513 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8514 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8515 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8516 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8517 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8518 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8519
8520
8521
8522 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8523 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8524 .cindex "local part" "list"
8525 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8526 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8527 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8528 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8529 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8530 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8531 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8532 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8533
8534 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8535 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8536 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8537 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8538 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8539 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8540 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8541 types.
8542 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8543
8544
8545
8546
8547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8549
8550 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8551 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8552 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8553 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8554
8555 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8556 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8557 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8558 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8559 escape character, as described in the following section.
8560
8561 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8562 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8563 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8564 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8565 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8566 reasons.
8567
8568
8569
8570 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8571 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8572 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8573 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8574 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8575 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8576 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8577 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8578
8579 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8580 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8581 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8582 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8583 .code
8584 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8585 .endd
8586 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8587 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8588 string.
8589
8590
8591
8592 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8593 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8594 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8595 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8596 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8597 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8598 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8599 encoding.
8600
8601 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8602 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8603 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8604
8605
8606 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8607 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8608 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8609 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8610 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8611 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8612 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8613 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8614 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8615 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8616 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8617 and &%nhash%&.
8618
8619 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8620 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8621 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8622
8623 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8624 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8625 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8626 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8627 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8628 .code
8629 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8630 .endd
8631 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8632 Exim message identifier. For example:
8633 .code
8634 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8635 .endd
8636 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8637 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8638
8639
8640 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8641 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8642 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8643 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8644 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8645 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8646 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8647 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8648 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8649 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8650 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8651 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8652 being expanded.
8653
8654
8655
8656
8657 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8658 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8659 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8660 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8661 white space is significant.
8662
8663 .vlist
8664 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8665 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8666 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8667 .code
8668 $local_part
8669 ${domain}
8670 .endd
8671 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8672 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8673 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8674 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8675 given, the expansion fails.
8676
8677 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8678 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8679 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8680 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8681 .code
8682 ${lc:$local_part}
8683 .endd
8684 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8685 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8686 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8687 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8688 string easier to understand.
8689
8690 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8691 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8692 expansion item below.
8693
8694 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8695 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8696 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8697 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8698 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8699 .code
8700 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8701 .endd
8702 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8703 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8704 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8705
8706 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8707 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8708 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8709 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8710 must have the following type:
8711 .code
8712 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8713 .endd
8714 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8715 function should return one of the following values:
8716
8717 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8718 into the expanded string that is being built.
8719
8720 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8721 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8722
8723 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8724 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8725
8726 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8727
8728 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8729 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8730 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8731
8732 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8733 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8734 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8735 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8736 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8737 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8738 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8739 form:
8740 .display
8741 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8742 .endd
8743 .vindex "&$value$&"
8744 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8745 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8746 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8747 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8748 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8749 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8750 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8751 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8752 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8753
8754 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8755 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8756 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8757 yield &"2001"&:
8758 .code
8759 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8760 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8761 .endd
8762 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8763 appear, for example:
8764 .code
8765 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8766 .endd
8767 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8768 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8769
8770
8771 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8772 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8773 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8774 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8775 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8776 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8777 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8778 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8779 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8780 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8781 <&'string3'&> as before.
8782
8783 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8784 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8785 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8786 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8787 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8788 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8789 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8790 provided. For example:
8791 .code
8792 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8793 .endd
8794 yields &"42"&, and
8795 .code
8796 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8797 .endd
8798 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8799 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8800
8801
8802 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8803 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8804 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8805 .vindex "&$item$&"
8806 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8807 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8808 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8809 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8810 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8811 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8812 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8813 .code
8814 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8815 .endd
8816 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8817 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8818
8819
8820 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8821 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8822 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8823 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8824 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8825 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8826
8827 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8828 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8829 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8830 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8831 .code
8832 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8833 .endd
8834 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8835 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8836 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8837 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8838 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8839 .code
8840 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8841 .endd
8842 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8843 letters appear. For example:
8844 .display
8845 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8846 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8847 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8848 .endd
8849
8850 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8851 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8852 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8853 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8854 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8855 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8856 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8857 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8858 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8859 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8860 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8861 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8862 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8863 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8864 .code
8865 $header_reply-to:
8866 .endd
8867 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8868 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8869 lines) may be present.
8870
8871 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8872 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8873
8874 .ilist
8875 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8876 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8877 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8878
8879 .next
8880 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8881 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8882 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8883 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8884 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8885 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8886 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8887 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8888
8889 .next
8890 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8891 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8892 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8893 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8894 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8895 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8896 .endlist ilist
8897
8898 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8899 command of the following form:
8900 .code
8901 headers charset "UTF-8"
8902 .endd
8903 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8904 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8905 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8906 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8907 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8908 ISO-8859-1.
8909
8910 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8911 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8912 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8913 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8914
8915 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8916 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8917 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8918 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8919 router or transport are not accessible.
8920
8921 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8922 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8923 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8924 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8925 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8926 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8927
8928 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8929 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8930 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8931 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8932 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8933 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8934 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8935
8936 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8937 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8938 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8939 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8940 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8941 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8942 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8943 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8944
8945
8946 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8947 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8948 .cindex &%hmac%&
8949 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8950 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8951 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8952 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8953 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8954 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8955 present. For example:
8956 .code
8957 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8958 .endd
8959 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8960 produces:
8961 .code
8962 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8963 .endd
8964 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8965 an Exim configuration:
8966 .code
8967 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8968 .endd
8969 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8970 .code
8971 headers_add = \
8972 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8973 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8974 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8975 .endd
8976 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8977 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8978 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8979 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8980 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8981 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8982
8983
8984 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8985 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8986 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8987 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8988 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8989 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8990 .code
8991 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8992 .endd
8993 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8994 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8995 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8996 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8997 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8998
8999 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9000 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9001 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9002 .code
9003 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9004 .endd
9005 you can use
9006 .code
9007 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9008 .endd
9009
9010 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9011 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9012 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9013 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9014 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9015 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9016 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9017 some of the braces:
9018 .code
9019 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9020 .endd
9021 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9022 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9023 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9024
9025
9026 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9027 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9028 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9029 described in the next item.
9030
9031 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9032 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9033 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9034 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9035 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9036 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9037 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9038 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9039 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9040
9041 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9042 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9043 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9044 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9045 out by the system administrator.
9046
9047 .vindex "&$value$&"
9048 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9049 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9050 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9051 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9052 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9053 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9054 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9055 original lookup fails.
9056
9057 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9058 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9059 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9060 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9061 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9062 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9063 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9064 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9065
9066 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9067 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9068 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9069 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9070
9071 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9072 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9073 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9074 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9075
9076 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9077 .code
9078 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9079 .endd
9080 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9081 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9082 .code
9083 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9084 {$value}fail}
9085 .endd
9086
9087
9088 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9089 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9090 .vindex "&$item$&"
9091 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9092 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9093 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9094 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9095 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9096 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9097 .code
9098 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9099 .endd
9100 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9101 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9102 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9103
9104 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9105 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9106 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9107 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9108 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9109 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9110 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9111 .code
9112 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9113 .endd
9114 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9115 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9116 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9117 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9118 example,
9119 .code
9120 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9121 .endd
9122 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9123
9124
9125
9126 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9127 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9128 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9129 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9130 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9131 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9132 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9133 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9134
9135 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9136 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9137 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9138 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9139 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9140 not its contents.
9141
9142 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9143 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9144 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9145
9146 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9147 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9148
9149
9150 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9151 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9152 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9153 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9154 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9155 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9156 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9157 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9158
9159 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9160 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9161 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9162 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9163 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9164 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9165 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9166 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9167 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9168 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9169
9170 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9171 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9172 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9173 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9174
9175 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9176 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9177 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9178 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9179 is the expansion of the third argument.
9180
9181 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9182 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9183 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9184
9185 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9186 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9187 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9188 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9189 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9190 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9191 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9192 newlines are left in the string.
9193 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9194 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9195 the string expansion fails.
9196
9197 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9198 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9199
9200
9201
9202 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9203 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9204 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9205 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9206 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9207 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9208 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9209 examples:
9210 .code
9211 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9212 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9213 .endd
9214 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9215 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9216 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9217 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9218 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9219 example:
9220 .code
9221 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9222 .endd
9223 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9224 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9225 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9226 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9227 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9228 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9229 .code
9230 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9231 .endd
9232 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9233 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9234 turns them into spaces:
9235 .code
9236 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9237 .endd
9238 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9239 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9240 addition, the following errors can occur:
9241
9242 .ilist
9243 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9244 .next
9245 Failure to connect the socket;
9246 .next
9247 Failure to write the request string;
9248 .next
9249 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9250 .endlist
9251
9252 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9253 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9254 errors occurs. For example:
9255 .code
9256 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9257 {socket failure}}
9258 .endd
9259 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9260 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9261 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9262 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9263 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9264
9265 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9266 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9267
9268
9269 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9270 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9271 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9272 .vindex "&$value$&"
9273 .vindex "&$item$&"
9274 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9275 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9276 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9277 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9278 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9279 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9280 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9281 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9282 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9283 .code
9284 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9285 .endd
9286 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9287 can be found:
9288 .code
9289 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9290 .endd
9291 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9292 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9293 expansion items.
9294
9295 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9296 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9297 expansion item above.
9298
9299 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9300 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9301 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9302 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9303 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9304 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9305 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9306 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9307
9308 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9309 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9310 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9311 .vindex "&$value$&"
9312 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9313 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9314 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9315 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9316 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9317 &$value$&.
9318
9319 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9320 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9321 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9322 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9323
9324 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9325 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9326 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9327 .code
9328 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9329 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9330 ...
9331 endif
9332 .endd
9333 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9334 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9335 commands.
9336
9337 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9338 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9339 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9340 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9341
9342 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9343 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9344
9345
9346 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9347 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9348 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9349 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9350 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9351 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9352 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9353 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9354 .code
9355 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9356 .endd
9357 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9358 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9359 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9360 .code
9361 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9362 .endd
9363 yields &"defabc"&, and
9364 .code
9365 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9366 .endd
9367 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9368 the regular expression from string expansion.
9369
9370
9371
9372 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9373 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9374 .cindex "substring extraction"
9375 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9376 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9377 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9378 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9379 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9380 .code
9381 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9382 .endd
9383 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9384 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9385 omitted.
9386
9387 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9388 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9389 length required. For example
9390 .code
9391 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9392 .endd
9393 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9394 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9395 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9396 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9397
9398 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9399 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9400 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9401 .code
9402 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9403 .endd
9404 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9405 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9406 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9407 .code
9408 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9409 .endd
9410 yields an empty string, but
9411 .code
9412 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9413 .endd
9414 yields &"1"&.
9415
9416 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9417 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9418 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9419 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9420 .code
9421 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9422 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9423 .endd
9424 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9425
9426
9427
9428 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9429 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9430 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9431 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9432 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9433 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9434 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9435 replacement list. For example
9436 .code
9437 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9438 .endd
9439 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9440 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9441 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9442 place.
9443 .endlist
9444
9445
9446
9447 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9448 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9449 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9450 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9451 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9452 following operations can be performed:
9453
9454 .vlist
9455 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9456 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9457 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9458 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9459 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9460 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9461
9462
9463 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9464 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9465 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9466 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9467 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9468 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9469 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9470 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9471 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9472
9473 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9474 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9475 character. For example:
9476 .code
9477 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9478 .endd
9479 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9480 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9481 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9482 processing lists.
9483
9484
9485 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9486 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9487 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9488 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9489 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9490 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9491 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9492 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9493 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9494
9495 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9496 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9497 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9498 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9499 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9500 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9501 string.
9502
9503 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9504 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9505 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9506 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9507 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9508
9509
9510 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9511 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9512 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9513 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9514 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9515 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9516 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9517
9518
9519 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9520 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9521 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9522 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9523 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9524 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9525 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9526 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9527 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9528 C programming language):
9529 .table2 70pt 300pt
9530 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9531 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9532 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9533 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9534 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9535 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9536 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9537 .endtable
9538 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9539 space is permitted before or after operators.
9540
9541 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9542 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9543 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9544 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9545 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9546
9547 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9548 or 1024*1024*1024,
9549 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9550 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9551
9552 .display
9553 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9554 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9555 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9556 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9557 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9558 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9559 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9560 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9561 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9562 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9563 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9564 .endd
9565
9566 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9567 .code
9568 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9569 condition = \
9570 ${if and { \
9571 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9572 { \
9573 < \
9574 {$recipients_count} \
9575 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9576 } \
9577 }{yes}{no}}
9578 .endd
9579 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9580 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9581
9582
9583 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9584 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9585 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9586 example,
9587 .code
9588 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9589 .endd
9590 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9591 and then re-expands what it has found.
9592
9593
9594 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9595 .cindex "Unicode"
9596 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9597 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9598 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9599 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9600 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9601 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9602 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9603 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9604 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9605
9606 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9607 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9608 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9609 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9610 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9611 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9612 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9613
9614
9615 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9616 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9617 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9618 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9619 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9620 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9621 .code
9622 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9623 .endd
9624 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9625 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9626
9627
9628
9629 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9630 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9631 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9632 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9633 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9634 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9635
9636
9637 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9638 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9639 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9640 .cindex "lower casing"
9641 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9642 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9643 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9644 .code
9645 ${lc:$local_part}
9646 .endd
9647
9648 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9649 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9650 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9651 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9652 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9653 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9654 .code
9655 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9656 .endd
9657 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9658 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9659 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9660
9661
9662 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9663 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9664 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9665 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9666 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9667 empty.
9668
9669
9670 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9671 .cindex "masked IP address"
9672 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9673 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9674 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9675 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9676 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9677 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9678 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9679 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9680 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9681 .code
9682 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9683 .endd
9684 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9685 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9686 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9687 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9688 .code
9689 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9690 .endd
9691 returns the string
9692 .code
9693 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9694 .endd
9695 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9696
9697
9698 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9699 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9700 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9701 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9702 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9703 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9704
9705
9706 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9707 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9708 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9709 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9710 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9711 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9712 .code
9713 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9714 .endd
9715 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9716
9717
9718 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9719 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9720 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9721 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9722 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9723 is an empty string or
9724 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9725 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9726 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9727 respectively For example,
9728 .code
9729 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
9730 .endd
9731 becomes
9732 .code
9733 "ab\"*\"cd"
9734 .endd
9735 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9736 variable or a message header.
9737
9738 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9739 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9740 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9741 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9742 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9743 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9744 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9745
9746
9747 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9748 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9749 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9750 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9751 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9752 .code
9753 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9754 .endd
9755 returns
9756 .code
9757 two%20%5C2A%20two
9758 .endd
9759 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9760 yields an unchanged string.
9761
9762
9763 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9764 .cindex "random number"
9765 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9766 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9767 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9768 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9769 .new
9770 if Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used.
9771 .wen
9772 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9773 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9774 random().
9775
9776
9777 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9778 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9779 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9780 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9781 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9782 for DNS. For example,
9783 .code
9784 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
9785 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9786 .endd
9787 returns
9788 .code
9789 4.2.0.192
9790 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9791 .endd
9792
9793
9794 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9795 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9796 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9797 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9798 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9799 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9800 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9801 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9802 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9803 characters
9804 .code
9805 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9806 .endd
9807 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9808 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9809 characters.
9810
9811
9812 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9813 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9814 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9815 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9816 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9817 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9818 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9819 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9820
9821 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9822 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9823 to use this operator as well.
9824
9825
9826
9827 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9828 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9829 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9830 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9831 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9832 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9833 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9834
9835
9836 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9837 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9838 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9839 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9840 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9841 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9842
9843
9844 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9845 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9846 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9847 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9848 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9849 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9850 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9851 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9852 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9853 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9854 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9855 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9856 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9857
9858 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9859 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9860 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9861
9862 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9863 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9864 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9865 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9866 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9867
9868
9869
9870 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9871 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9872 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9873 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9874 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9875 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9876
9877
9878 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9879 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9880 .cindex "substring extraction"
9881 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9882 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9883 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9884 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9885 .code
9886 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9887 .endd
9888 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9889 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9890
9891 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9892 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9893 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9894 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9895 seconds.
9896
9897 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9898 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9899 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9900 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9901 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9902 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9903 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
9904
9905 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9906 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9907 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9908 .cindex "upper casing"
9909 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9910 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9911 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9912 .endlist
9913
9914
9915
9916
9917
9918
9919 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9920 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9921 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9922 while expanding strings:
9923
9924 .vlist
9925 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9926 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9927 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9928 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9929 condition.
9930
9931 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9932 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9933 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9934 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9935 are:
9936 .display
9937 &`= `& equal
9938 &`== `& equal
9939 &`> `& greater
9940 &`>= `& greater or equal
9941 &`< `& less
9942 &`<= `& less or equal
9943 .endd
9944 For example:
9945 .code
9946 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9947 .endd
9948 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9949 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9950 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9951 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9952 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9953 zero.
9954
9955 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
9956 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
9957 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
9958
9959
9960 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9961 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9962 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9963 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9964 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9965 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9966 false if zero.
9967 An empty string is treated as false.
9968 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
9969 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
9970 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9971
9972 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9973 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9974 For example:
9975 .code
9976 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9977 .endd
9978
9979
9980 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9981 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9982 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
9983 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
9984 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
9985 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
9986 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
9987 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9988
9989 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
9990
9991 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9992 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9993 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9994 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9995 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9996 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9997 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9998 included in the binary.
9999
10000 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10001 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10002 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10003 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10004 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10005 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10006 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10007 string in LDAP form is:
10008 .code
10009 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10010 .endd
10011 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10012 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10013 .code
10014 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10015 .endd
10016 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10017 supported:
10018
10019 .ilist
10020 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10021 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10022 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10023 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10024 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10025 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10026 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10027 comparison fails.
10028
10029 .next
10030 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10031 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10032 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10033 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10034 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10035 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10036
10037 .next
10038 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10039 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10040 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10041 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10042 whatever its length.
10043
10044 .next
10045 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10046 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10047 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10048 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10049 .endlist
10050 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10051 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10052 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10053 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10054 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10055 support &[crypt16()]&.
10056
10057 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10058 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10059 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10060 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10061 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10062
10063 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10064 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10065 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10066
10067 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10068 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10069 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10070 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10071 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10072
10073 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10074 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10075 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10076 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10077 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10078 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10079 .code
10080 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10081 .endd
10082 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10083 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10084
10085 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10086 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10087 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10088 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10089 exists in the message. For example,
10090 .code
10091 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10092 .endd
10093 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10094 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10095
10096 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10097 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10098 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10099 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10100 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10101 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10102 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10103 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10104 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10105
10106 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10107 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10108 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10109 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10110 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10111 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10112 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10113 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10114
10115 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10116 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10117 .cindex "first delivery"
10118 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10119 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10120 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10121 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10122
10123
10124 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10125 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10126 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10127 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10128 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10129 .vindex "&$item$&"
10130 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10131 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10132 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10133 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10134 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10135 .ilist
10136 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10137 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10138 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10139 .next
10140 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10141 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10142 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10143 .endlist
10144 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10145 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10146 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10147 list separator is changed to a comma:
10148 .code
10149 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10150 .endd
10151 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10152 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10153
10154
10155 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10156 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10157 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10158 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10159 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10160 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10161 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10162 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10163 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10164 case-independent.
10165
10166 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10167 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10168 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10169 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10170 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10171 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10172 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10173 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10174 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10175 case-independent.
10176
10177 .new
10178 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10179 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10180 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10181 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10182 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10183 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10184 is true.
10185
10186 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10187 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10188 .code
10189 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10190 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10191 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10192 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10193 .endd
10194 .wen
10195
10196 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10197 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10198 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10199 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10200 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10201 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10202 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10203 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10204 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10205 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10206 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10207
10208 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10209 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10210 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10211 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10212 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10213
10214 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10215 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10216 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10217 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10218 .code
10219 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10220 .endd
10221 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10222
10223 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10224 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10225 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10226 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10227 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10228 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10229 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10230 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10231 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10232 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10233 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10234 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10235 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10236 this can be used.
10237
10238
10239 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10240 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10241 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10242 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10243 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10244 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10245 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10246 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10247 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10248 case-independent.
10249
10250 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10251 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10252 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10253 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10254 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10255 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10256 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10257 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10258 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10259 case-independent.
10260
10261
10262 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10263 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10264 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10265 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10266 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10267 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10268 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10269 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10270 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10271 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10272 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10273 For example,
10274 .code
10275 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10276 .endd
10277 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10278 backslashes is also required.
10279
10280 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10281 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10282 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10283 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10284 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10285 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10286
10287 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10288 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10289 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10290 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10291 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10292 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10293 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10294 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10295
10296 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10297 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10298 See &*match_local_part*&.
10299
10300 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10301 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10302 See &*match_local_part*&.
10303
10304 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10305 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10306 .new
10307 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10308 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10309 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10310 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10311 .wen
10312 .code
10313 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10314 .endd
10315 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10316
10317 .ilist
10318 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10319 .next
10320 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10321 .next
10322 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10323 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10324 in a single test such as
10325 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10326 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10327 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10328 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10329 .code
10330 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10331 .endd
10332 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10333 .next
10334 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10335 .next
10336 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10337 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10338 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10339 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10340 masks. For example:
10341 .code
10342 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10343 .endd
10344 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10345 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10346 address mask, for example:
10347 .code
10348 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10349 .endd
10350 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10351 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10352 .code
10353 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10354 .endd
10355 .endlist ilist
10356
10357 .new
10358 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10359 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10360 .wen
10361
10362 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10363
10364 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10365 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10366 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10367 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10368 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10369 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10370 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10371 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10372 example is:
10373 .code
10374 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10375 .endd
10376 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10377 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10378 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10379 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10380 .code
10381 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10382 .endd
10383 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10384 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10385 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10386 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10387 caselessly.
10388
10389 .new
10390 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10391 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10392 .wen
10393
10394 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10395 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10396 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10397 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10398
10399 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10400 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10401 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10402 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10403 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10404 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10405 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10406 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10407 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10408 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10409 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10410 .code
10411 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10412 .endd
10413 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10414 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10415
10416 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10417 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10418 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10419 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10420 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10421 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10422 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10423
10424 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10425 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10426 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10427 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10428 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10429 .code
10430 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10431 .endd
10432 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10433 .code
10434 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10435 .endd
10436 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10437 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10438 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10439 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10440 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10441 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10442 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10443 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10444
10445
10446 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10447 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10448 .cindex "Cyrus"
10449 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10450 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10451 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10452 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10453 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10454 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10455
10456 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10457 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10458 building Exim. For example:
10459 .code
10460 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10461 .endd
10462 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10463 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10464 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10465 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10466
10467 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10468 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10469 configuration, you might have this:
10470 .code
10471 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10472 .endd
10473 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10474 .code
10475 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10476 .endd
10477 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10478 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10479 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10480 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10481 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10482 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10483
10484
10485 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10486 .cindex "Radius"
10487 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10488 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10489 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10490 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10491 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10492 support.
10493
10494 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10495 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10496 this library, you need to set
10497 .code
10498 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10499 .endd
10500 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10501 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10502 .code
10503 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10504 .endd
10505 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10506 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10507 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10508
10509 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10510 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10511 the authentication is successful. For example:
10512 .code
10513 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10514 .endd
10515
10516
10517 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10518 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10519 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10520 .cindex "Cyrus"
10521 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10522 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10523 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10524 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10525 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10526 by a process that is not running as root.
10527
10528 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10529 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10530 building Exim. For example:
10531 .code
10532 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10533 .endd
10534 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10535 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10536 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10537
10538 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10539 two are mandatory. For example:
10540 .code
10541 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10542 .endd
10543 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10544 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10545 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10546 .endlist vlist
10547
10548
10549
10550 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10551 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10552 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10553 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10554 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10555 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10556 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10557
10558
10559 .vlist
10560 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10561 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10562 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10563 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10564 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10565 For example,
10566 .code
10567 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10568 .endd
10569 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10570 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10571 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10572
10573 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10574 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10575 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10576 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10577 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10578 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10579 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10580 parsed but not evaluated.
10581 .endlist
10582 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10583
10584
10585
10586
10587 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10588 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10589 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10590 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10591 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10592
10593 .vlist
10594 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10595 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10596 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10597 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10598 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10599 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10600 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10601 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10602 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10603 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10604 matching condition.
10605
10606 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10607 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10608 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10609 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10610 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10611 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10612 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10613 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10614 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10615 during subsequent delivery.
10616
10617 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10618 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10619 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10620 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10621 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10622 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10623 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10624 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10625 delivery.
10626
10627 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10628 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10629 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10630 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10631 be preserved by coding like this:
10632 .code
10633 warn !verify = sender
10634 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10635 .endd
10636 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10637 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10638 failure.
10639
10640 .vitem &$address_data$&
10641 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10642 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10643 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10644 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10645 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10646 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10647 user filter files.
10648
10649 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10650 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10651 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10652 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10653 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10654 from the child's routing.
10655
10656 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10657 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10658 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10659 address.
10660
10661 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10662 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10663 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10664
10665 .vitem &$address_file$&
10666 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10667 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10668 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10669 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10670 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10671 .code
10672 /home/r2d2/savemail
10673 .endd
10674 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10675 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10676 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10677 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10678 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10679 to the relevant file.
10680
10681 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10682 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10683 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10684 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10685
10686 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10687 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10688 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10689 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10690
10691 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10692 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10693 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10694 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10695 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10696 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10697 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10698 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10699 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10700 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10701 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10702 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10703 command line option.
10704
10705
10706
10707
10708 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10709 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10710 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10711 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10712 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10713 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10714 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10715 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10716 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10717 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10718 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10719
10720 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10721 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10722 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10723 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10724 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10725
10726
10727 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10728 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10729 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10730 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10731 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10732 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10733 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10734 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10735 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10736 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10737 an undefined mechanism.
10738
10739 .new
10740 .vitem &$av_failed$&
10741 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10742 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10743 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10744 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10745 the ACL malware condition.
10746 .wen
10747
10748 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10749 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10750 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10751 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10752 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10753 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10754
10755 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10756 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10757 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10758 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10759 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10760 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10761 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
10762
10763 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10764 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10765 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10766 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10767 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10768
10769 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10770 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10771 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10772 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10773 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10774
10775 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10776 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10777 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10778 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10779 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10780 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10781 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10782
10783 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10784 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10785 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10786 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10787 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10788 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10789 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10790
10791 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10792 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10793 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10794
10795 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10796 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10797 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10798 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10799 compilations of the same version of the program.
10800
10801 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10802 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10803 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10804 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10805 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10806
10807 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10808 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10809 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10810 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10811 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10812
10813 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10814 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10815 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10816 &$dnslist_value$&
10817 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10818 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10819 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10820 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10821 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10822 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10823 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10824 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10825 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10826
10827 .vitem &$domain$&
10828 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10829 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10830 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10831 case for &$domain$&.
10832
10833 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10834 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10835 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10836 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10837
10838 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10839 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10840 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10841 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10842 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10843 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10844
10845 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10846 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10847 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10848
10849 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10850
10851 .ilist
10852 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10853 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10854 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10855 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10856 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10857 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10858 the &(smtp)& transport.
10859
10860 .next
10861 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10862 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10863 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10864 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10865
10866 .next
10867 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10868 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10869 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10870 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10871 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10872 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10873
10874 .next
10875 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10876 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10877 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10878 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10879 .endlist
10880
10881
10882 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10883 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10884 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10885 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10886 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10887 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10888 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10889 used.
10890
10891 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10892 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10893 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10894 to nothing.
10895
10896 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10897 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10898 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10899
10900 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10901 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10902 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10903
10904 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10905 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10906 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10907
10908 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10909 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10910 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10911 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10912 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10913
10914 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10915 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10916 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10917 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10918 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10919
10920 .vitem &$home$&
10921 .vindex "&$home$&"
10922 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10923 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10924 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10925 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10926 by a setting on the transport itself.
10927
10928 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10929 of the environment variable HOME.
10930
10931 .vitem &$host$&
10932 .vindex "&$host$&"
10933 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10934 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10935 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10936 to local and remote transports.
10937
10938 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10939 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10940 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10941 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10942 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10943 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10944 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10945 is connected.
10946
10947 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10948 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10949 client is connected.
10950
10951
10952 .vitem &$host_address$&
10953 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10954 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10955 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10956 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10957
10958 .vitem &$host_data$&
10959 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10960 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10961 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10962 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10963 .code
10964 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10965 message = $host_data
10966 .endd
10967 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10968 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10969 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10970 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10971 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10972 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10973 variables is set to &"1"&.
10974
10975 .ilist
10976 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10977 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10978
10979 .next
10980 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10981 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10982 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10983 .endlist ilist
10984
10985 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10986 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10987 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10988 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10989 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10990 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10991 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10992 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10993 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10994 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10995
10996 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10997 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10998 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10999
11000
11001 .vitem &$inode$&
11002 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11003 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11004 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11005 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11006 a unique name for the file.
11007
11008 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11009 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11010 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11011
11012 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11013 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11014 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11015
11016 .vitem &$item$&
11017 .vindex "&$item$&"
11018 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11019 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11020 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11021 empty.
11022
11023 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11024 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11025 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11026 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11027 lookup.
11028
11029 .vitem &$load_average$&
11030 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11031 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11032 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11033 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11034
11035 .vitem &$local_part$&
11036 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11037 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11038 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11039 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11040 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11041
11042 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11043 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11044 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11045 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11046 once.
11047
11048 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11049 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11050 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11051 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11052 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11053 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11054
11055 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11056 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11057 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11058 &$address_pipe$&).
11059
11060 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11061 local part of the recipient address.
11062
11063 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11064 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11065 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11066
11067 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11068 the addresses
11069 .code
11070 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11071 abc\:xyz@test.example
11072 .endd
11073 the value of &$local_part$& is
11074 .code
11075 abc:xyz
11076 .endd
11077 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11078 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11079 have:
11080 .code
11081 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11082 .endd
11083 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11084 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11085 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11086
11087 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11088 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11089 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11090 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11091 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11092 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11093 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11094
11095 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11096 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11097 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11098 variable expands to nothing.
11099
11100 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11101 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11102 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11103 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11104 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11105
11106 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11107 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11108 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11109 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11110 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11111
11112 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11113 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11114 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11115 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11116
11117 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11118 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11119 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11120
11121 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11122 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11123 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11124 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11125 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11126 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11127 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11128 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11129
11130 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11131 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11132 This contains the expanded value of the
11133 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11134 been read.
11135
11136 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11137 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11138 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11139 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11140 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11141 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11142
11143 .vitem &$log_space$&
11144 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11145 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11146 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11147 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11148 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11149 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11150
11151
11152 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11153 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11154 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11155 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11156 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11157 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11158 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11159 variable is empty.
11160
11161 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11162 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11163 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11164 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11165 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11166
11167 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11168 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11169 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11170 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11171 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11172 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11173 character(s).
11174
11175 .vitem &$message_age$&
11176 .cindex "message" "age of"
11177 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11178 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11179 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11180 delivery attempt.
11181
11182 .vitem &$message_body$&
11183 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11184 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11185 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11186 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11187 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11188 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11189 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11190 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11191 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11192
11193 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11194 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11195 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11196 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11197 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11198
11199 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11200 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11201 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11202 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11203 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11204 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11205 &$message_body$&.
11206
11207 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11208 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11209 .cindex "message body" "size"
11210 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11211 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11212 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11213 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11214 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11215
11216 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11217 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11218 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11219 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11220 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11221 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11222 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11223 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11224
11225 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11226 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11227 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11228 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11229 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11230 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11231
11232 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11233 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11234 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11235 contents of header lines is done.
11236
11237 .vitem &$message_id$&
11238 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11239
11240 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11241 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11242 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11243 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11244 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11245 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11246 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11247 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11248 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11249 from the body is not counted.
11250
11251 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11252 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11253 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11254 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11255 header and the body).
11256
11257 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11258 .code
11259 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11260 condition = \
11261 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11262 .endd
11263 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11264 message has not yet been received.
11265
11266 .vitem &$message_size$&
11267 .cindex "size" "of message"
11268 .cindex "message" "size"
11269 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11270 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11271 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11272 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11273 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11274 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11275 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11276 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11277 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11278
11279 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11280 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11281 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11282 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11283
11284 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11285 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11286 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11287 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11288
11289 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11290 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11291 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11292
11293 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11294 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11295 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11296 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11297 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11298 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11299 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11300 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11301 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11302 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11303
11304 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11305 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11306 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11307
11308 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11309 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11310 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11311 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11312 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11313 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11314 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11315 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11316 the original address.
11317
11318 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11319 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11320 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11321 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11322 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11323
11324 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11325 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11326 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11327
11328 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11329 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11330 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11331 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11332 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11333 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11334 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11335 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11336 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11337
11338 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11339 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11340 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11341 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11342 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11343 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11344 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11345 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11346 user.
11347
11348 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11349 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11350 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11351 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11352
11353 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11354 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11355 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11356 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11357
11358 .vitem &$pid$&
11359 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11360 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11361 This variable contains the current process id.
11362
11363 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11364 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11365 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11366 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11367 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11368 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11369 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11370 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11371 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11372 variable"& error if encountered.
11373
11374 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11375 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11376 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11377 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11378 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11379 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11380 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11381
11382
11383 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11384 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11385 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11386 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11387
11388 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11389 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11390 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11391 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11392
11393 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11394 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11395 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11396 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11397
11398 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11399 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11400 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11401
11402 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11403 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11404 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11405 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11406
11407 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11408 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11409 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11410 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11411 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11412
11413 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11414 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11415 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11416 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11417 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11418 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11419
11420 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11421 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11422 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11423 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11424 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11425
11426 .vitem &$received_count$&
11427 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11428 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11429 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11430 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11431 delivering.
11432
11433 .vitem &$received_for$&
11434 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11435 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11436 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11437 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11438 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11439
11440 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11441 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11442 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11443 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11444 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11445 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11446 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11447 option.
11448
11449 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11450 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11451 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11452 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11453 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11454 time.
11455
11456 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11457 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11458 &(smtp)& transport).
11459
11460 .vitem &$received_port$&
11461 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11462 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11463
11464 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11465 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11466 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11467 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11468 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11469 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11470 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11471 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11472 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11473
11474 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11475 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11476 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11477 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11478 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11479 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11480
11481 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11482 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11483 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11484
11485 .vitem &$received_time$&
11486 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11487 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11488 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11489
11490 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11491 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11492 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11493 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11494 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11495 .display
11496 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11497 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11498 .endd
11499 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11500 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11501 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11502 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11503
11504 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11505 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11506 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11507 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11508
11509 .ilist
11510 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11511 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11512
11513 .next
11514 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11515
11516 .next
11517 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11518 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11519 MAIL).
11520
11521 .next
11522 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11523 .next
11524
11525 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11526 .endlist
11527
11528 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11529 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11530
11531 .vitem &$recipients$&
11532 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11533 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11534 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11535 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11536 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11537 cases:
11538
11539 .olist
11540 In a system filter file.
11541 .next
11542 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11543 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11544 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11545 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11546 .next
11547 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11548 .endlist
11549
11550
11551 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11552 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11553 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11554 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11555 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11556 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11557
11558
11559 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11560 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11561 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11562 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11563
11564
11565 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11566 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11567 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11568 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11569 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11570 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11571 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11572
11573 .vitem &$return_path$&
11574 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11575 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11576 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11577 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11578 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11579 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11580 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11581 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11582 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11583 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11584 envelope sender.
11585
11586 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11587 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11588 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11589
11590 .vitem &$runrc$&
11591 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11592 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11593 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11594 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11595 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11596 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11597 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11598 another.
11599
11600 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11601 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11602 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11603 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11604 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11605 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11606 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11607 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11608
11609 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11610 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11611 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11612 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11613 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11614 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11615
11616 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11617 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11618 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11619 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11620 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11621 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11622 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11623 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11624
11625 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11626 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11627 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11628
11629 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11630 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11631 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11632
11633 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11634 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11635 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11636 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11637 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11638 this:
11639 .display
11640 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11641 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11642 .endd
11643 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11644 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11645 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11646 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11647
11648 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11649 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11650 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11651 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11652 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11653 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11654 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11655 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11656 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11657 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11658 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11659 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11660 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11661
11662 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11663 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11664 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11665 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11666 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11667 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11668
11669 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11670 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11671 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11672 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11673
11674 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11675 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11676 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11677 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11678 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11679 &$authenticated_id$&.
11680
11681 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11682 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11683 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11684 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11685 other means, this variable is empty.
11686
11687 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11688 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11689 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11690 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11691 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11692 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11693 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11694
11695 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11696 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11697 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11698 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11699
11700 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11701 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11702 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11703 is set to &"1"&.
11704
11705 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11706 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11707 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11708 following are true:
11709
11710 .ilist
11711 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11712 .next
11713 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11714 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11715 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11716 .next
11717 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11718 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11719 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11720 .next
11721 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11722 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11723 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11724 .next
11725 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11726 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11727 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11728 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11729 .code
11730 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11731 .endd
11732 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11733 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11734 .endlist
11735
11736
11737 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11738 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11739 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11740 number that was used on the remote host.
11741
11742 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11743 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11744 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11745 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11746 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11747 called Exim.
11748
11749 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11750 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11751 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11752 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11753
11754 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11755 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11756 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11757 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11758 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11759 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11760 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11761 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11762 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11763 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11764 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11765 the parentheses.
11766
11767 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11768 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11769 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11770 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11771 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11772
11773 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11774 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11775 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11776 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11777 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11778
11779 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11780 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11781 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11782 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11783 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11784 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11785 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11786
11787 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11788 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11789 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11790 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11791 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11792
11793 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11794 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11795 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11796 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11797 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11798 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11799
11800 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11801 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11802 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11803 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11804 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11805 .code
11806 MAIL FROM:<>
11807 MAIL FROM: <>
11808 .endd
11809 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11810 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11811 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11812 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11813
11814 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11815 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11816 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11817 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11818 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11819 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11820 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11821
11822 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11823 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11824 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11825 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11826 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11827 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11828 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11829 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11830 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11831 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11832 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11833
11834 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11835 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11836 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11837 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11838 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11839 message is junk mail.
11840
11841 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11842 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11843 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11844 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11845
11846
11847 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11848 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11849 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11850
11851 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11852 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11853 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11854 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11855 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11856 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11857
11858 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11859 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11860 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11861 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11862 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11863 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11864 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11865 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11866 .code
11867 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11868 .endd
11869 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11870
11871
11872 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11873 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11874 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11875 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11876 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11877 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11878
11879 .new
11880 .vitem &$tls_bits$&
11881 .vindex "&$tls_bits$&"
11882 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength; the meaning of
11883 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
11884 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
11885 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
11886 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
11887 .wen
11888
11889 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11890 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11891 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11892 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11893
11894 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11895 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11896 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11897 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11898 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11899 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11900 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11901 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11902
11903 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11904 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11905 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11906 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11907 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11908 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11909
11910 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11911 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11912 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11913 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11914 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11915 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11916 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11917 deliveries.
11918
11919 .new
11920 .vitem &$tls_sni$&
11921 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
11922 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
11923 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
11924 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
11925 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
11926 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
11927 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
11928 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
11929 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
11930
11931 The value will be retained for the lifetime of the message. During outbound
11932 SMTP deliveries, it reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
11933 the transport.
11934 .wen
11935
11936 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11937 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11938 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11939 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11940
11941 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11942 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11943 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11944
11945 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11946 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11947 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11948 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11949 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11950 values for those that are behind (west).
11951
11952 .vitem &$tod_log$&
11953 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11954 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11955 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11956
11957 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11958 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11959 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11960 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11961 flag.
11962
11963 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11964 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11965 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11966 -0500.
11967
11968 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11969 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11970 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11971 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11972
11973 .vitem &$value$&
11974 .vindex "&$value$&"
11975 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11976 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11977 &*reduce*& expansion.
11978
11979 .vitem &$version_number$&
11980 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11981 The version number of Exim.
11982
11983 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11984 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11985 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11986 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11987
11988 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11989 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11990 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11991 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11992 .endlist
11993 .ecindex IIDstrexp
11994
11995
11996
11997 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11998 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11999
12000 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12001 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12002 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12003 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12004 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12005 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12006 the line
12007 .code
12008 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12009 .endd
12010 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12011
12012
12013 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12014 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12015 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12016 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12017 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12018 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12019 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12020 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12021 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12022
12023 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12024 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12025 should usually be something like
12026 .code
12027 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12028 .endd
12029 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12030 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12031 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12032 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12033 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12034 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12035 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12036 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12037 two ways:
12038
12039 .ilist
12040 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12041 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12042 a startup when Exim is entered.
12043 .next
12044 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12045 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12046 .endlist
12047
12048 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12049 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12050
12051
12052 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12053 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12054 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12055 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12056 forms:
12057 .code
12058 ${perl{foo}}
12059 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12060 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12061 .endd
12062 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12063 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12064 with an error message of the form
12065 .code
12066 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12067 .endd
12068 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12069 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12070 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12071 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12072 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12073 that was passed to &%die%&.
12074
12075
12076 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12077 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12078 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12079 the Perl code
12080 .code
12081 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12082 .endd
12083 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12084 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12085 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12086
12087 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12088 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12089 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12090 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12091
12092 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12093 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12094 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12095 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12096 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12097 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12098 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12099
12100
12101 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12102 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12103 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12104 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12105 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12106 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12107 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12108 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12109 avoided, but the output is lost.
12110
12111 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12112 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12113 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12114 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12115 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12116 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12117 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12118 .code
12119 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12120 .endd
12121 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12122 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12123 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12124 as the first subroutine argument.
12125 .ecindex IIDperl
12126
12127
12128 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12129 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12130
12131 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12132 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12133 "Starting the daemon"
12134 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12135 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12136 .cindex "network interface"
12137 .cindex "interface" "network"
12138 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12139 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12140 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12141 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12142 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12143 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12144 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12145 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12146 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12147 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12148 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12149
12150 .olist
12151 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12152 and ports to listen on.
12153 .next
12154 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12155 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12156 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12157 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12158 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12159 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12160 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12161 as an error situation.
12162 .next
12163 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12164 for the outgoing connection.
12165 .endlist
12166
12167
12168 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12169 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12170 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12171 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12172 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12173
12174 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12175 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12176 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12177 chapter describes how they operate.
12178
12179 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12180 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12181
12182
12183
12184 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12185 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12186 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12187 following options:
12188
12189 .ilist
12190 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12191 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12192 .next
12193 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12194 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12195 .endlist
12196
12197 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12198 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12199 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12200 colons. For example:
12201 .code
12202 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12203 192.168.23.65 ; \
12204 ::1 ; \
12205 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12206 .endd
12207 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12208 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12209
12210 .olist
12211 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12212 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12213 .code
12214 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12215 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12216 .endd
12217 .next
12218 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12219 with a colon separator, for example:
12220 .code
12221 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12222 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12223 .endd
12224 .endlist
12225
12226 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12227 default setting contains just one port:
12228 .code
12229 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12230 .endd
12231 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12232 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12233 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12234 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12235 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12236
12237
12238
12239 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12240 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12241 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12242 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12243 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12244 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12245 .code
12246 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12247 .endd
12248 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12249 .code
12250 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12251 .endd
12252 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12253
12254
12255
12256 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12257 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12258 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12259 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12260 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12261 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12262 exim.
12263
12264 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12265 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12266 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12267 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12268 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12269 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12270 .code
12271 -oX 1225
12272 .endd
12273 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12274 whereas
12275 .code
12276 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12277 .endd
12278 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12279 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12280 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12281
12282
12283
12284 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12285 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12286 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12287 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12288 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12289 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12290 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12291 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12292 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12293 common use of this option is expected to be
12294 .code
12295 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12296 .endd
12297 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12298 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12299 this way when a daemon is started.
12300
12301 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12302 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12303 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12304 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12305 connections via the daemon.)
12306
12307
12308
12309
12310 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12311 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12312 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12313 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12314 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12315 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12316 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12317 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12318 .code
12319 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12320 .endd
12321 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12322 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12323 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12324 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12325 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12326 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12327 .code
12328 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12329 .endd
12330 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12331 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12332 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12333 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12334 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12335
12336 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12337 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12338 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12339 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12340 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12341 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12342 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12343 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12344 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12345 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12346 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12347 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12348
12349 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12350 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12351 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12352 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12353 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12354
12355
12356
12357 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12358 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12359 .code
12360 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12361 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12362 .endd
12363 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12364 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12365 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12366 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12367
12368 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12369 .code
12370 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12371 .endd
12372 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12373 .code
12374 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12375 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12376 .endd
12377 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12378 IPv4 loopback address only:
12379 .code
12380 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12381 .endd
12382 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12383 .code
12384 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12385 .endd
12386 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12387
12388
12389
12390 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12391 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12392 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12393 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12394 treated as local.
12395
12396 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12397 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12398 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12399 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12400
12401 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12402 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12403 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12404 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12405 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12406 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12407 used for listening. Consider this example:
12408 .code
12409 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12410 192.168.53.235 ; \
12411 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12412
12413 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12414 .endd
12415 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12416 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12417 Exim is routing.
12418
12419 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12420 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12421 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12422 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12423 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12424 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12425 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12426 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12427
12428
12429
12430 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12431 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12432 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12433 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12434 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12435 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12436 details.
12437
12438
12439
12440
12441 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12443
12444 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12445 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12446 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12447 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12448
12449 .ilist
12450 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12451 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12452 .next
12453 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12454 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12455 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12456 .next
12457 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12458 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12459 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12460 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12461 settings.
12462 .endlist
12463
12464 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12465 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12466 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12467 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12468 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12469 listed in more than one group.
12470
12471 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12472 .table2
12473 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12474 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12475 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12476 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12477 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12478 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12479 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12480 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12481 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12482 .endtable
12483
12484
12485 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12486 .table2
12487 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12488 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12489 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12490 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12491 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12492 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12493 .endtable
12494
12495
12496
12497 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12498 .table2
12499 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12500 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12501 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12502 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12503 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12504 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12505 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12506 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12507 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12508 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12509 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12510 .endtable
12511
12512
12513
12514 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12515 .table2
12516 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12517 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12518 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12519 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12520 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12521 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12522 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12523 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12524 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12525 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12526 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12527 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12528 .endtable
12529
12530
12531
12532 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12533 .table2
12534 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12535 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12536 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12537 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12538 .endtable
12539
12540
12541
12542 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12543 .table2
12544 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12545 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12546 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12547 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12548 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12549 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12550 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12551 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12552 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12553 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12554 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12555 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12556 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12557 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12558 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12559 .endtable
12560
12561
12562
12563 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12564 .table2
12565 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12566 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12567 .endtable
12568
12569
12570
12571 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12572 .table2
12573 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12574 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12575 .endtable
12576
12577
12578
12579 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12580 .table2
12581 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12582 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12583 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12584 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12585 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12586 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12587 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12588 .endtable
12589
12590
12591
12592 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12593 .table2
12594 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12595 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12596 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12597 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12598 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12599 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12600 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12601 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12602 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12603 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12604 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12605 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12606 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12607 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12608 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12609 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12610 connection"
12611 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12612 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12613 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12614 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12615 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12616 .endtable
12617
12618
12619
12620 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12621 .table2
12622 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12623 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12624 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12625 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12626 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12627 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12628 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12629 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12630 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12631 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12632 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12633 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12634 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12635 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12636 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12637 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12638 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12639 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12640 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12641 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12642 words""&"
12643 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12644 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12645 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12646 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12647 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12648 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12649 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12650 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12651 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12652 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12653 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12654 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12655 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12656 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12657 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12658 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12659 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12660 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12661 .endtable
12662
12663
12664
12665 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12666 .table2
12667 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12668 item"
12669 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12670 item"
12671 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12672 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12673 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12674 .endtable
12675
12676
12677
12678 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12679 .table2
12680 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12681 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12682 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12683 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12684 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12685 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12686 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12687 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12688 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12689 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12690 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12691 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12692 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12693 .endtable
12694
12695
12696
12697 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12698 .table2
12699 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12700 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12701 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12702 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12703 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12704 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12705 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12706 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12707 .endtable
12708
12709
12710
12711 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12712 .table2
12713 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12714 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12715 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12716 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12717 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12718 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12719 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12720 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12721 .endtable
12722
12723
12724
12725
12726 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12727 .table2
12728 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12729 .endtable
12730
12731
12732
12733
12734
12735 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12736 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12737
12738 .table2
12739 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12740 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12741 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12742 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12743 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12744 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12745 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12746 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12747 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12748 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12749 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12750 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12751 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12752 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12753 connection"
12754 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12755 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12756 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12757 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12758 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12759 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12760 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12761 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12762 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12763 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12764 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12765 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12766 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12767 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12768 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12769 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12770 .endtable
12771
12772
12773
12774 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12775 .table2
12776 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12777 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12778 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12779 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12780 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12781 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12782 .endtable
12783
12784
12785
12786 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12787 .table2
12788 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12789 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12790 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12791 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12792 words""&"
12793 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12794 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12795 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12796 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12797 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12798 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12799 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12800 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12801 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12802 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12803 .endtable
12804
12805
12806
12807 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12808 .table2
12809 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12810 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12811 directory"
12812 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12813 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12814 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12815 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12816 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12817 .endtable
12818
12819
12820
12821 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12822 .table2
12823 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12824 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12825 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12826 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12827 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12828 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12829 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
12830 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12831 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12832 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12833 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12834 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12835 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12836 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12837 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12838 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12839 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12840 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12841 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12842 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12843 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12844 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12845 .endtable
12846
12847
12848
12849 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12850 .table2
12851 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12852 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12853 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12854 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12855 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12856 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12857 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12858 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12859 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12860 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12861 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12862 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12863 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12864 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12865 .endtable
12866
12867
12868
12869 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12870 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12871 &dagger;.
12872
12873 .new
12874 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
12875 .cindex "8BITMIME"
12876 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12877 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12878 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12879 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12880 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12881
12882 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
12883 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
12884 It now defaults to true.
12885 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
12886 .display
12887 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
12888 .endd
12889 .wen
12890
12891 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12892 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12893 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12894 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12895 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12896 further details.
12897
12898 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12899 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12900 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12901 SMTP messages.
12902
12903 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12904 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12905 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12906 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12907 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12908
12909 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12910 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12911 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12912 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12913 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12914
12915 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12916 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12917 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12918 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12919
12920 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12921 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12922 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12923 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12924 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12925
12926 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12927 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12928 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12929 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12930
12931 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12932 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12933 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12934 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12935
12936 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12937 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12938 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12939 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12940 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12941
12942
12943 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12944 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12945 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12946 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12947
12948 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12949 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12950 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12951 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12952 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12953
12954 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12955 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12956 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12957 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12958 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12959
12960 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12961 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12962 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12963 further details.
12964
12965 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12966 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12967 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12968 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12969
12970 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12971 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12972 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12973 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12974
12975 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12976 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12977 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12978 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12979
12980 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12981 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12982 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12983 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12984
12985 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12986 .cindex "admin user"
12987 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12988 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12989 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12990 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12991 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12992 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12993 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12994
12995 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12996 .cindex "domain literal"
12997 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12998 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12999 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13000 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13001
13002 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13003 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13004 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13005 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13006 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13007 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13008 the local host's IP addresses.
13009
13010
13011 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13012 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13013 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13014 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13015 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13016 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13017 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13018 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13019 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13020
13021 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13022 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13023 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13024 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13025 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13026 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13027 experiment if they wish.
13028
13029 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13030 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13031 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13032 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13033 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13034 suitable setting is:
13035 .code
13036 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13037 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13038 .endd
13039 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13040 .code
13041 dns_check_names_pattern =
13042 .endd
13043 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13044
13045
13046 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13047 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13048 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13049 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13050 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13051 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13052 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13053 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13054 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13055 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13056 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13057
13058 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13059 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13060 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13061 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13062 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13063 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13064
13065 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13066 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13067 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13068 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13069 .code
13070 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13071 .endd
13072 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13073 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13074 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13075 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13076
13077
13078 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13079 .cindex "thawing messages"
13080 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13081 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13082 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13083 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13084 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13085 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13086
13087 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13088 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13089 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13090
13091
13092 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13093 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13094 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13095 .code
13096 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13097 .endd
13098 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13099 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13100
13101
13102 .option bi_command main string unset
13103 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13104 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13105 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13106 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13107 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13108
13109
13110 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13111 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13112 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13113 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13114 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13115 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13116
13117
13118 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13119 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13120 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13121 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13122
13123 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13124 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13125 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13126 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13127 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13128 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13129 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13130 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13131 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13132 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13133
13134 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13135 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13136 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13137 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13138
13139
13140 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13141 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13142 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13143 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13144 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13145 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13146 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13147 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13148 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13149
13150 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13151 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13152 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13153 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13154 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13155 messages.
13156
13157 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13158 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13159 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13160 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13161 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13162 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13163 connection. A typical setting might be:
13164 .code
13165 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13166 .endd
13167 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13168 .code
13169 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13170 .endd
13171 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13172 address.
13173
13174 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13175 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13176 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13177 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13178 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13179 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13180
13181
13182 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13183 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13184 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13185 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13186
13187
13188 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13189 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13190 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13191 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13192
13193
13194 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13195 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13196 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13197 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13198
13199
13200 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13201 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13202 callout verification. The default value is
13203 .code
13204 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13205 .endd
13206 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13207
13208
13209 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13210 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13211
13212
13213 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13214 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13215
13216 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13217 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13218 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13219 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13220 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13221 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13222 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13223 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13224 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13225 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13226
13227
13228 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13229 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13230
13231
13232 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13233 .cindex "checking disk space"
13234 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13235 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13236 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13237 message is accepted.
13238
13239 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13240 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13241 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13242 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13243 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13244 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13245 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13246 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13247
13248
13249 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13250 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13251 .code
13252 check_spool_space = 10M
13253 check_spool_inodes = 100
13254 .endd
13255 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13256 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13257 transit.
13258
13259 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13260 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13261 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13262
13263 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13264 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13265 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13266 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13267 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13268 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13269
13270 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13271 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13272
13273 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13274 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13275 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13276
13277 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13278 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13279 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13280 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13281 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13282 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13283
13284 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13285 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13286 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13287 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13288 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13289 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13290 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13291
13292 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13293 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13294
13295 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13296 .cindex "warning of delay"
13297 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13298 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13299 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13300 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13301 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13302 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13303 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13304 with
13305 .code
13306 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13307 .endd
13308 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13309 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13310 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13311 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13312 .code
13313 delay_warning = 6h
13314 .endd
13315 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13316 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13317 .code
13318 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13319 .endd
13320
13321 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13322 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13323 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13324 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13325 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13326 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13327 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13328 not sent. The default is:
13329 .code
13330 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13331 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13332 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13333 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13334 } {no}{yes}}
13335 .endd
13336 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13337 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13338 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13339 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13340
13341 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13342 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13343 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13344 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13345 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13346 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13347 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13348 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13349
13350 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13351 .cindex "load average"
13352 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13353 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13354 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13355 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13356 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13357
13358
13359 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13360 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13361 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13362 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13363 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13364 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13365 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13366 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13367
13368 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13369 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13370 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13371 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13372 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13373 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13374 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13375 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13376
13377 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13378 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13379 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13380 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13381
13382
13383 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13384 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13385 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13386 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13387 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13388 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13389 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13390
13391
13392 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13393 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13394 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13395 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13396 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13397 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13398 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13399 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13400 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13401 by a setting such as this:
13402 .code
13403 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13404 .endd
13405 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13406 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13407 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13408 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13409 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13410 options are applied after this global option.
13411
13412 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13413 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13414 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13415 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13416 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13417 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13418 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13419 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13420 value of this option. The default pattern is
13421 .code
13422 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13423 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13424 .endd
13425 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13426 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13427 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13428 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13429 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13430 empty string.
13431
13432 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13433 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13434 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13435
13436 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13437 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13438 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13439 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13440
13441 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13442 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13443 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13444 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13445 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13446 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13447 domain matches this list.
13448
13449 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13450 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13451 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13452
13453
13454 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13455 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13456 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13457 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13458 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13459 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13460 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13461 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13462 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13463 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13464 to set in them.
13465
13466
13467 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13468 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13469
13470
13471 .new
13472 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13473 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13474 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13475 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13476 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13477 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13478 on.
13479
13480 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13481 .wen
13482
13483
13484 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13485 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13486 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13487 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13488
13489 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13490 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13491 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13492 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13493 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13494 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13495 .code
13496 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13497 .endd
13498 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13499 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13500
13501 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13502 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13503 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13504 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13505 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13506 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13507 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13508 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13509 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13510
13511
13512 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13513 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13514 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13515 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13516 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13517 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13518 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13519 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13520 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13521
13522 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13523 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13524 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13525 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13526 are examined. For example:
13527 .code
13528 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13529 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13530 postmaster@mydomain.example
13531 .endd
13532 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13533 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13534 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13535 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13536 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13537 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13538 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13539
13540
13541 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13542 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13543 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13544 .display
13545 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13546 .endd
13547 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13548 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13549 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13550 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13551 overrides the default.
13552
13553 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13554 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13555 and warning messages. For example:
13556 .code
13557 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13558 .endd
13559 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13560 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13561 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13562 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13563 not used.
13564
13565
13566 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13567 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13568 .cindex "Exim group"
13569 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13570 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13571 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13572 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13573 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13574 security issues.
13575
13576
13577 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13578 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13579 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13580 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13581 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13582 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13583 other place.
13584 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13585 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13586 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13587 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13588
13589
13590 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13591 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13592 .cindex "Exim user"
13593 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13594 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13595 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13596 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13597
13598 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13599 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13600 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13601 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13602
13603
13604 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13605 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13606 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13607 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13608
13609
13610 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13611 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13612
13613 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13614 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13615 .oindex "&%-t%&"
13616 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13617 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13618 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13619 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13620 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13621 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13622 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13623 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13624 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13625 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13626 addresses.
13627
13628
13629 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13630 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13631 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13632 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13633 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13634 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13635 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13636 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13637 retries.
13638
13639 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13640 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13641 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13642 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13643
13644
13645
13646 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13647 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13648 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13649 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13650 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13651 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13652 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13653 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13654 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13655 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13656 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13657 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13658 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13659 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13660 logging that you require.
13661
13662
13663 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13664 .cindex "HP-UX"
13665 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13666 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13667 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13668 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13669 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13670 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13671 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13672 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13673
13674 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13675 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13676 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13677 user's name.
13678
13679 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13680 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13681 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13682 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13683 .code
13684 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13685 gecos_name = $1
13686 .endd
13687
13688 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13689 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13690
13691
13692 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13693 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13694 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13695 implementations of TLS.
13696
13697 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13698 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13699 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13700 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13701 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13702 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13703
13704
13705
13706 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13707 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13708 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13709 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13710 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13711 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13712 sections are rejected.
13713
13714
13715 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13716 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13717 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13718 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13719 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13720 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13721 zero means &"no limit"&.
13722
13723
13724
13725
13726 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13727 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13728 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13729 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13730 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13731 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13732 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13733 if you want to do semantic checking.
13734 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13735 set.
13736
13737
13738 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13739 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13740 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13741 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13742 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13743 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13744 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13745 .code
13746 helo_allow_chars = _
13747 .endd
13748 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13749
13750
13751 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13752 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13753 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13754 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13755 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13756 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13757 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13758 do.
13759
13760
13761 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13762 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13763 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13764 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13765 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13766 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13767 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13768 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13769 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13770 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13771 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13772 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13773
13774 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13775 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13776 EHLO command either:
13777
13778 .ilist
13779 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13780 .next
13781 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13782 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13783 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13784 calling host address, or
13785 .next
13786 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13787 available) yields the calling host address.
13788 .endlist
13789
13790 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13791 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13792 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13793
13794 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13795 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13796 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13797 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13798 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13799 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13800 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13801 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13802 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13803 error.
13804
13805 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13806 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13807 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13808 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13809 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13810 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13811 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13812 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13813 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13814
13815 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13816 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13817 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13818 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13819 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13820
13821 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13822 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13823 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13824 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13825
13826
13827 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13828 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13829 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13830 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13831 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13832 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13833 default configuration file contains
13834 .code
13835 host_lookup = *
13836 .endd
13837 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13838 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13839
13840 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13841 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13842 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13843
13844 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13845 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13846 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13847 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13848 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13849 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13850
13851
13852 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13853 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13854 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13855 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13856 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13857 if you want.
13858
13859 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13860 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13861 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13862 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13863
13864
13865
13866 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13867 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13868 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13869 as soon as the connection is made.
13870 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13871 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13872 connections immediately.
13873
13874 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13875 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13876 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13877 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13878 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13879
13880
13881 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13882 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13883 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13884 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13885 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13886 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13887 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13888 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13889 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13890 .code
13891 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13892 .endd
13893 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13894
13895
13896
13897 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13898 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13899 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13900 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13901 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13902 records
13903 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13904 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13905
13906 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13907 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13908 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13909 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13910 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13911 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13912 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13913
13914
13915 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13916 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13917 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13918 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13919 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13920
13921
13922
13923 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13924 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13925 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13926 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13927 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13928 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13929
13930 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13931 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13932 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13933 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13934 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13935 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13936 for frozen messages. For example,
13937 .code
13938 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13939 .endd
13940 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13941 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13942 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13943 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13944 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13945 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13946
13947
13948 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13949 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13950 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13951 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13952 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13953 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13954 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13955 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13956 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13957 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13958
13959
13960 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13961 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13962
13963
13964 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13965 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13966 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13967 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13968 logged.
13969
13970
13971 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
13972 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
13973 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
13974 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
13975 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
13976 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
13977 and constrained to be a directory.
13978
13979
13980 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
13981 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
13982 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
13983 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
13984 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
13985 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
13986 and constrained to be a file.
13987
13988
13989 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
13990 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
13991 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
13992 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
13993 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
13994
13995
13996 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
13997 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
13998 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
13999 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14000 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14001 identity to be proven.
14002
14003
14004 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14005 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14006 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14007 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14008 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14009
14010
14011 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14012 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14013 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14014 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14015 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14016 with LDAP support.
14017
14018
14019 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14020 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14021 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14022 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14023 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14024 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14025 to hard/demand.
14026
14027
14028 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14029 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14030 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14031 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14032 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14033 of SSL-on-connect.
14034 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14035 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14036
14037
14038 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14039 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14040 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14041 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14042 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14043 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14044 has been built with LDAP support.
14045
14046
14047
14048 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14049 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14050 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14051 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14052 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14053 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14054 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14055
14056 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14057 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14058 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14059
14060 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14061 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14062 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14063 and the default qualify domain.
14064
14065 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14066 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14067 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14068 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14069
14070 .cindex "envelope sender"
14071 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14072 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14073 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14074
14075 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14076 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14077 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14078
14079
14080
14081
14082 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14083 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14084 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14085 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14086 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14087 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14088 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14089 example, if
14090 .code
14091 local_from_prefix = *-
14092 .endd
14093 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14094 .code
14095 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14096 .endd
14097 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14098 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14099 qualify domain.
14100
14101
14102 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14103 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14104
14105
14106 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14107 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14108 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14109 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14110 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14111 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14112 &%local_interfaces%& is
14113 .code
14114 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14115 .endd
14116 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14117 .code
14118 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14119 .endd
14120
14121 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14122 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14123 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14124 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14125 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14126 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14127 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14128 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14129
14130
14131
14132 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14133 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14134 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14135 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14136 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14137 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14138 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14139 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14140
14141
14142
14143
14144 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14145 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14146 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14147 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14148 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14149 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14150 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14151 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14152 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14153 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14154 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14155 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14156 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14157 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14158 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14159
14160
14161
14162 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14163 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14164 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14165 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14166 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14167 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14168 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14169 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14170 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14171 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14172 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14173 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14174 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14175 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14176
14177
14178 .option log_selector main string unset
14179 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14180 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14181 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14182 minus characters. For example:
14183 .code
14184 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14185 .endd
14186 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14187 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14188
14189
14190 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14191 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14192 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14193 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14194 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14195 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14196 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14197 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14198 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14199 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14200 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14201 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14202 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14203
14204
14205 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14206 .cindex "too many open files"
14207 .cindex "open files, too many"
14208 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14209 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14210 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14211 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14212 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14213 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14214 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14215 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14216 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14217 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14218 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14219 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14220
14221
14222 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14223 .cindex "length of login name"
14224 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14225 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14226 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14227 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14228 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14229 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14230
14231
14232 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14233 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14234 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14235 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14236 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14237 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14238 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14239 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14240
14241
14242 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14243 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14244 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14245 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14246 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14247 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14248 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14249
14250
14251 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14252 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14253 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14254 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14255 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14256 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14257 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14258 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14259 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14260 empty string, the option is ignored.
14261
14262
14263 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14264 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14265 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14266 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14267 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14268 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14269 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14270 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14271 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14272 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14273 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14274 colons will become hyphens.
14275
14276
14277 .option message_logs main boolean true
14278 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14279 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14280 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14281 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14282 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14283 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14284 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14285 which is not affected by this option.
14286
14287
14288 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14289 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14290 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14291 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14292 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14293 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14294 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14295 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14296 optionally followed by K or M.
14297
14298 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14299 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14300 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14301 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14302 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14303
14304 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14305 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14306 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14307 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14308 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14309 message that an individual transport can process.
14310
14311 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14312 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14313 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14314 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14315 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14316 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14317 some problems may result.
14318
14319 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14320 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14321 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14322
14323
14324 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14325 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14326 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14327 .code
14328 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14329 .endd
14330 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14331 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14332 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14333 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14334 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14335
14336
14337 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14338 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14339 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14340 contains a full description of this facility.
14341
14342
14343
14344 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14345 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14346 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14347 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14348 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14349
14350
14351 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14352 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14353 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14354 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14355 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14356 safety precaution.
14357
14358 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14359 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14360 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14361 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14362 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14363
14364 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14365 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14366 example is
14367 .code
14368 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14369 .endd
14370 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14371 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14372 transport driver.
14373
14374
14375 .option openssl_options main "string list" unset
14376 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14377 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14378 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14379 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14380
14381 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14382 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14383 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14384 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14385 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14386 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14387 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14388
14389 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14390 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14391 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14392 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14393 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14394
14395 .new
14396 Historical note: prior to release 4.78, Exim defaulted this value to
14397 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14398 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14399 some now infamous attacks.
14400 .wen
14401
14402 An example:
14403 .code
14404 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14405 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14406 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14407 .endd
14408
14409 Possible options may include:
14410 .ilist
14411 &`all`&
14412 .next
14413 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14414 .next
14415 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14416 .next
14417 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14418 .next
14419 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
14420 .next
14421 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14422 .next
14423 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14424 .next
14425 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14426 .next
14427 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14428 .next
14429 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14430 .next
14431 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14432 .next
14433 &`no_compression`&
14434 .next
14435 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14436 .next
14437 &`no_sslv2`&
14438 .next
14439 &`no_sslv3`&
14440 .next
14441 &`no_ticket`&
14442 .next
14443 &`no_tlsv1`&
14444 .next
14445 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
14446 .next
14447 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
14448 .next
14449 &`single_dh_use`&
14450 .next
14451 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14452 .next
14453 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14454 .next
14455 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14456 .next
14457 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14458 .next
14459 &`tls_d5_bug`&
14460 .next
14461 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14462 .endlist
14463
14464
14465 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14466 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14467 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14468 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14469 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14470
14471
14472 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14473 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14474 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14475 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14476 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14477 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14478 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14479 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14480 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14481 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14482 an ACL.
14483
14484 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14485 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14486 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14487 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14488 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14489 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14490 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14491
14492
14493 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14494 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14495 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14496
14497
14498 .option perl_startup main string unset
14499 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14500 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14501
14502
14503 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14504 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14505 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14506 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14507 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14508 PostgreSQL support.
14509
14510
14511 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14512 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14513 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14514 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14515 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14516 to the host name:
14517 .code
14518 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14519 .endd
14520 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14521 spool directory.
14522 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14523 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14524 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14525
14526
14527 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14528 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14529 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14530 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14531 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14532 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14533 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14534 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14535 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14536
14537
14538 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14539 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14540 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14541 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14542 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14543 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14544 volume of mail. Use with care!
14545
14546
14547 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14548 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14549 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14550 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14551 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14552 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14553 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14554 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14555 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14556 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14557
14558 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14559 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14560 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14561 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14562 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14563 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14564
14565
14566 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14567 .cindex "printing characters"
14568 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14569 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14570 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14571 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14572 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14573 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14574 characters.
14575
14576 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14577 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14578 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14579 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14580 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14581 standards.
14582
14583
14584 .option process_log_path main string unset
14585 .cindex "process log path"
14586 .cindex "log" "process log"
14587 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14588 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14589 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14590 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14591 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14592 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14593 different spool directories.
14594
14595
14596 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14597 .oindex "&%-M%&"
14598 .oindex "&%-R%&"
14599 .oindex "&%-q%&"
14600 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14601 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14602 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14603
14604
14605 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14606 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14607 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14608 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14609 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14610 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14611 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14612 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14613 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14614
14615 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14616 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14617 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14618 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14619 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14620 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14621 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14622
14623
14624 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14625 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14626 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14627
14628
14629
14630 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14631 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14632 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14633 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14634 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14635 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14636 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14637 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14638
14639
14640 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14641 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
14642 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14643 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14644 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14645
14646
14647 .option queue_only main boolean false
14648 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14649 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14650 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14651 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14652 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14653 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14654
14655 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14656 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14657 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14658 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14659
14660
14661 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14662 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14663 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14664 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14665 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14666 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14667 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14668 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14669 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14670 .code
14671 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14672 .endd
14673 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14674 &_/some/file_& exists.
14675
14676
14677 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14678 .cindex "load average"
14679 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14680 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14681 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14682 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14683 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14684 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14685 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14686 false.
14687
14688 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14689 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14690 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14691 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14692
14693
14694 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14695 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14696 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14697 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14698 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14699 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14700 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14701 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14702 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14703 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14704 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14705 re-evaluated for each message.
14706
14707
14708 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14709 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14710 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14711 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14712 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14713 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14714
14715
14716 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14717 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14718 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14719 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14720 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14721 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14722 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14723 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14724 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14725 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14726 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14727 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14728 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14729
14730
14731
14732 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14733 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14734 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14735 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14736 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14737 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14738 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14739 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14740 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14741
14742 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14743 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14744 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14745 the daemon's command line.
14746
14747 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14748 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14749 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14750 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14751 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14752 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14753 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14754 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14755 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14756 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14757 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14758 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14759 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14760 &%queue_domains%&.
14761
14762
14763 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14764 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14765 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14766 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14767 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14768 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14769 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14770
14771 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14772 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14773 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14774 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14775 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14776 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14777 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14778 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14779 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14780 header lines. The default setting is:
14781
14782 .code
14783 received_header_text = Received: \
14784 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14785 {${if def:sender_ident \
14786 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14787 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14788 by $primary_hostname \
14789 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14790 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14791 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14792 ${if def:sender_address \
14793 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14794 id $message_exim_id\
14795 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14796 .endd
14797
14798 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14799 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14800 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14801 header lines such as the following:
14802 .code
14803 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14804 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14805 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14806 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14807 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14808 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14809 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14810 .endd
14811 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14812 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14813 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14814 message was accepted.
14815
14816
14817 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14818 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14819 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14820 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14821 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14822 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14823 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14824 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14825
14826
14827 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14828 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14829 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14830 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14831 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14832 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14833 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14834 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14835 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14836 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14837 option was not set.
14838
14839
14840 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14841 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14842 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14843 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14844 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14845 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14846 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14847 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14848 done.
14849
14850 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14851 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14852 RCPT commands in a single message.
14853
14854
14855 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14856 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14857 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14858 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14859 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14860 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14861 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14862
14863
14864 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14865 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14866 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14867 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14868 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14869 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14870 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14871 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14872 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14873 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14874 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14875 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14876 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14877 tagged with its process id.
14878
14879 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14880 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14881 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14882 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14883 is received.
14884
14885 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14886 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14887 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14888 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14889 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14890 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14891 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14892 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14893 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14894 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14895 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14896
14897 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14898 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14899 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14900 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14901
14902
14903 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14904 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14905 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14906 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14907 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14908 .code
14909 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14910 .endd
14911 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14912 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14913
14914
14915 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14916 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14917 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14918 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14919 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14920 past failures.
14921
14922
14923 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14924 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14925 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14926 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14927 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14928 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14929 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14930 the default value.
14931
14932
14933 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14934 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14935 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14936 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14937 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14938 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14939 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14940 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14941 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14942 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14943
14944
14945 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14946 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14947
14948
14949 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14950 .cindex "RFC 1413"
14951 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14952 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14953 in the list.
14954
14955 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14956 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14957 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14958 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14959 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14960
14961
14962 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14963 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14964 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14965 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14966 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14967 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14968 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14969 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14970 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14971 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14972
14973
14974 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14975 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14976 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14977 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14978 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14979 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14980 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14981 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14982 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14983 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14984 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14985
14986
14987
14988 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14989 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14990 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14991 .cindex "inetd"
14992 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14993 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14994 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14995 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14996 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14997 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14998
14999 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15000 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15001 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15002 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15003
15004
15005 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15006 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15007 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15008 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15009 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15010 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15011 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15012 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15013
15014 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15015 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15016 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15017 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15018 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15019 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15020 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15021 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15022
15023
15024 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15025 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15026 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15027 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15028 live with.
15029
15030
15031 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15032 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15033
15034 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15035 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15036 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15037 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15038 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15039 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15040 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15041 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15042 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15043 seen).
15044
15045
15046 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15047 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15048 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15049 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15050 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15051 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15052 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15053 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15054 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15055 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15056 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15057
15058 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15059 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15060 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15061 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15062 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15063 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15064
15065
15066
15067 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15068 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15069 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15070 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15071 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15072 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15073 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15074 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15075 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15076 to all messages received in the same connection.
15077
15078 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15079 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15080 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15081 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15082
15083
15084 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15085 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15086
15087 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
15088 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15089 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15090 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15091 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15092 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15093 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15094 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15095 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15096 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15097 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15098 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15099 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15100
15101
15102 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15103 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15104 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15105 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15106 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15107 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15108 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15109 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15110 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15111 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15112 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15113 individual host.
15114
15115 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15116 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15117 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15118 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15119
15120
15121 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15122 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15123 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15124 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15125 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15126 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15127 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15128 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15129 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15130
15131 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15132 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15133 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15134 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15135
15136 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15137 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15138 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15139 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15140 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15141 For example:
15142 .code
15143 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15144 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15145 .endd
15146
15147 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15148 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15149 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15150 &%helo_data%& value.
15151
15152 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15153 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15154 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15155 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15156 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15157 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15158 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15159 .code
15160 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15161 $version_number $tod_full
15162 .endd
15163 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15164 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15165 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15166 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15167 multiline response).
15168
15169
15170 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15171 .cindex "checking disk space"
15172 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15173 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15174 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15175 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15176 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15177 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15178 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15179
15180
15181 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15182 .cindex "connection backlog"
15183 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15184 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15185 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15186 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15187 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15188 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15189 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15190 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15191 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15192 attacks by SYN flooding.
15193
15194
15195 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15196 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15197 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15198 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15199 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15200 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15201 fewer, but they still exist.
15202
15203 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15204 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15205 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15206 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15207 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15208 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15209 does detect many instances.
15210
15211 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15212 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15213 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15214 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15215
15216
15217
15218 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15219 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15220 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15221 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15222 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15223 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15224 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15225 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15226 example:
15227 .code
15228 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15229 $sender_host_address
15230 .endd
15231 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15232 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15233 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15234 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15235 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15236 the command.
15237
15238
15239 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15240 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15241 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15242 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15243 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15244
15245
15246 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15247 .cindex "load average"
15248 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15249 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15250 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15251 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15252 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15253 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15254
15255
15256
15257 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15258 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15259 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15260 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15261 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15262 .code
15263 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15264 .endd
15265 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15266 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15267 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15268 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15269 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15270
15271 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15272 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15273 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15274 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15275 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15276 not count towards the limit.
15277
15278
15279
15280 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15281 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15282 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15283 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15284 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15285 that subvert web
15286 clients
15287 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15288 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15289
15290
15291
15292 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15293 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15294 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15295 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15296 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15297 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15298 recipients.
15299
15300 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15301 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15302 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15303 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15304
15305 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15306 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15307 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15308 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15309 values:
15310
15311 .ilist
15312 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15313 .next
15314 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15315 fractional parts are allowed here.
15316 .next
15317 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15318 .next
15319 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15320 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15321 .endlist
15322
15323 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15324 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15325 .code
15326 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15327 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15328 .endd
15329 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15330 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15331 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15332 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15333
15334
15335 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15336 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15337
15338
15339 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15340 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15341
15342
15343 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15344 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15345 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15346 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15347 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15348 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15349 the message is abandoned.
15350 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15351 .code
15352 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15353 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15354 .endd
15355 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15356 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15357
15358
15359 .oindex "&%-os%&"
15360 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15361 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15362 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15363 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15364 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15365
15366
15367 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15368 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15369 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15370
15371
15372 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15373 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15374 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15375 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15376 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15377 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15378 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15379 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15380 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15381 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15382 .code
15383 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15384 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15385 .endd
15386
15387 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15388 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15389 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15390 The default value is
15391 .code
15392 127.0.0.1 783
15393 .endd
15394 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15395
15396
15397
15398 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15399 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15400 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15401 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15402 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15403 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15404 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15405 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15406 arrival of the message.
15407
15408 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15409 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15410 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15411 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15412 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15413
15414 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15415 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15416 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15417 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15418 automatically deleted.
15419
15420 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15421 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15422 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15423 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15424 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15425 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15426 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15427 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15428 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15429
15430
15431 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15432 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15433 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15434 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15435 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15436 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15437 &$primary_hostname$&.
15438
15439 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15440 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15441 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15442 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15443 as failures in the configuration file.
15444
15445 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15446 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15447
15448 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15449 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15450 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15451 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15452
15453 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15454 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15455 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15456 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15457 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15458 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15459
15460 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15461 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15462 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15463 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15464 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15465 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15466 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15467
15468
15469 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15470 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15471 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15472 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15473 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15474 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15475 domain causes a syntax error.
15476 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15477 syntax checking.
15478
15479
15480 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15481 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15482 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15483 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15484 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15485 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15486 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15487 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15488 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15489 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15490 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15491 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15492
15493
15494 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15495 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15496 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15497 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15498 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15499 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15500 details of Exim's logging.
15501
15502
15503
15504 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15505 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15506 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15507 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15508 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15509
15510
15511
15512 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15513 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15514 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15515 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15516 details of Exim's logging.
15517
15518
15519 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15520 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15521 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15522 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15523 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15524 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15525 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15526 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15527 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15528 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15529 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15530
15531
15532 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15533 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15534 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15535 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15536 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15537 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15538
15539
15540 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15541 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15542 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15543 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15544 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15545
15546 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15547 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15548 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15549 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15550 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15551
15552 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15553 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15554 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15555 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15556 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15557 contains the pipe command.
15558
15559
15560 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15561 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15562 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15563 is used in a system filter.
15564
15565
15566 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15567 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15568 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15569 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15570 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15571 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15572 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15573 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15574 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15575 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15576
15577 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15578 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15579 transport option overrides.
15580
15581
15582 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15583 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15584 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15585 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15586 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15587 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15588 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15589 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15590 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15591 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15592 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15593 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15594 TCP_NODELAY.
15595
15596
15597 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15598 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15599 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15600 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15601 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15602 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15603 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15604 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15605 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15606 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15607
15608 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15609 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15610 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15611
15612
15613 .option timezone main string unset
15614 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15615 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15616 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15617 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15618 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15619 .code
15620 timezone = UTC
15621 .endd
15622 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15623 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15624 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15625 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15626 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15627 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15628
15629
15630 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15631 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15632 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15633 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15634 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15635 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15636 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15637 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15638
15639
15640 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15641 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15642 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15643 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15644 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15645 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15646 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15647
15648 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15649 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15650 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15651 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15652
15653 .new
15654 If the option contains &$tls_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
15655 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
15656 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
15657 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
15658 .wen
15659
15660 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15661 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15662 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15663 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15664 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15665
15666 .new
15667 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15668 .wen
15669
15670
15671 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15672 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15673 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15674 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15675 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15676 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15677
15678
15679 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15680 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15681 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15682 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15683 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15684
15685
15686
15687 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15688 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15689 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15690 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15691 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15692 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15693 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15694
15695 .new
15696 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15697 .wen
15698
15699
15700 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15701 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15702 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15703 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15704 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15705 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15706 TLS session.
15707
15708
15709 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15710 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15711 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15712 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15713 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15714 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15715 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15716 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15717 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15718 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15719 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15720
15721
15722 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15723 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15724 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15725 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15726
15727
15728 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15729 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15730 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15731 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15732 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15733 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15734 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15735 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15736 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15737
15738 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
15739 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
15740 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
15741 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
15742 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
15743 use OpenSSL with a directory.
15744
15745 .new
15746 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15747 .wen
15748
15749
15750 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15751 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15752 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15753 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15754 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15755 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15756 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15757 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15758
15759 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15760 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15761 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15762 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15763 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15764 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15765 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15766
15767 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15768 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15769 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15770 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15771 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15772 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15773 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15774 certificate"&.
15775
15776 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15777 certificates.
15778
15779
15780 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15781 .cindex "trusted groups"
15782 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15783 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15784 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15785 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15786 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15787 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15788 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15789 are trusted.
15790
15791 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15792 .cindex "trusted users"
15793 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15794 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15795 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15796 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15797 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15798 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15799 Exim user are trusted.
15800
15801 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15802 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15803 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15804 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15805 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15806 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15807 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15808 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15809 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15810 &%-F%& option.
15811
15812 .option unknown_username main string unset
15813 See &%unknown_login%&.
15814
15815 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15816 .cindex "trusted users"
15817 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15818 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15819 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15820 .cindex "envelope sender"
15821 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15822 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15823 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15824 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15825 is used) is ignored.
15826
15827 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15828 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15829 .code
15830 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15831 .endd
15832 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15833 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15834 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15835 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15836 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15837 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15838 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15839 followed by a hyphen
15840 by a setting like this:
15841 .code
15842 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15843 .endd
15844 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15845 restriction, you can use
15846 .code
15847 untrusted_set_sender = *
15848 .endd
15849 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15850 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15851 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15852 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15853 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15854 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15855 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15856 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15857
15858 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15859 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15860 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15861 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15862 sender address.
15863
15864
15865 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15866 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15867 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15868 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15869 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15870 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15871 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15872 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15873 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15874 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15875 .code
15876 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15877 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15878 .endd
15879 The pattern can be seen by running
15880 .code
15881 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15882 .endd
15883 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15884 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15885 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15886 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15887 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15888 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15889
15890
15891 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15892 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15893
15894
15895 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15896 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15897 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15898 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15899 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15900 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15901 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15902 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15903
15904
15905 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15906 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15907 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15908 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15909 .ecindex IIDconfima
15910 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15911
15912
15913
15914
15915 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15916 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15917
15918 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15919 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15920 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15921 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15922 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
15923
15924 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15925 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15926 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15927 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15928 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15929
15930
15931
15932 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15933 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15934 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15935 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15936 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15937 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15938 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15939
15940 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15941 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15942 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15943 routers, and the eventual transport.
15944
15945 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15946 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15947 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15948 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15949 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15950
15951 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15952 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15953 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15954 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15955 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15956
15957 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15958 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15959 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15960 .code
15961 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15962 .endd
15963 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15964 .code
15965 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15966 .endd
15967 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15968 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15969
15970 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15971 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15972 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15973 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15974 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15975 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15976 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15977
15978
15979
15980 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15981 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
15982 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15983 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15984 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15985 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15986 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15987 routing.
15988
15989
15990
15991 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15992 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15993 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15994 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15995 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15996 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15997 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15998 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15999 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16000 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16001 you could put:
16002 .code
16003 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16004 .endd
16005 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16006 and
16007 .code
16008 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16009 .endd
16010 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16011 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16012 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16013 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16014
16015
16016 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16017 .cindex "case of local parts"
16018 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16019 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16020 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16021 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16022 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16023 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16024 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16025 more details.
16026
16027 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16028 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16029 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16030 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16031 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16032 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16033 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16034 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16035 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16036
16037 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16038 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16039 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16040 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16041
16042
16043
16044 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16045 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16046 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16047 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16048 .vindex "&$home$&"
16049 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16050 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16051 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16052 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16053 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16054 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16055 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16056 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16057 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16058 the router is skipped.
16059
16060 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16061 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16062 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16063 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16064 setting to achieve this. For example:
16065 .code
16066 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16067 .endd
16068 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16069 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16070 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16071
16072
16073
16074 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16075 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16076 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16077 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16078 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16079 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16080 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16081 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16082
16083 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16084 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16085
16086 This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16087 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16088
16089 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16090 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16091 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16092 .code
16093 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16094 .endd
16095 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16096 .code
16097 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16098 .endd
16099
16100 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16101 .code
16102 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16103 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16104 condition = foobar
16105 .endd
16106
16107 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16108 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16109 be specified using &%condition%&.
16110
16111
16112 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16113 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16114 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16115 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16116 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16117 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16118 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16119 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16120 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16121 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16122 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16123 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16124
16125
16126
16127 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16128 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16129 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16130 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16131 transport option of the same name.
16132
16133
16134 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16135 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16136 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16137 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16138 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16139 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16140 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16141 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16142
16143
16144
16145 .option driver routers string unset
16146 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16147 to be used.
16148
16149
16150
16151 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16152 .cindex "envelope sender"
16153 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16154 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16155 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16156 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16157 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16158 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16159 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16160
16161 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16162 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16163 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16164 setting.
16165
16166 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16167 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16168 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16169 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16170
16171 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16172 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16173 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16174 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16175 settings:
16176 .code
16177 errors_to =
16178 errors_to = ""
16179 .endd
16180 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16181 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16182 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16183 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16184 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16185
16186 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16187 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16188 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16189 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16190 setting &%return_path%&.
16191
16192 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16193 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16194 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16195
16196
16197
16198 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16199 .cindex "address" "testing"
16200 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16201 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16202 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16203 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16204 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16205 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16206 on for the system alias file.
16207 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16208 are evaluated.
16209
16210 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16211 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16212 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16213
16214
16215
16216 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16217 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16218 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16219 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16220
16221
16222
16223 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16224 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16225 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16226
16227
16228
16229 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16230 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16231 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16232
16233
16234
16235 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16236 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16237 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16238 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16239 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16240 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16241 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16242 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16243 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16244
16245 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16246 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16247 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16248 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16249 transport for further details.
16250
16251
16252 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16253 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16254 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16255 .cindex "transport" "local"
16256 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16257 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16258 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16259 process.
16260 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16261 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16262 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16263 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16264 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16265
16266
16267
16268 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16269 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16270 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16271 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16272 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16273 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16274 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16275 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16276 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16277 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16278 &"see"& the added header lines.
16279
16280 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16281 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16282 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16283 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16284
16285 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16286 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16287
16288 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16289 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16290 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16291 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16292 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16293 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16294 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16295 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16296 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16297 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16298
16299
16300
16301 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16302 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16303 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16304 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16305 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16306 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16307 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16308 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16309 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16310 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16311 &"see"& the original header lines.
16312
16313 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16314 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16315 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16316 errors.
16317
16318 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16319 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16320
16321 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16322 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16323 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16324 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16325
16326
16327 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16328 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16329 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16330 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16331 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16332 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16333 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16334 like
16335 .code
16336 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16337 .endd
16338 by setting
16339 .code
16340 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16341 .endd
16342 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16343 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16344 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16345 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16346 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16347 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16348
16349 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16350 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16351 .code
16352 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16353 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16354 .endd
16355 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16356 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16357
16358 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16359 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16360 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16361 domain that is being routed.
16362
16363 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16364 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16365 checked.
16366
16367 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16368 .cindex "additional groups"
16369 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16370 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16371 .cindex "transport" "local"
16372 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16373 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16374 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16375 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16376 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16377
16378
16379
16380 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16381 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16382 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16383 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16384 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16385 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16386 evaluated.
16387
16388 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16389 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16390 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16391 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16392 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16393 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16394 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16395 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16396 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16397
16398 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16400 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16401 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16402 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16403 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16404 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16405 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16406 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16407 the relevant transport.
16408
16409 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16410 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16411 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16412 callout.
16413
16414 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16415 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16416 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16417 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16418 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16419 .code
16420 real_localuser:
16421 driver = accept
16422 local_part_prefix = real-
16423 check_local_user
16424 transport = local_delivery
16425 .endd
16426 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16427 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16428 .code
16429 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16430 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16431 .endd
16432
16433 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16434 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16435 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16436 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16437
16438
16439 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16440 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16441
16442
16443
16444 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16445 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16446 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16447 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16448 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16449 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16450 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16451 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16452 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16453 &%username-foo%&.
16454
16455
16456 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16457 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16458
16459
16460
16461 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16462 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16463 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16464 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16465 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16466 are evaluated, and
16467 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16468 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16469 example:
16470 .code
16471 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16472 .endd
16473 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16474 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16475 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16476 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16477 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16478 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16479 each virtual domain:
16480 .code
16481 postmaster:
16482 driver = redirect
16483 local_parts = postmaster
16484 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16485 .endd
16486
16487
16488 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16489 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16490 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16491 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16492 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16493 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16494 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16495 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16496 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16497 redirect addresses.
16498
16499
16500
16501 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16502 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16503 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16504 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16505 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16506 delivery to be deferred.
16507
16508 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16509 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16510 .oindex "&%self%&"
16511 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16512 means of the setting
16513 .code
16514 self = pass
16515 .endd
16516 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16517 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16518 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16519
16520 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16521 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16522 controls what happens next.
16523
16524
16525 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16526 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16527 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16528 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16529 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16530 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16531 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16532 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16533
16534 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16535 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16536 applies to all of them.
16537
16538
16539
16540 .option pass_router routers string unset
16541 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16542 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16543 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16544 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16545 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16546 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16547 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16548 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16549 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16550 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16551
16552
16553
16554 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16555 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16556 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16557 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16558 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16559 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16560
16561 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16562 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16563 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16564 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16565
16566
16567
16568 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16569 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16570 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16571 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16572 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16573 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16574 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16575
16576 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16577 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16578 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16579 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16580
16581 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16582 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16583 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16584 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16585 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16586
16587 .cindex "NFS"
16588 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16589 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16590 unavailable.
16591
16592 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16593 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16594 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16595 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16596 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16597 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16598 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16599 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16600
16601 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16602 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16603 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16604 operates as follows:
16605
16606 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16607 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16608 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16609 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16610 used. For example:
16611 .code
16612 require_files = mail:/some/file
16613 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16614 .endd
16615 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16616 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16617
16618 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16619 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16620 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16621 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16622
16623 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16624 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16625 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16626 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16627 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16628
16629 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16630 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16631 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16632 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16633 check again in that process.
16634
16635 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16636 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16637 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16638 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16639 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16640 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16641 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16642 .code
16643 require_files = +/some/file
16644 .endd
16645 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16646 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16647 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16648
16649
16650
16651 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16652 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16653 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16654 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16655 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16656 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16657 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16658 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16659 latter kind.
16660
16661 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16662 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16663 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16664 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16665 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16666 same name.
16667
16668 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16669 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16670 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16671
16672
16673
16674 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16675 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16676 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16677 .vindex "&$home$&"
16678 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16679 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16680 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16681 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16682 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16683 cause the router to defer.
16684
16685 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16686 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16687 place.
16688 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16689 are evaluated.)
16690 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16691 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16692
16693 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16694 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16695 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16696 of these values that is set:
16697
16698 .ilist
16699 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16700 .next
16701 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16702 .next
16703 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16704 .next
16705 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16706 .endlist
16707
16708 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16709 router, but not for the transport.
16710
16711
16712
16713 .option self routers string freeze
16714 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16715 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16716 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16717 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16718 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16719 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16720 of remote hosts.
16721 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16722 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16723 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16724 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16725 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16726
16727 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16728 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16729 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16730 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16731 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16732 cases:
16733
16734 .vlist
16735 .vitem &%defer%&
16736 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16737
16738 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16739 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16740 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16741 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16742
16743 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16744 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16745 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16746 rewritten.
16747
16748 .vitem &%pass%&
16749 .oindex "&%more%&"
16750 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16751 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16752 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16753 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16754 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16755 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16756 combination
16757 .code
16758 self = pass
16759 no_more
16760 .endd
16761 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16762 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16763 be passed to the next router.
16764
16765 .vitem &%fail%&
16766 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16767
16768 .vitem &%send%&
16769 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16770 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16771 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16772 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16773 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16774 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16775 .endlist
16776
16777
16778
16779 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16780 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16781 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16782 address matches something on the list.
16783 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16784 are evaluated.
16785
16786 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16787 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16788 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16789 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16790 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16791 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16792 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16793 matters.
16794
16795
16796 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16797 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16798 .cindex "packet radio"
16799 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16800 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16801 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16802 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16803 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16804 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16805 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16806 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16807
16808 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16809 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16810 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16811 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16812 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16813 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16814 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16815 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16816 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16817 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16818 .code
16819 translate_ip_address = \
16820 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16821 {$value}fail}}
16822 .endd
16823 The file would contain lines like
16824 .code
16825 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16826 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16827 .endd
16828 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16829 are doing.
16830
16831
16832
16833 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16834 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16835 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16836 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16837 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16838 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16839 delivery is deferred.
16840
16841 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16842 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16843 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16844
16845
16846
16847 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16848 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16849 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16850 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16851 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16852 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16853 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16854 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16855 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16856 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16857 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16858 environment.
16859
16860
16861
16862
16863 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16864 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16865 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16866 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16867 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16868 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16869 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16870 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16871 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16872 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16873
16874 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16875 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16876 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16877 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16878 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16879
16880 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16881 environment.
16882
16883
16884
16885
16886 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16887 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16888 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16889 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16890 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16891 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16892 delivery to be deferred.
16893
16894 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16895 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16896 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16897 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16898 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16899 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16900
16901 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16902 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16903 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16904 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16905 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16906 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16907 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16908 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16909
16910 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16911 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16912 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16913 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16914 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16915 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16916 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16917 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16918 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16919 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16920
16921 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16922 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16923 subsequent routers.
16924
16925
16926 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16927 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16928 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16929 .cindex "transport" "local"
16930 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16931 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16932 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16933 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16934 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16935 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16936 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16937 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16938 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16939 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16940 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16941 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16942
16943
16944
16945 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16946 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16947 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16948
16949
16950 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16951 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16952 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
16953 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16954 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16955 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16956 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16957 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16958 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16959
16960 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16961 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16962 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16963 user or group.
16964
16965
16966 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16967 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16968 addresses
16969 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16970 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16971 are evaluated.
16972
16973
16974 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16975 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16976 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16977 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16978 are evaluated.
16979 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16980 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16981
16982
16983
16984
16985
16986
16987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16988 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16989
16990 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16991 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16992 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16993 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16994 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16995 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16996 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16997 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16998 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16999 .code
17000 localusers:
17001 driver = accept
17002 domains = mydomain.example
17003 check_local_user
17004 transport = local_delivery
17005 .endd
17006 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17007 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17008 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17009 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17010
17011
17012
17013
17014
17015
17016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17018
17019 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17020 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17021 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17022 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17023 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17024 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17025
17026 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17027 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17028 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17029 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17030 records.
17031
17032 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17033 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17034 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17035 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17036 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17037 generic option, the router declines.
17038
17039 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17040 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17041 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17042
17043 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17044 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17045 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17046 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17047 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17048 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17049
17050
17051 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17052 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17053 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17054 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17055 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17056 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17057
17058 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17059 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17060 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17061 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17062 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17063 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17064 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17065 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17066 case routing fails.
17067
17068
17069
17070
17071 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17072 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17073 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17074
17075 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17076 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17077 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17078 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17079 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17080 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17081 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17082
17083
17084 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17085 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17086 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17087 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17088 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17089 required. For example,
17090 .code
17091 check_srv = smtp
17092 .endd
17093 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17094 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17095 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17096 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17097 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17098 normal way.
17099
17100 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17101 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17102 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17103 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17104 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17105 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17106
17107 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17108 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17109 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17110 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17111 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17112 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17113 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17114 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17115
17116 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17117 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17118
17119
17120
17121 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17122 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17123 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17124 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17125 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17126 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17127 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17128 setting:
17129 .code
17130 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17131 .endd
17132 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17133 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17134 the address record.
17135
17136
17137 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17138 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17139 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17140 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17141
17142
17143
17144
17145 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17146 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17147 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17148 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17149 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17150 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17151 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17152 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17153 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17154 &'resolv.conf'&.
17155
17156
17157
17158 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17159 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17160 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17161 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17162 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17163 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17164 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17165 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17166 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17167 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17168 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17169
17170 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17171 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17172 sense.
17173
17174 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17175 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17176 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17177 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17178 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17179 header rewriting.
17180
17181
17182 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17183 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17184 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17185 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17186 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17187 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17188 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17189 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17190
17191 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17192 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17193 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17194 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17195 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17196 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17197 without processing them independently,
17198 provided the following conditions are met:
17199
17200 .ilist
17201 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17202 &%headers_remove%&.
17203 .next
17204 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17205 the domain.
17206 .endlist
17207
17208
17209
17210
17211 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17212 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17213 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17214 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17215 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17216 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17217 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17218 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17219 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17220 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17221
17222 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17223 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17224 local wildcard.
17225
17226
17227
17228 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17229 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17230 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17231 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17232
17233
17234
17235
17236 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17237 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17238 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17239 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17240 if
17241 .code
17242 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17243 .endd
17244 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17245 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17246 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17247 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17248 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17249 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17250
17251
17252 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17253 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17254 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17255 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17256 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17257
17258 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17259 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17260 such as that implied by
17261 .code
17262 domains = @mx_any
17263 .endd
17264 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17265 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17266 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17267 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17268
17269
17270
17271
17272
17273
17274
17275
17276
17277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17278 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17279
17280 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17281 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17282 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17283 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17284 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17285 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17286 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17287 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17288 router handles the address
17289 .code
17290 root@[192.168.1.1]
17291 .endd
17292 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17293 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17294 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17295 .code
17296 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17297 .endd
17298 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17299 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17300
17301 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17302 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17303 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17304 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17305
17306 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17307 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17308 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17309 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17310
17311
17312
17313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17315
17316 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17317 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17318 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17319 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17320 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17321 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17322 must set
17323 .code
17324 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17325 .endd
17326 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17327
17328 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17329 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17330 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17331 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17332 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17333 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17334 must not be specified for it.
17335
17336 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17337 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17338 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17339 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17340 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17341 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17342 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17343
17344
17345 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17346 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17347 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17348 delivery to the address is deferred.
17349
17350
17351 .option port iplookup integer 0
17352 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17353 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17354 call.
17355
17356
17357 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17358 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17359 protocols is to be used.
17360
17361
17362 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17363 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17364 default value is:
17365 .code
17366 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17367 .endd
17368 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17369 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17370
17371
17372 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17373 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17374 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17375 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17376 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17377 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17378 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17379 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17380
17381
17382 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17383 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17384 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17385 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17386 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17387 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17388 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17389 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17390 following could be used:
17391 .code
17392 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17393 reroute = $local_part@$1
17394 .endd
17395
17396 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17397 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17398 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17399 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17400
17401
17402
17403
17404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17405 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17406
17407 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17408 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17409 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17410 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17411 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17412 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17413 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17414 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17415 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17416 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17417
17418 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17419 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17420 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17421 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17422 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17423 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17424 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17425
17426 .vindex "&$host$&"
17427 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17428 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17429 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17430 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17431 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17432 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17433 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17434 text string.
17435
17436 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17437 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17438 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17439 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17440 below, following the list of private options.
17441
17442
17443 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17444
17445 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17446 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17447
17448 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17449 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17450
17451 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17452 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17453 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17454 of the following values:
17455 .code
17456 decline
17457 defer
17458 fail
17459 freeze
17460 ignore
17461 pass
17462 .endd
17463 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17464 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17465 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17466 &%pass_router%&),
17467 .oindex "&%more%&"
17468 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17469 router only if &%more%& is true.
17470
17471 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17472 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17473 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17474 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17475
17476 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17477 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17478 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17479
17480
17481 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17482 .cindex "randomized host list"
17483 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17484 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17485 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17486 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17487 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17488 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17489 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17490 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17491
17492 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17493 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17494 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17495 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17496 .code
17497 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17498 .endd
17499 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17500 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17501 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17502 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17503 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17504
17505
17506 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17507 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17508 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17509 example:
17510 .code
17511 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17512 .endd
17513 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17514 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17515 deferred.
17516
17517
17518 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17519 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17520 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17521 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17522
17523
17524 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17525 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17526 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17527 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17528 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17529 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17530 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17531 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17532
17533 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17534 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17535 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17536 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17537 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17538 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17539 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17540 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17541
17542
17543
17544
17545 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17546 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17547 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17548 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17549 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17550 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17551 .display
17552 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17553 .endd
17554 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17555 no options:
17556 .code
17557 route_list = \
17558 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17559 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17560 .endd
17561 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17562 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17563 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17564 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17565 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17566 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17567 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17568 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17569 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17570 in a &%route_list%&).
17571
17572 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17573 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17574 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17575 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17576
17577
17578
17579 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17580 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17581 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17582 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17583 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17584 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17585 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17586 like this:
17587 .code
17588 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17589 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17590 .endd
17591 This data can be accessed by setting
17592 .code
17593 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17594 .endd
17595 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17596 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17597 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17598 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17599 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17600
17601
17602
17603
17604 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17605 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17606 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17607 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17608 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17609 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17610 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17611
17612 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17613 variables are set during its expansion:
17614
17615 .ilist
17616 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17617 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17618 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17619 .code
17620 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17621 .endd
17622 .next
17623 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17624 .next
17625 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17626
17627 .next
17628 .vindex "&$value$&"
17629 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17630 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17631 .code
17632 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17633 .endd
17634 .endlist
17635
17636 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17637 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17638
17639
17640
17641 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17642 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17643 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17644 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17645 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17646 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17647
17648 .ilist
17649 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17650 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17651 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17652 .code
17653 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17654 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17655 .endd
17656 .next
17657 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17658 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17659 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17660 number follows. For example:
17661 .code
17662 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17663 .endd
17664 .endlist
17665
17666 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17667 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17668 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17669 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17670 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17671 transport.
17672
17673 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17674 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17675 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17676 records in the DNS. For example:
17677 .code
17678 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17679 .endd
17680 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17681 example:
17682 .code
17683 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17684 .endd
17685 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17686 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17687 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17688 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17689 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17690 happens is controlled by the
17691 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17692 &%self%& option of the router.
17693
17694 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17695 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17696 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17697 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17698 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17699 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17700 defined by MX preferences.
17701
17702 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17703 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17704 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17705
17706 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17707 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17708 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17709 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17710
17711 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17712 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17713 router.
17714
17715 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17716 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17717 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17718
17719 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17720 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17721
17722
17723
17724 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17725 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17726 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17727 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17728 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17729 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17730 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17731
17732 .ilist
17733 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17734 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17735 .next
17736 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17737 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17738 .next
17739 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17740 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17741 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17742 .next
17743 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17744 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17745 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17746 .endlist
17747
17748 For example:
17749 .code
17750 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17751 domain2 host4:host5
17752 .endd
17753 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17754 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17755 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17756 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17757 call.
17758
17759 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17760 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17761 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17762 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17763 function called.
17764
17765
17766
17767 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17768 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17769
17770 .vindex "&$host$&"
17771 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17772 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17773
17774
17775
17776 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17777 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17778 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17779
17780 .ilist
17781 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17782 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17783 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17784 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17785 .code
17786 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17787 .endd
17788 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17789 your first router something like this:
17790 .code
17791 smart_route:
17792 driver = manualroute
17793 domains = !+local_domains
17794 transport = remote_smtp
17795 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17796 .endd
17797 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17798 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17799 they are tried in order
17800 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17801 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17802 .code
17803 smart_route:
17804 driver = manualroute
17805 transport = remote_smtp
17806 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17807 .endd
17808 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17809 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17810 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17811 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17812 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17813 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17814 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17815 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17816
17817 .next
17818 .cindex "mail hub example"
17819 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17820 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17821 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17822 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17823 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17824 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17825 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17826 lookup is easier to manage.
17827
17828 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17829 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17830 example:
17831 .code
17832 hub_route:
17833 driver = manualroute
17834 transport = remote_smtp
17835 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17836 .endd
17837 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17838 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17839 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17840 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17841 domain can be used to find the host:
17842 .code
17843 through_firewall:
17844 driver = manualroute
17845 transport = remote_smtp
17846 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17847 .endd
17848 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17849 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17850 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17851 next router.
17852
17853 .next
17854 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17855 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17856 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17857 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17858 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17859 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17860 .code
17861 save_in_file:
17862 driver = manualroute
17863 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17864 route_list = saved.domain.example
17865 .endd
17866 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17867 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17868 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17869 .code
17870 save_in_file:
17871 driver = manualroute
17872 route_list = \
17873 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17874 *.saved.domain2.example \
17875 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17876 batch_pipe
17877 .endd
17878 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17879 .vindex "&$host$&"
17880 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17881 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17882 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17883 the address if the lookup fails.
17884
17885 .next
17886 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17887 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17888 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17889 one way it can be done:
17890 .code
17891 # Transport
17892 uucp:
17893 driver = pipe
17894 user = nobody
17895 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17896 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17897 return_fail_output = true
17898
17899 # Router
17900 uucphost:
17901 transport = uucp
17902 driver = manualroute
17903 route_data = \
17904 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17905 .endd
17906 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17907 .code
17908 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17909 .endd
17910 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17911 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17912 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17913 .endlist
17914 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17915 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17916
17917
17918
17919
17920
17921
17922
17923
17924 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17926
17927 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17928 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17929 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17930 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17931 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17932 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17933 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17934 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17935 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17936 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17937 options:
17938 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17939
17940 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17941 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17942 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17943 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17944 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17945
17946
17947 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17948 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17949 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17950 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17951 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17952 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17953
17954
17955 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17956 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17957 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17958 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17959 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17960 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17961 not set, a value for the gid also.
17962
17963 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17964 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17965 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17966 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17967 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17968 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17969 gid.
17970
17971
17972 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17973 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17974 before running the command.
17975
17976
17977 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17978 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17979 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17980 timeout.
17981
17982
17983 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17984 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17985 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17986 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17987 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17988
17989 .ilist
17990 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17991 below).
17992 .next
17993 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17994 &%no_more%& is set.
17995 .next
17996 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17997 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17998 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17999 included in the SMTP response.
18000 .next
18001 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18002 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18003 included in any SMTP response.
18004 .next
18005 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18006 .next
18007 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18008 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18009 .next
18010 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18011 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18012 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18013 .endlist
18014
18015 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18016 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18017 the page):
18018 .code
18019 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18020 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18021 .endd
18022 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18023 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18024 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18025 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18026
18027 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18028 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18029 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18030 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18031 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18032
18033 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18034 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18035 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18036 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18037 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18038
18039 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18040 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18041 variable. For example, this return line
18042 .code
18043 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18044 .endd
18045 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18046 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18047 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18048 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18049
18050
18051
18052
18053 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18054 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18055
18056 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18057 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18058 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18059 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18060 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18061 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18062 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18063 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18064 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18065 redirected in several different ways:
18066
18067 .ilist
18068 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18069 independently.
18070 .next
18071 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18072 .next
18073 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18074 .next
18075 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18076 .next
18077 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18078 .next
18079 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18080 .next
18081 It can be discarded.
18082 .endlist
18083
18084 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18085 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18086 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18087 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18088
18089
18090
18091 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18092 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18093 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18094 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18095 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18096 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18097 .code
18098 system_aliases:
18099 driver = redirect
18100 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18101 .endd
18102 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18103 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18104 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18105 cause delivery to be deferred.
18106
18107 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18108 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18109 .code
18110 userforward:
18111 driver = redirect
18112 check_local_user
18113 file = $home/.forward
18114 no_verify
18115 .endd
18116 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18117 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18118 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18119 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18120 comments.
18121
18122
18123
18124 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18125 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18126 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18127 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18128
18129 .ilist
18130 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18131 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18132 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18133 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18134 .next
18135 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18136 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18137 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18138 saves some resources.
18139 .endlist
18140
18141
18142
18143
18144
18145
18146 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18147 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18148 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18149 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18150 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18151
18152 .ilist
18153 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18154 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18155 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18156 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18157 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18158 document is intended for use by end users.
18159 .next
18160 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18161 described in the next section.
18162 .endlist
18163
18164 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18165 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18166 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18167 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18168 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18169
18170
18171
18172 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18173 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18174 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18175 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18176 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18177 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18178 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18179 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18180 commas or newlines.
18181 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18182 quotes.
18183
18184 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18185 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18186 next newline character is ignored.
18187
18188 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18189 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18190 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18191 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18192 removed.
18193
18194 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18195 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18196 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18197 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18198 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18199 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18200 setting:
18201 .code
18202 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18203 .endd
18204
18205
18206 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18207 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18208 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18209 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18210 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18211 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18212 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18213 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18214 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18215 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18216 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18217
18218 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18219 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18220 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18221 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18222 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18223 .code
18224 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18225 .endd
18226 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18227 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18228 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18229 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18230 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18231 synonymously.
18232
18233 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18234 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18235 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18236 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18237 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18238
18239 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18240 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18241 contains:
18242 .code
18243 Sam.Reman: spqr
18244 .endd
18245 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18246 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18247 this forward file:
18248 .code
18249 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18250 .endd
18251 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18252 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18253 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18254 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18255 should really contain
18256 .code
18257 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18258 .endd
18259 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18260 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18261 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18262
18263
18264
18265 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18266 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18267 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18268
18269 .ilist
18270 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18271 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18272 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18273 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18274 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18275 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18276 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18277
18278 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18279 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18280 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18281 in double quotes, for example:
18282 .code
18283 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18284 .endd
18285 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18286 quote just the command. An item such as
18287 .code
18288 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18289 .endd
18290 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18291
18292 .next
18293 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18294 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18295 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18296 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18297 .code
18298 /home/world/minbari
18299 .endd
18300 is treated as a file name, but
18301 .code
18302 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18303 .endd
18304 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18305 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18306 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18307 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18308
18309 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18310 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18311
18312 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18313 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18314 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18315 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18316
18317 .next
18318 .cindex "included address list"
18319 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18320 If an item is of the form
18321 .code
18322 :include:<path name>
18323 .endd
18324 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18325 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18326 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18327 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18328 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18329 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18330 .code
18331 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18332 .endd
18333 It must be given as
18334 .code
18335 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18336 .endd
18337 .next
18338 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18339 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18340 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18341 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18342 .cindex "black hole"
18343 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18344 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18345 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18346 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18347
18348 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18349 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18350 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18351 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18352 &_/dev/null_&.
18353
18354 .next
18355 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18356 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18357 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18358 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18359 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18360 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18361 redirection items of the form
18362 .code
18363 :defer:
18364 :fail:
18365 .endd
18366 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18367 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18368 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18369 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18370 .code
18371 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18372 .endd
18373 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18374 of a
18375 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18376 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18377 default.
18378 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18379 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18380 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18381
18382 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18383 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18384 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18385 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18386 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18387 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18388 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18389 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18390 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18391 ignored.
18392
18393 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18394 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18395 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18396 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18397
18398 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18399 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18400 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18401 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18402 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18403
18404 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18405 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18406 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18407 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18408 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18409 rules still apply.
18410
18411 .next
18412 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18413 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18414 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18415 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18416 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18417 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18418 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18419 .endlist
18420
18421
18422 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18423 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18424 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18425 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18426 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18427 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18428 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18429 aliasing scheme of the type
18430 .code
18431 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18432 localpart1: pipe
18433 localpart2: pipe
18434 .endd
18435 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18436 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18437 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18438 such as
18439 .code
18440 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18441 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18442 .endd
18443 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18444 the pipes are distinct.
18445
18446
18447
18448 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18449 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18450 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18451 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18452 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18453 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18454 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18455 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18456 can be used to avoid this.
18457
18458
18459 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18460 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18461 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18462 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18463 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18464 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18465 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18466
18467
18468
18469 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18470
18471 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18472 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18473
18474
18475 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18476 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18477 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18478
18479
18480 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18481 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18482 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18483 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18484
18485
18486 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18487 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18488 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18489 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18490 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18491 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18492 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18493
18494 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18495 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18496
18497
18498 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18499 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18500 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18501 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18502 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18503
18504
18505
18506 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18507 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18508 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18509 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18510 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18511 let ordinary users do.
18512
18513
18514
18515 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18516 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18517 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18518 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18519 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18520 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18521
18522 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18523 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18524 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18525 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18526 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18527 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18528 .code
18529 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18530 .endd
18531 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18532 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18533 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18534 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18535 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18536 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18537 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18538 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18539
18540
18541 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18542 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18543 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18544 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18545 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18546 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18547 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18548 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18549
18550
18551
18552 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18553 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18554 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18555 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18556 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18557 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18558
18559
18560 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18561 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18562 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18563 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18564 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18565 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18566
18567 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18568 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18569 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18570 .code
18571 data = #Exim filter\n\
18572 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18573 .endd
18574 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18575 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18576 choice into a newline.
18577
18578
18579 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18580 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18581 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18582 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18583 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18584
18585
18586 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18587 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18588 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18589 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18590 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18591 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18592 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18593 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18594
18595 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18596 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18597 runs a check on the containing directory,
18598 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18599 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18600 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18601 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18602 not, the router declines.
18603
18604
18605 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18606 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18607 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18608 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18609 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18610 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18611 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18612
18613
18614 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18615 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18616 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18617 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18618 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18619
18620
18621 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18622 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18623 redirection list.
18624
18625
18626 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18627 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18628 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18629
18630
18631
18632
18633 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18634 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18635 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18636 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18637 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18638 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18639 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18640 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18641 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18642
18643
18644 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18645 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18646 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18647 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18648 functions.
18649
18650 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18651 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18652 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18653 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18654
18655 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18656 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18657 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18658 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18659 &_.forward_& files).
18660
18661
18662 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18663 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18664 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18665
18666
18667 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18668 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18669 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18670 of the embedded Perl support.
18671
18672
18673 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18674 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18675 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18676
18677
18678 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18679 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18680 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18681
18682
18683 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18684 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18685 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18686 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18687 &%one_time%& is set.
18688
18689
18690 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18691 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18692 to make use of &%run%& items.
18693
18694
18695 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18696 If this option is true, items of the form
18697 .code
18698 :include:<path name>
18699 .endd
18700 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18701
18702
18703 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18704 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18705 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18706 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18707 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18708
18709
18710 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18711 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18712 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18713
18714
18715 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18716 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18717 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18718 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18719 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18720
18721
18722
18723
18724 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18725 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18726 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18727 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18728 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18729 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18730 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18731
18732
18733 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18734 .cindex "EACCES"
18735 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18736 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18737 file did not exist.
18738
18739
18740 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18741 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
18742 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18743 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18744 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18745
18746 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18747 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18748 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18749 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18750 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18751 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18752 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18753 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18754
18755
18756
18757 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18758 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18759 redirection list must start with this directory.
18760
18761
18762 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18763 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18764 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18765
18766
18767 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18768 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18769 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18770 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18771 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18772 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18773 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18774 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18775 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18776 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18777 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18778 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18779 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18780 before they subscribed.
18781
18782 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18783 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18784 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18785 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18786 attempt.
18787
18788 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18789 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18790 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18791 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18792
18793 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18794 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18795 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18796
18797 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18798 &%one_time%&.
18799
18800 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18801 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18802 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18803 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18804 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18805 expansion.
18806
18807
18808 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18809 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18810 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18811 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18812 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18813 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18814 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18815 See &%check_owner%& above.
18816
18817
18818 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18819 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18820 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18821 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18822
18823
18824 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18825 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18826 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18827 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18828 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18829 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18830 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18831
18832
18833 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18834 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18835 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18836 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18837 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18838 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18839 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18840 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18841
18842 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18843 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18844 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18845 addresses.
18846
18847 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18848 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18849 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18850 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18851 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18852 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18853 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18854 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18855 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18856 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18857
18858
18859 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18860 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18861 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18862 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18863 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18864 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18865
18866
18867 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18868 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18869 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18870 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18871 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18872 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18873
18874
18875 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18876 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18877 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18878 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18879 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18880
18881
18882 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18883 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18884 :subaddress part of an address.
18885
18886 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18887 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18888 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18889 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18890
18891
18892 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18893 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18894 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18895 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18896 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18897 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18898 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18899
18900
18901
18902 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18903 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18904 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18905 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18906 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18907 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18908 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18909 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18910 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18911 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18912 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18913 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18914 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18915 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18916 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18917 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18918
18919 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18920 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18921 the following routers.
18922
18923 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18924 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18925 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18926 so it is passed to the following routers.
18927
18928 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18929 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18930 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18931 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18932
18933 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18934 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18935 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18936 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18937 .code
18938 userforward:
18939 driver = redirect
18940 allow_filter
18941 check_local_user
18942 file = $home/.forward
18943 file_transport = address_file
18944 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18945 reply_transport = address_reply
18946 no_verify
18947 skip_syntax_errors
18948 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18949 syntax_errors_text = \
18950 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18951 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18952 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18953 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18954 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18955 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18956 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18957 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18958 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18959 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18960 .endd
18961 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18962 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18963 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18964 .code
18965 real_localuser:
18966 driver = accept
18967 check_local_user
18968 local_part_prefix = real-
18969 transport = local_delivery
18970 .endd
18971 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18972 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18973 .code
18974 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18975 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18976 .endd
18977
18978
18979 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18980 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18981
18982
18983 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18984 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18985 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18986 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18987
18988
18989
18990
18991
18992
18993 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18994 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18995
18996 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18997 "Environment for local transports"
18998 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18999 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19000 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19001 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19002 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19003 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19004 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19005
19006 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19007 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19008 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19009 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19010
19011 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19012 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19013 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19014 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19015 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19016
19017
19018
19019 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19020 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19021 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19022 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19023 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19024 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19025 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19026 time.
19027
19028 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19029 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19030 .code
19031 my_transport:
19032 driver = pipe
19033 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19034 .endd
19035 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19036 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19037 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19038 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19039
19040
19041
19042
19043 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19044 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19045 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19046 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19047 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19048 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19049 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19050 group (set by the transport). For example:
19051 .code
19052 # Routers ...
19053 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19054 local_users:
19055 driver = accept
19056 check_local_user
19057 transport = group_delivery
19058
19059 # Transports ...
19060 # This transport overrides the group
19061 group_delivery:
19062 driver = appendfile
19063 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19064 group = mail
19065 .endd
19066 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19067 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19068 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19069 set.
19070
19071 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19072 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19073 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19074 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19075 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19076 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19077
19078 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19079 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19080 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19081 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19082 original gid is also used.
19083
19084 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19085 following that is set is used:
19086
19087 .ilist
19088 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19089 .next
19090 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19091 .next
19092 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19093 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19094 .next
19095 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19096 .next
19097 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19098 the uid is the creator's uid;
19099 .next
19100 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19101 .endlist
19102
19103 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19104 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19105 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19106 The first of the following that is set is used:
19107
19108 .ilist
19109 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19110 .next
19111 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19112 .next
19113 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19114 .next
19115 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19116 .next
19117 The Exim uid.
19118 .endlist
19119
19120 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19121 &%never_users%& list.
19122
19123
19124
19125
19126
19127 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19128 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19129 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19130 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19131 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19132 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19133 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19134 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19135 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19136 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19137
19138 .ilist
19139 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19140 .next
19141 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19142 .next
19143 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19144 .next
19145 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19146 .endlist
19147
19148 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19149
19150 .ilist
19151 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19152 .next
19153 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19154 .endlist
19155
19156
19157 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19158 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19159 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19160
19161
19162
19163 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19164 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19165 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19166 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19167 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19168 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19169 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19170 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19171 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19172 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19173 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19174 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19175 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19176 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19177
19178
19179
19180
19181
19182
19183
19184 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19186
19187 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19188 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19189 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19190 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19191 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19192
19193
19194 .option body_only transports boolean false
19195 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19196 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19197 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19198 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19199 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19200 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19201 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19202 automatically suppress them.
19203
19204
19205 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19206 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19207 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19208 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19209 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19210 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19211
19212
19213 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19214 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19215 deliveries by the transport or for any
19216 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19217 what you are doing.
19218
19219
19220 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19221 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19222 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19223 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19224 transport is run.
19225 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19226 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19227 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19228 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19229 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19230 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19231 one.
19232
19233
19234 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19235 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19236 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19237 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19238 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19239 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19240 safely be resent to other recipients.
19241
19242
19243 .option driver transports string unset
19244 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19245 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19246
19247
19248 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19249 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19250 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19251 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19252 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19253 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19254 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19255 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19256 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19257 resent to other recipients.
19258
19259
19260 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19261 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19262 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19263 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19264 &%user%& (see below).
19265
19266
19267 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19268 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19269 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19270 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19271 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19272 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19273 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19274 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19275 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19276
19277
19278
19279 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19280 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19281 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19282 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19283 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19284 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19285 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19286 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19287
19288
19289 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19290 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19291 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19292 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19293 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19294 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19295 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19296 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19297 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19298
19299
19300
19301 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19302 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19303 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19304 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19305 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19306 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19307 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19308 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19309 example,
19310 .code
19311 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19312 x@y w@z
19313 .endd
19314 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19315 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19316 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19317 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19318 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19319 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19320 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19321 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19322 change envelope recipients at this time.
19323
19324
19325 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19326 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19327 .vindex "&$home$&"
19328 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19329 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19330 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19331 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19332 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19333 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19334 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19335 deferred.
19336
19337
19338 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19339 .cindex "additional groups"
19340 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19341 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19342 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19343 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19344 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19345
19346
19347 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19348 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19349 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19350 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19351 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19352 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19353 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19354 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19355 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19356 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19357 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19358 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19359 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19360 delivered.
19361
19362
19363
19364 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19365 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19366 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19367 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19368 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19369 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19370 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19371 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19372 that contains
19373 .code
19374 local_part_prefix = *-
19375 .endd
19376 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19377 is delivered with
19378 .code
19379 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19380 .endd
19381 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19382 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19383 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19384 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19385 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19386
19387
19388 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19389 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19390 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19391 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19392 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19393 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19394 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19395 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19396 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19397
19398 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19399 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19400 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19401 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19402
19403 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19404 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19405 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19406
19407
19408 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19409 .cindex "envelope sender"
19410 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19411 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19412 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19413 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19414 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19415 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19416 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19417 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19418 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19419
19420 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19421 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19422
19423 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19424 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19425 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19426 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19427 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19428 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19429 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19430
19431 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19432 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19433 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19434 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19435 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19436
19437
19438
19439 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19440 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19441 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19442 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19443 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19444 have easy access to it.
19445
19446 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19447 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19448 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19449 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19450 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19451 recipients.
19452
19453
19454 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19455 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19456
19457
19458 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19459 .cindex "shadow transport"
19460 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19461 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19462 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19463
19464 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19465 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19466 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19467 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19468 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19469 cause a log line to be written.
19470
19471 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19472 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19473 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19474 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19475 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19476 of the form
19477 .code
19478 ST=<shadow transport name>
19479 .endd
19480 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19481 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19482 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19483 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19484 headers that some sites insist on.
19485
19486
19487 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19488 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19489 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19490 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19491 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19492 individual users or via a system filter.
19493
19494 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19495 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19496 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19497 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19498 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19499
19500 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19501 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19502 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19503 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19504 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19505 &(pipe)& transports.
19506
19507 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19508 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19509 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19510 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19511 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19512
19513 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19514 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19515 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19516 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19517
19518 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19519 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19520 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19521 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19522 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19523 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19524
19525 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19526 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19527 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19528 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19529 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19530 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19531 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19532 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19533
19534 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19535 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19536 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19537 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19538 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19539 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19540 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19541 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19542 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19543 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19544
19545 .vindex "&$host$&"
19546 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19547 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19548 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19549 which the message is being sent. For example:
19550 .code
19551 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19552 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19553 .endd
19554
19555 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19556 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19557 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19558 .ilist
19559 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19560 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19561 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19562 example:
19563 .code
19564 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19565 .endd
19566 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19567 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19568 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19569 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19570 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19571 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19572 .next
19573 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19574 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19575 arguments. Consider this example:
19576 .code
19577 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19578 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19579 .endd
19580 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19581 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19582 .code
19583 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19584 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19585 .endd
19586 .endlist
19587
19588 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19589 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19590 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19591 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19592 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19593 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19594 bounced from a transport filter.
19595
19596 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19597 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19598 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19599
19600
19601 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19602 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19603 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19604 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19605 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19606 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19607 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19608 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19609 becomes a temporary error.
19610
19611
19612 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19613 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19614 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19615 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19616 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19617 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19618 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19619 option is not set.
19620
19621 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19622 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19623 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19624
19625 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19626 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19627 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19628 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19629 retry data.
19630 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19631 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19632 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19633
19634
19635
19636
19637
19638
19639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19641
19642 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19643 "Address batching"
19644 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19645 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19646 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19647 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19648 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19649 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19650 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19651
19652 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19653 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19654 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19655 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19656 local transport, for example:
19657
19658 .ilist
19659 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19660 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19661 recipients saves space.
19662 .next
19663 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19664 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19665 .next
19666 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19667 to a scanner program or
19668 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19669 acceptable.
19670 .endlist
19671
19672 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19673 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19674 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19675
19676 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19677 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19678 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19679 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19680 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19681 to certain conditions:
19682
19683 .ilist
19684 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19685 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19686 batching is possible.
19687 .next
19688 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19689 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19690 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19691 .next
19692 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19693 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19694 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19695 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19696 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19697 from taking place.
19698 .next
19699 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19700 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19701 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19702 be the same.
19703 .endlist
19704
19705 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19706 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19707 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19708 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19709 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19710 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19711 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19712 .code
19713 check_string = "."
19714 escape_string = ".."
19715 .endd
19716 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19717 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19718 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19719
19720 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19721 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19722 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19723 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19724 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19725 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19726
19727 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19728 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19729 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19730 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19731 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19732 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19733 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19734 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19735 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19736
19737
19738
19739
19740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19742
19743 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19744 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19745 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19746 .cindex "directory creation"
19747 .cindex "creating directories"
19748 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19749 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19750 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19751 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19752 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19753 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19754 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19755 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19756 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19757 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19758
19759 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19760 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19761 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19762 included.
19763
19764 .cindex "quota" "system"
19765 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19766 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19767 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19768
19769 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19770 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19771 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19772 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19773
19774 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19775 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19776 private options.
19777
19778 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19779 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19780 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19781 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19782 option).
19783
19784
19785
19786 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19787 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19788 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19789 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19790 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19791
19792 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19793 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19794 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19795 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19796 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19797 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19798 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19799 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19800 operation. There are two cases:
19801
19802 .ilist
19803 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19804 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19805 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19806 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19807 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19808 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19809 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19810 .next
19811 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19812 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19813 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19814 .endlist
19815
19816
19817 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19818 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19819 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19820 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19821 form:
19822 .code
19823 save folder23
19824 .endd
19825 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19826 .code
19827 require "fileinto";
19828 fileinto "folder23";
19829 .endd
19830 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19831 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19832 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19833 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19834 way of handling this requirement:
19835 .code
19836 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19837 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19838 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19839 {$address_file} \
19840 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19841 }} \
19842 }
19843 .endd
19844 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19845 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19846 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19847
19848 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19849 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19850 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19851 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19852 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19853 path to the transport.
19854
19855 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19856 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19857
19858
19859
19860
19861 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19862 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19863
19864
19865
19866 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19867 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19868 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19869 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19870 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19871 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19872 delivery is deferred.
19873
19874
19875 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19876 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19877 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19878 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19879 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19880 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19881 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19882 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19883
19884
19885 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19886 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19887 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19888 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19889 file.
19890
19891
19892 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19893 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19894
19895
19896 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19897 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19898 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19899 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19900 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19901
19902
19903 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19904 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19905 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19906 process is running.
19907
19908
19909 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19910 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19911 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19912 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19913 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19914 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19915 contains is significant.
19916
19917 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19918 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19919 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19920 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19921 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19922
19923 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19924 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19925 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19926 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19927 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19928 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19929 .code
19930 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19931 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19932 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19933 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19934 .endd
19935 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19936 .cindex "directory creation"
19937 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19938 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19939 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19940
19941 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19942 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19943 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19944 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19945 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19946
19947
19948
19949 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19950 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19951 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19952 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19953 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19954 beneath.
19955
19956 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19957 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19958 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19959 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19960 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19961 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19962 &%file_must_exist%&.
19963
19964
19965 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19966 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19967 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19968 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19969
19970 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19971 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19972 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19973 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19974 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19975
19976
19977 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19978 .cindex "base62"
19979 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19980 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19981 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19982 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19983 .code
19984 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19985 .endd
19986 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19987 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19988 option.
19989
19990
19991 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19992 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19993 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19994
19995
19996 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19997 See &%check_string%& above.
19998
19999
20000 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20001 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20002 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20003 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20004 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20005 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20006 &%file%&.
20007
20008 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20009 .cindex "locking files"
20010 .cindex "lock files"
20011 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20012 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20013
20014 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20015 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20016 examples:
20017 .code
20018 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20019 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20020 file = $home/inbox
20021 .endd
20022 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20023 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20024 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20025 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20026 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20027 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20028
20029
20030
20031 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20032 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20033 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20034 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20035 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20036 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20037 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20038 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20039 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20040 this added to it:
20041 .code
20042 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20043 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20044 .endd
20045 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20046 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20047 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20048 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20049 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20050 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20051 delivery is deferred.
20052
20053
20054 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20055 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20056 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20057 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20058
20059
20060 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20061 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20062 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20063 .cindex "locking files"
20064 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20065 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20066 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20067 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20068 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20069 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20070 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20071 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20072
20073 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20074 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20075 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20076 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20077
20078 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20079 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20080 retries is
20081 .code
20082 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20083 .endd
20084 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20085 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20086 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20087
20088 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20089 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20090 .code
20091 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20092 .endd
20093
20094 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20095 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20096 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20097 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20098
20099
20100 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20101 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20102 for details of locking.
20103
20104
20105 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20106 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20107 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20108
20109
20110 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20111 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20112 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20113
20114
20115 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20116 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20117 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20118 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20119 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20120
20121
20122 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20123 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20124 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20125 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20126 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20127 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20128 external source that maintains the data.
20129
20130
20131 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20132 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20133 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20134 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20135 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20136 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20137 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20138 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20139
20140
20141
20142 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20143 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20144 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20145 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20146 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20147 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20148 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20149 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20150 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20151 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20152
20153
20154 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20155 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20156 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20157 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20158 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20159 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20160 calculation. The default value is:
20161 .code
20162 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20163 .endd
20164 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20165 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20166 &_Trash_&
20167 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20168 .code
20169 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20170 .endd
20171 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20172 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20173 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20174 directly into that directory.
20175
20176
20177 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20178 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20179 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20180
20181
20182 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20183 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20184 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20185
20186
20187 .new
20188 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20189 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20190 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20191 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20192 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20193 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20194 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20195 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20196 .wen
20197
20198 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20199 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20200 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20201 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20202 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20203 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20204 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20205 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20206 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20207 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20208
20209
20210 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20211 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20212 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20213 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20214 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20215 below for further details.
20216
20217
20218 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20219 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20220 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20221
20222
20223 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20224 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20225 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20226
20227
20228 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20229 .cindex "locking files"
20230 .cindex "file" "locking"
20231 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20232 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20233 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20234 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20235 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20236 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20237 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20238
20239 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20240 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20241 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20242 combination:
20243 .code
20244 mbx_format = true
20245 message_prefix =
20246 message_suffix =
20247 .endd
20248 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20249 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20250 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20251 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20252 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20253 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20254 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20255 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20256
20257 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20258 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20259 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20260 append messages to it.
20261
20262
20263 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20264 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20265 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20266 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20267 in which case it is:
20268 .code
20269 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20270 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20271 .endd
20272 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20273 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20274
20275 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20276 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20277 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20278 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20279 setting
20280 .code
20281 message_suffix =
20282 .endd
20283 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20284 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20285
20286 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20287 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20288 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20289 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20290 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20291 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20292 value, and this option is ignored.
20293
20294
20295 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20296 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20297 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20298 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20299 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20300
20301
20302 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20303 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20304 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20305 on users about incoming mail.
20306
20307
20308 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20309 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20310 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20311 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20312 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20313 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20314 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20315 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20316 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20317
20318 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20319 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20320 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20321
20322 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20323 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20324 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20325 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20326 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20327 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20328
20329 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20330 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20331 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20332 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20333 be handled.
20334
20335 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20336
20337 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20338 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20339 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20340 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20341 system quota failures.
20342
20343 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20344 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20345 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20346 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20347 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20348 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20349 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20350 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20351 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20352 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20353
20354
20355 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20356 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20357 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20358 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20359 delivery directory.
20360
20361
20362 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20363 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20364 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20365 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20366 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20367 &"no quota"&.
20368
20369
20370 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20371 See &%quota%& above.
20372
20373
20374 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20375 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20376 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20377 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20378 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20379 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20380 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20381
20382 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20383 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20384 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20385 the file length to the file name. For example:
20386 .code
20387 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20388 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20389 .endd
20390 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20391 number of lines in the message.
20392
20393 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20394 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20395 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20396
20397 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20398
20399
20400 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20401 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20402 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20403 .code
20404 quota_warn_message = "\
20405 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20406 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20407 This message is automatically created \
20408 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20409 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20410 a warning threshold that is\n\
20411 set by the system administrator.\n"
20412 .endd
20413
20414
20415 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20416 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20417 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20418 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20419 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20420 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20421 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20422 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20423 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20424 sign. For example:
20425 .code
20426 quota = 10M
20427 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20428 .endd
20429 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20430 percent sign is ignored.
20431
20432 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20433 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20434 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20435 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20436 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20437 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20438 .code
20439 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20440 .endd
20441 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20442 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20443 option.
20444
20445 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20446 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20447 percentage.
20448
20449
20450 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20451 .cindex "envelope sender"
20452 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20453 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20454 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20455 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20456 for details of batch SMTP.
20457
20458
20459 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20460 .cindex "carriage return"
20461 .cindex "linefeed"
20462 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20463 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20464 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20465 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20466
20467 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20468 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20469 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20470 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20471 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20472 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20473
20474
20475 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20476 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20477 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20478 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20479 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20480 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20481
20482
20483 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20484 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20485 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20486 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20487 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20488
20489 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20490 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20491 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20492 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20493
20494 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20495 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20496 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20497 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20498 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20499 error.
20500
20501 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20502 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20503
20504
20505 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20506 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20507 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20508 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20509 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20510 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20511 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20512
20513 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20514 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20515 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20516 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20517 file corruption.
20518
20519 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20520 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20521 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20522
20523
20524 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20525 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20526 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20527 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20528 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20529 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20530 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20531 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20532 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20533
20534 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20535 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20536 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20537 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20538
20539
20540
20541
20542 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20543 .cindex "appending to a file"
20544 .cindex "file" "appending"
20545 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20546
20547 .ilist
20548 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20549 return is given.
20550
20551 .next
20552 .cindex "directory creation"
20553 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20554 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20555 &%directory_mode%& option.
20556
20557 .next
20558 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20559 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20560 transport.
20561
20562 .next
20563 .cindex "file" "locking"
20564 .cindex "locking files"
20565 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20566 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20567 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20568
20569 .olist
20570 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20571 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20572 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20573 .next
20574 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20575 .next
20576 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20577 Unlink the hitching post name.
20578 .next
20579 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20580 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20581 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20582 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20583 .next
20584 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20585 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20586 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20587 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20588 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20589 it before trying again.
20590 .endlist olist
20591
20592 .next
20593 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20594 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20595 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20596
20597 .next
20598 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20599 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20600 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20601 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20602 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20603 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20604 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20605 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20606 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20607 checked.
20608
20609 .next
20610 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20611 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20612 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20613 delivery is deferred.
20614
20615 .next
20616 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20617 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20618 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20619 permissions.
20620
20621 .next
20622 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20623 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20624 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20625
20626 .next
20627 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20628 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20629 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20630
20631 .next
20632 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20633 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20634 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20635 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20636 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20637 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20638 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20639 that prevents link following.
20640
20641 .next
20642 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20643 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20644 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20645 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20646 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20647
20648 .next
20649 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20650
20651 .next
20652 .cindex "file" "locking"
20653 .cindex "locking files"
20654 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20655 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20656 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20657 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20658 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20659 .code
20660 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20661 .endd
20662 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20663 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20664 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20665
20666 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20667 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20668 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20669
20670 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20671 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20672 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20673 delivery is deferred.
20674
20675 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20676 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20677 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20678 immediately. It retries up to
20679 .code
20680 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20681 .endd
20682 times (rounded up).
20683 .endlist
20684
20685 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20686 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20687
20688
20689 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20690 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20691 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20692 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20693 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20694 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20695 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20696 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20697 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20698 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20699
20700 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20701 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20702 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20703 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20704 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20705 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20706 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20707
20708 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20709 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20710 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20711 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20712
20713
20714 .cindex "maildir format"
20715 .cindex "mailstore format"
20716 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20717 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20718 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20719 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20720 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20721
20722 .cindex "directory creation"
20723 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20724 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20725 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20726 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20727 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20728 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20729 deferred.
20730
20731
20732
20733 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20734 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20735 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20736 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20737 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20738 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20739 &_new_& subdirectory.
20740
20741 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20742 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20743 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20744 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20745 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20746 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20747 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20748
20749 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20750 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20751 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20752 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20753 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20754 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20755 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20756 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20757
20758 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20759 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20760 folders. Consider this example:
20761 .code
20762 maildir_format = true
20763 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20764 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20765 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20766 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20767 .endd
20768 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20769 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20770 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20771 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20772 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20773 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20774
20775 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20776 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20777 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20778 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20779 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20780
20781 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20782 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20783 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20784
20785 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20786 .cindex "maildir++"
20787 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20788 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20789 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20790 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20791 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20792 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20793 amount of space used.
20794
20795 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20796 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20797 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20798 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20799 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20800 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20801
20802
20803
20804
20805 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20806 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20807 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20808 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20809 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20810 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20811
20812
20813 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20814 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20815 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20816 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20817 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20818 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20819 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20820 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20821 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20822 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
20823 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
20824 backwards compatibility).
20825
20826 For one common implementation, you might set:
20827 .code
20828 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
20829 .endd
20830 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
20831
20832 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
20833 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
20834 &[stat()]& each message file.
20835
20836
20837 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20838 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20839 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20840 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20841 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20842 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20843 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20844 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20845 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20846
20847 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20848 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20849 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20850 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20851 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20852 need to know the quota.
20853
20854 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20855 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20856
20857 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20858 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20859 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20860 details.
20861
20862
20863 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20864 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20865 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20866 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20867 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20868 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20869 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20870 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20871
20872 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20873 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20874 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20875 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20876 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20877 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20878
20879 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20880 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20881 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20882 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20883 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20884 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20885
20886 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20887 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20888 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20889 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20890
20891
20892 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20893 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20894 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20895 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20896 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20897 .code
20898 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20899 .endd
20900 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20901 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20902 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20903 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20904 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20905
20906
20907
20908
20909
20910
20911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20913
20914 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20915 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20916 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20917 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20918 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20919 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20920 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20921 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20922
20923 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20924 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20925 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20926 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20927 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20928
20929
20930 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20931 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20932 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20933 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20934 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20935
20936 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20937 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20938 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20939 transport is run as a consequence of a
20940 &%mail%&
20941 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20942 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20943 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20944 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20945 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20946 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20947
20948 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20949 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20950 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20951 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20952
20953 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20954 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20955 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20956 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20957 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20958 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20959 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20960
20961 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20962 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20963 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20964 the transport defers.
20965 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20966 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20967
20968 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20969 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20970 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20971 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20972
20973 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20974 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20975 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20976 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20977 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20978 problems. They are just discarded.
20979
20980
20981
20982 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20983 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20984
20985 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20986 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20987 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20988
20989
20990 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20991 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20992 when the message is specified by the transport.
20993
20994
20995 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20996 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20997 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20998 string comes first.
20999
21000
21001 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21002 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21003 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21004
21005
21006 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21007 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21008 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21009
21010
21011 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21012 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21013 specified by the transport.
21014
21015
21016 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21017 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21018 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21019 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21020
21021
21022 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21023 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21024 the message is specified by the transport.
21025
21026
21027 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21028 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21029 used.
21030
21031
21032 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21033 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21034 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21035 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21036 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21037
21038
21039
21040 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21041 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21042 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21043 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21044
21045 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21046 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21047 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21048 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21049 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21050 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21051 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21052 infinity.
21053
21054 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21055 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21056 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21057 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21058 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21059
21060 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21061 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21062 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21063 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21064 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21065 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21066
21067
21068 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21069 See &%once%& above.
21070
21071
21072 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21073 See &%once%& above.
21074 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21075
21076
21077 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21078 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21079 specified by the transport.
21080
21081
21082 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21083 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21084 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21085 configuration option.
21086
21087
21088 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21089 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21090 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21091 automatic responses. For example:
21092 .code
21093 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21094 .endd
21095 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21096 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21097 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21098 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21099 small.
21100
21101
21102
21103 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21104 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21105 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21106 the text comes first.
21107
21108
21109 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21110 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21111 when the message is specified by the transport.
21112 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21113 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21114
21115
21116
21117
21118 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21119 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21120
21121 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21122 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21123 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21124 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21125 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21126 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21127 specified command
21128 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21129 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21130 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21131 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21132 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21133 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21134 .code
21135 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
21136 .endd
21137 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21138 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21139 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21140 as follows:
21141
21142 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21143 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21144
21145
21146 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21147 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21148 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21149 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21150 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21151
21152
21153 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21154 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21155 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21156 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21157 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21158 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21159 LMTP protocol.
21160
21161 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21162 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21163 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21164 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21165 in its response to the LHLO command.
21166
21167 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21168 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21169 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21170 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21171
21172
21173 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21174 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21175 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21176 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21177 LMTP transport:
21178 .code
21179 lmtp:
21180 driver = lmtp
21181 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21182 batch_max = 20
21183 user = exim
21184 .endd
21185 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21186 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21187
21188
21189
21190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21191 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21192
21193 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21194 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21195 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21196 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21197 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21198 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21199 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21200 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21201 following ways:
21202
21203 .ilist
21204 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21205 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21206 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21207 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21208 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21209 .next
21210 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21211 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21212 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21213 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21214 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21215 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21216 that are routed to the transport.
21217 .next
21218 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21219 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21220 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21221 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
21222 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
21223 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
21224 the local part that was redirected.
21225 .endlist
21226
21227
21228 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21229 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21230 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21231
21232 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21233 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21234 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21235 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21236 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21237 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21238 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21239
21240
21241 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21242 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21243 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21244 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21245 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21246
21247
21248
21249
21250 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21251 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21252 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21253 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21254 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21255 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21256 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21257 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21258 &"local delivery failed"&.
21259
21260 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21261 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21262 will be sent as normal.
21263
21264 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21265 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21266 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21267 apply in this case.
21268
21269 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21270 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21271 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21272 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21273
21274 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21275 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21276 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21277 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21278 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21279 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21280 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21281 &%temp_errors%&.
21282
21283
21284
21285 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21286 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21287 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21288 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21289 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21290 run.
21291
21292 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21293 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21294 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21295 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21296
21297 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21298 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21299 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21300 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21301 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21302 .code
21303 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21304 .endd
21305 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21306 arguments. You have to write
21307 .code
21308 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21309 .endd
21310 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21311 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21312 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21313 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21314 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21315 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21316 example:
21317 .code
21318 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21319 .endd
21320
21321 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21322 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21323 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21324 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21325 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21326 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21327 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21328 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21329 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21330 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21331
21332 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21333 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21334 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21335 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21336 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21337 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21338 control what is done with it.
21339
21340 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21341 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21342 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21343 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21344 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21345 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21346 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21347 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21348 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21349 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21350 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21351
21352
21353
21354 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21355 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21356 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21357 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21358 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21359 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21360 environment.
21361 .display
21362 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21363 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21364 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21365 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21366 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21367 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21368 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21369 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21370 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21371 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21372 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21373 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21374 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21375 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21376 &`USER `& see below
21377 .endd
21378 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21379 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21380 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21381 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21382 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21383 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21384 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21385
21386 .cindex "HOST"
21387 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21388 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21389 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21390 the router.
21391
21392 .cindex "HOME"
21393 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21394 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21395 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21396 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21397
21398
21399 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21400 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21401
21402
21403
21404 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21405 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21406 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21407 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21408 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21409 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21410 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21411 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21412 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21413 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21414 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21415 example, if
21416 .code
21417 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21418 .endd
21419 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21420 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21421 &%use_shell%& is set.
21422
21423
21424 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21425 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21426
21427
21428 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21429 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21430 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21431
21432
21433 .option check_string pipe string unset
21434 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21435 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21436 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21437 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21438 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21439 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21440 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21441 ignored.
21442
21443
21444 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21445 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21446 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21447 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21448 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21449 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21450 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21451
21452
21453 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21454 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21455 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21456 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21457 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21458 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21459 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21460
21461
21462 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21463 See &%check_string%& above.
21464
21465
21466 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21467 .cindex "exec failure"
21468 .cindex "failure of exec"
21469 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21470 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21471 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21472 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21473 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21474
21475
21476 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21477 .cindex "signal exit"
21478 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21479 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21480 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21481 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21482
21483
21484 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21485 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21486 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21487 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21488 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21489 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21490
21491 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21492 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21493
21494 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21495 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21496 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21497 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21498 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21499
21500
21501 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21502 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21503 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21504 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21505 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21506 Only one of them may be set.
21507
21508
21509
21510 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21511 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21512 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21513 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21514
21515
21516
21517 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21518 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21519 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21520 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21521 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21522 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21523 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21524 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21525
21526
21527 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21528 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21529 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21530 .code
21531 message_prefix = \
21532 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21533 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
21534 .endd
21535 .cindex "Cyrus"
21536 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21537 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21538 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21539 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21540 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21541 setting
21542 .code
21543 message_prefix =
21544 .endd
21545 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21546 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21547
21548
21549 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21550 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21551 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21552 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21553 .code
21554 message_suffix =
21555 .endd
21556 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21557 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21558
21559
21560 .option path pipe string "see below"
21561 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21562 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21563 .code
21564 /bin:/usr/bin
21565 .endd
21566 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21567 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21568 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21569
21570
21571 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21572 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21573 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21574 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21575 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21576 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21577 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21578 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21579 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21580
21581
21582 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21583 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21584 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21585 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21586 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21587 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21588 accept the message is used.
21589
21590
21591 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21592 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21593 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21594 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21595 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21596 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21597
21598
21599 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21600 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21601 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21602 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21603 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21604 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21605 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21606
21607
21608
21609 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21610 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21611 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21612 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21613 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21614 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21615 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21616 of them may be set.
21617
21618
21619
21620 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21621 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21622 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21623 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21624 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21625 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21626 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21627 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21628 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21629 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21630 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21631 and 73, respectively.
21632
21633
21634 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21635 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21636 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21637 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21638 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21639 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21640 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21641
21642 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21643 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21644 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21645 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21646 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21647 delivery to be deferred.
21648
21649 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21650 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21651
21652
21653 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21654 .cindex "envelope sender"
21655 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21656 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21657 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21658 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21659 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21660
21661 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21662 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21663 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21664 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21665 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21666 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21667 class database.
21668
21669
21670 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21671 .cindex "carriage return"
21672 .cindex "linefeed"
21673 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21674 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21675 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21676 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21677
21678 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21679 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21680 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21681 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21682 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21683
21684
21685 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21686 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21687 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21688 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21689 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21690 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21691 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21692 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21693 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21694 its &%-c%& option.
21695
21696
21697
21698 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21699 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21700 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21701 .cindex "external local delivery"
21702 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21703 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21704 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21705 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21706 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21707 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21708 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21709 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21710 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21711 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21712 .code
21713 # transport
21714 procmail_pipe:
21715 driver = pipe
21716 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21717 return_path_add
21718 delivery_date_add
21719 envelope_to_add
21720 check_string = "From "
21721 escape_string = ">From "
21722 umask = 077
21723 user = $local_part
21724 group = mail
21725
21726 # router
21727 procmail:
21728 driver = accept
21729 check_local_user
21730 transport = procmail_pipe
21731 .endd
21732 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21733 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21734 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21735 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21736 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21737 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21738
21739 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21740 .code
21741 IFS=" "
21742 .endd
21743 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21744 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21745
21746 .cindex "Cyrus"
21747 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21748 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21749 .code
21750 # transport
21751 local_delivery_cyrus:
21752 driver = pipe
21753 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21754 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21755 user = cyrus
21756 group = mail
21757 return_output
21758 log_output
21759 message_prefix =
21760 message_suffix =
21761
21762 # router
21763 local_user_cyrus:
21764 driver = accept
21765 check_local_user
21766 local_part_suffix = .*
21767 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21768 .endd
21769 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21770 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21771 sender.
21772 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21773 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21774
21775
21776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21778
21779 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21780 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21781 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21782 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21783 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21784 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21785 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21786 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21787
21788
21789 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21790 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21791 two ways:
21792
21793 .ilist
21794 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21795 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21796 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21797 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21798 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21799 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21800 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21801 .next
21802 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21803 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21804 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21805 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21806 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21807 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21808 process.
21809 .endlist
21810
21811
21812 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21813 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21814 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21815
21816
21817
21818 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21819 .vindex "&$host$&"
21820 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21821 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21822 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21823 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21824 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21825 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21826 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21827 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21828
21829
21830 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21831 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
21832 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21833 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21834 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
21835 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
21836 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
21837 are the values that were set when the message was received.
21838 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21839 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
21840 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21841 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21842 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21843 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21844
21845
21846 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21847 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21848 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21849
21850
21851 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21852 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21853 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21854 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21855 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21856 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21857 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21858 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21859
21860 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21861 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21862 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21863 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21864 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21865 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21866 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21867 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21868 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21869
21870
21871 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21872 .cindex "Cyrus"
21873 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21874 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21875 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21876 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21877 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21878 ignored.
21879
21880 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21881 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21882 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21883 particular connection.
21884
21885 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21886 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21887 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21888 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21889
21890 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21891 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21892 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21893 .code
21894 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21895 .endd
21896 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21897 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21898
21899 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21900 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21901 value.
21902
21903
21904 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21905 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21906 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21907 authenticated as a client.
21908
21909
21910 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21911 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21912 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21913 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21914
21915
21916 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21917 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21918 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21919 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21920 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21921 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21922 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21923
21924
21925 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21926 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21927 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21928 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21929 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21930 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21931 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21932 option.
21933
21934
21935 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21936 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21937 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21938 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21939
21940
21941 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21942 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21943 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21944 cutoff times.
21945
21946 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21947 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21948 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21949 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21950 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21951 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21952
21953 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21954 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21955 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21956 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21957 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21958 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21959 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21960 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21961 to them.
21962
21963
21964 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21965 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21966 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21967 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21968 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21969
21970
21971 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21972 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21973 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21974 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21975 details.
21976
21977
21978
21979 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21980 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21981 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21982 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21983 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21984 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21985 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21986 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21987
21988 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21989 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21990 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21991 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21992 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21993 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21994
21995 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21996 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21997 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21998 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21999 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22000
22001 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22002 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22003 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22004 copy of the message is sent.
22005
22006 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22007 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22008 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22009 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22010 fails"& facility.
22011
22012
22013 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22014 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22015 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22016 zero.
22017
22018 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22019 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22020 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22021 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22022 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22023 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22024
22025 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22026 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22027 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22028 implementations of TLS.
22029
22030 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22031 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22032 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22033 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22034 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22035 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22036 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22037 option is:
22038 .code
22039 $primary_hostname
22040 .endd
22041 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22042 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22043 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22044 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22045 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22046 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22047 interface address, you could use this:
22048 .code
22049 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22050 {$primary_hostname}}
22051 .endd
22052 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22053 callouts.
22054
22055 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22056 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22057 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22058 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22059 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22060 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22061
22062 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22063 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22064 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22065 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22066
22067 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22068 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22069 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22070 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22071 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22072 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22073 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22074
22075 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22076 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22077 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22078 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22079 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22080 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22081 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22082 address are used.
22083
22084 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22085 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22086
22087
22088 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22089 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22090 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22091 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22092 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22093 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22094 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22095 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22096 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22097 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22098
22099
22100 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22101 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22102 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22103 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22104
22105
22106 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22107 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22108 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22109 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22110
22111
22112 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22113 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22114 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22115 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22116 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22117 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22118 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22119 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22120
22121
22122 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22123 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22124 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22125 why it exists.
22126
22127
22128
22129 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22130 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22131 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22132 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22133 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22134 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22135 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22136 explanation of when this might be needed.
22137
22138
22139 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22140 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22141 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22142 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22143 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22144
22145
22146 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22147 .cindex "randomized host list"
22148 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22149 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22150 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22151 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22152 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22153 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22154 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22155 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22156
22157 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22158 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22159 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22160 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22161 .code
22162 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22163 .endd
22164 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22165 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22166 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22167
22168 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22169 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22170 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22171 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22172 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22173 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22174 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22175 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22176 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22177
22178
22179 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22180 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22181 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22182 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22183 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22184 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22185
22186 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22187 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22188 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22189 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22190 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22191 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22192 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22193
22194 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22195 .cindex "bind IP address"
22196 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22197 .vindex "&$host$&"
22198 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22199 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22200 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22201 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22202 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22203 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22204 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22205 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22206 unknown.
22207
22208 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22209 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22210 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22211 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22212 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22213 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22214 .code
22215 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22216 .endd
22217 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22218 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22219 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22220 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22221
22222
22223 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22224 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22225 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22226 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22227 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22228 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22229 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22230 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22231 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22232 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22233 unreachable hosts.
22234
22235
22236 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22237 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22238 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22239 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22240 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22241
22242 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22243 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22244 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22245 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22246 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22247 permits this.
22248
22249
22250 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22251 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22252 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22253 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22254 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22255 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22256 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22257 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22258
22259
22260 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22261 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22262 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22263 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22264 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22265 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22266 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22267 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22268
22269 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22270 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22271 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22272 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22273 is deferred.
22274
22275
22276
22277 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22278 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22279 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22280 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22281 .vindex "&$port$&"
22282 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22283 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22284 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22285 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22286 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22287
22288 .new
22289 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22290 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22291 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22292 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22293 .wen
22294
22295
22296 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22297 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22298 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22299 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22300 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22301 addresses is not affected.
22302
22303 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22304 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22305 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22306 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22307 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22308 hosts.
22309
22310
22311 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22312 .cindex "serializing connections"
22313 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22314 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22315 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22316 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22317 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22318 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22319 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22320
22321 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22322 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22323 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22324 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22325 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22326 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22327
22328 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22329 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22330 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22331 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22332 are used for ETRN serialization.
22333
22334
22335 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22336 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22337 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22338 .cindex "size" "of message"
22339 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22340 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22341 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22342 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22343 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22344 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22345 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22346 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22347
22348 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22349 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22350
22351
22352 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22353 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22354 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22355 .vindex "&$host$&"
22356 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22357 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22358 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22359 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22360 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22361 details of TLS.
22362
22363 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22364 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22365 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22366 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22367 client.
22368
22369
22370 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22371 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22372 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22373 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22374 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22375
22376
22377 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22378 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22379 .vindex "&$host$&"
22380 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22381 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22382 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22383 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22384 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22385 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22386 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22387 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22388
22389
22390 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22391 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22392 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22393 .vindex "&$host$&"
22394 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22395 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22396 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22397 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22398 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22399 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22400 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22401 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22402 ciphers is a preference order.
22403
22404
22405
22406 .new
22407 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
22408 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
22409 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
22410 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_sni variable and causes any
22411 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
22412 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
22413 certificate and private key for the session.
22414
22415 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
22416
22417 OpenSSL only, also requiring a build of OpenSSL that supports TLS extensions.
22418 .wen
22419
22420
22421
22422 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22423 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22424 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22425 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22426 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22427 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22428 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22429 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22430 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22431 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22432 in clear.
22433
22434
22435 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22436 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22437 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22438 .vindex "&$host$&"
22439 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22440 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22441 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22442 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22443 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22444 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22445 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22446 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22447 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22448
22449
22450
22451
22452 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22453 "SECTvalhosmax"
22454 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22455 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22456 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22457 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22458 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22459
22460
22461 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22462 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22463 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22464 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22465 retrying.
22466
22467 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22468 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22469 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22470
22471 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22472 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22473 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22474 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22475 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22476
22477 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22478 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22479 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22480 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22481 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22482 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22483 see below for an exception).
22484
22485 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22486 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22487 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22488 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22489 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22490
22491 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22492 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22493 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22494 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22495 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22496 reached their retry times.
22497
22498 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22499 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22500 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22501 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22502 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22503 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22504 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22505 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22506 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22507 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22508 reached.
22509
22510 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22511 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22512 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22513 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22514 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22515 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22516
22517 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22518 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22519 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22520 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22521 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22522 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22523
22524
22525
22526
22527
22528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22529 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22530
22531 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22532 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22533 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22534 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22535 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22536 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22537
22538 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22539 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22540 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22541 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22542 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22543 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22544 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22545
22546 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22547 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22548 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22549 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22550
22551
22552 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22553 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22554 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22555 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22556
22557 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22558 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22559 facility; you do not have to use it.
22560
22561 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22562 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22563 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22564 address to which it applies.
22565
22566 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22567 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22568 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22569 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22570 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22571 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22572 rules.
22573
22574 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22575 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22576 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22577 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22578
22579
22580 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22581 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22582 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22583 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22584 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22585 discouraged.
22586
22587 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22588 illustrated by these examples:
22589
22590 .ilist
22591 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22592 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22593 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22594 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22595 .next
22596 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22597 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22598 .endlist
22599
22600
22601
22602 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22603 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22604 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22605 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22606 message's processing.
22607
22608 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22609 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22610 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22611 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22612 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22613 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22614 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22615 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22616 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22617
22618 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22619 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22620 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22621 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22622 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22623 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22624 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22625 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22626 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22627 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22628
22629 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22630 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22631 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22632 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22633 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22634 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22635
22636 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22637 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22638 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22639
22640 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22641 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22642 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22643 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22644 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22645 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22646 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22647 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22648 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22649
22650 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22651 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22652 transport time.
22653
22654
22655
22656
22657 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22658 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22659 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22660 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22661 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22662 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22663 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22664 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22665 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22666 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22667 .code
22668 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22669 .endd
22670 might produce the output
22671 .code
22672 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22673 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22674 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22675 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22676 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22677 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22678 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22679 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22680 .endd
22681 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22682 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22683 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22684 set for a particular transport.
22685
22686
22687 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22688 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22689 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22690 rules in the form
22691 .display
22692 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22693 .endd
22694 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22695 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22696 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22697 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22698
22699 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22700 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22701 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22702 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22703 ignored.
22704
22705 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22706 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22707 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22708
22709 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22710 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22711 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22712 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22713 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22714 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22715 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22716
22717 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22718 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22719 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22720 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22721 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22722 .code
22723 *@* ${lookup ...
22724 .endd
22725 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22726 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22727
22728
22729 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22730 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22731 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22732 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22733 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22734 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22735 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22736 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22737 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22738
22739 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22740 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22741 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22742
22743 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22744 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22745 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22746 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22747 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22748 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22749 of pattern they are set as follows:
22750
22751 .ilist
22752 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22753 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22754 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22755 pattern
22756 .code
22757 *queen@*.fict.example
22758 .endd
22759 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22760 .code
22761 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22762 $1 = hearts-
22763 $2 = wonderland
22764 .endd
22765 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22766 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22767
22768 .next
22769 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22770 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22771 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22772 rewriting rule of the form
22773 .display
22774 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22775 .endd
22776 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22777 .code
22778 $1 = foo
22779 $2 = bar
22780 $3 = baz.example
22781 .endd
22782 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22783 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22784 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22785 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22786 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22787 .endlist
22788
22789
22790 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22791 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22792 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22793 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22794 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22795 .code
22796 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22797 .endd
22798 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22799 &'From:'& headers.
22800
22801 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22802 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22803 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22804 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22805 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22806 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22807 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22808 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22809 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22810 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22811 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22812 entry written to the panic log.
22813
22814
22815
22816 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22817 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22818
22819 .ilist
22820 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22821 c, f, h, r, s, t.
22822 .next
22823 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22824 .next
22825 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22826 .endlist
22827
22828 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22829 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22830
22831
22832
22833 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22834 "SECID154"
22835 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22836 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22837 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22838 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22839 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22840 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22841 .display
22842 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22843 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22844 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22845 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22846 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22847 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22848 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22849 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22850 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22851 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22852 .endd
22853 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22854 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22855 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22856
22857 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22858 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22859
22860
22861 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22862 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22863 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22864 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22865 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22866 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22867 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22868 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22869 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22870
22871 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22872 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22873 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22874 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22875 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22876 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22877 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22878 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22879
22880
22881 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22882 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22883 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22884 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22885
22886 .ilist
22887 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22888 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22889 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22890 .next
22891 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22892 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22893 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22894 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22895 .next
22896 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22897 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22898 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22899 .next
22900 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22901 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22902 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22903 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22904 .code
22905 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22906 .endd
22907 into
22908 .code
22909 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22910 .endd
22911 .cindex "RFC 2047"
22912 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22913 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22914 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22915 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22916 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22917 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22918 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22919 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22920
22921 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22922 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22923 .endlist
22924
22925
22926 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22927 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22928 .code
22929 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22930 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22931 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22932 .endd
22933 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22934 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22935 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22936 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22937 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22938 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22939 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22940 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22941
22942 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22943 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22944 .code
22945 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22946 .endd
22947 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22948 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22949
22950 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22951 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22952 messages that originate outside the local host:
22953 .code
22954 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22955 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22956 .endd
22957 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22958 space.
22959
22960 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22961 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22962 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22963 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22964 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22965 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22966 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22967 components. For example, the rule
22968 .code
22969 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22970 .endd
22971 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22972 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22973 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22974 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22975 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22976 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22977 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22978 .ecindex IIDaddrew
22979
22980
22981
22982
22983
22984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22985 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22986
22987 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22988 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22989 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22990 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22991 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22992 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22993 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22994 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22995 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22996 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22997 address, domain and error.
22998
22999 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23000 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23001 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23002 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23003 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23004 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23005 log selector is set, the message
23006 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23007 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23008 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23009 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23010
23011 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23012 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23013 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23014 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23015 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23016 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23017 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23018 domain are maintained independently.
23019
23020 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23021 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23022 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23023 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23024 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23025 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23026 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23027 the local address is reached.
23028
23029 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23030 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23031 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23032 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23033 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23034
23035 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23036 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23037 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23038 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23039 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23040 messages that it should now be retaining.
23041
23042
23043
23044 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23045 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23046 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23047 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23048 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23049 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23050 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23051 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23052 message's sender, respectively.
23053
23054
23055 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23056 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23057 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23058 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23059 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23060 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23061 example,
23062 .code
23063 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23064 .endd
23065 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23066 whereas
23067 .code
23068 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23069 .endd
23070 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23071 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23072 part.
23073
23074 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23075 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
23076 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23077 expressions work in address lists.
23078 .display
23079 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23080 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23081 .endd
23082
23083
23084 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23085 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23086 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23087 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23088 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23089 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23090 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23091 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23092 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23093
23094 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23095 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23096 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23097 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23098 local transports).
23099
23100 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23101 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23102 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23103 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23104 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23105 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23106 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23107 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23108 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23109 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23110 commands.
23111
23112
23113
23114 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23115 "SECID160"
23116 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23117 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23118 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23119 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23120 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23121 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23122 .code
23123 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23124 MX 6 p.q.r.example
23125 MX 7 m.n.o.example
23126 .endd
23127 and the retry rules are
23128 .code
23129 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23130 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23131 .endd
23132 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23133 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23134 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23135 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23136 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23137 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23138
23139 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23140 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23141 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23142 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23143
23144 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23145 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23146 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23147 .code
23148 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23149 .endd
23150 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23151 textual form of the IP address.
23152
23153 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23154 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23155 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23156 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23157
23158 .vlist
23159 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23160 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23161 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23162
23163 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23164 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23165 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23166
23167 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23168 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23169
23170 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23171 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23172 .endlist
23173
23174 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23175 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23176 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23177 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23178 retry rule of this form:
23179 .code
23180 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23181 .endd
23182 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23183 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23184
23185 .vlist
23186 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23187 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23188 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23189 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23190
23191 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23192 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23193
23194 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23195 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23196
23197 .vitem &%refused%&
23198 A connection was refused.
23199
23200 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23201 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23202
23203 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23204 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23205
23206 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23207 A connection attempt timed out.
23208
23209 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23210 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23211 obtained from an MX record.
23212
23213 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23214 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23215 obtained from an MX record.
23216
23217 .vitem &%timeout%&
23218 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23219
23220 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23221 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23222 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23223 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23224
23225 .vitem &%quota%&
23226 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23227 transport.
23228
23229 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23230 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23231 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23232 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23233 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23234 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23235 for four days.
23236 .endlist
23237
23238 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23239 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23240 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23241 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23242 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23243 heuristic rules:
23244
23245 .ilist
23246 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23247 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23248 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23249 .next
23250 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23251 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23252 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23253 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23254 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23255 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23256 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23257 .next
23258 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23259 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23260 .endlist
23261
23262 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23263 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23264 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23265 error).
23266
23267
23268
23269 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23270 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23271 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23272 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23273 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23274 form:
23275 .display
23276 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23277 .endd
23278 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23279 .code
23280 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23281 .endd
23282 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23283 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23284 For example:
23285 .code
23286 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23287 .endd
23288 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23289 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23290 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23291 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23292 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23293
23294 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23295 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23296 .code
23297 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23298 .endd
23299 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23300 list is never matched.
23301
23302
23303
23304
23305
23306 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23307 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23308 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23309 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23310 .display
23311 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23312 .endd
23313 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23314 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23315 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23316 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23317 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23318
23319 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23320 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23321 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23322 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23323 The available algorithms are:
23324
23325 .ilist
23326 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23327 the interval.
23328 .next
23329 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23330 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23331 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23332 .next
23333 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23334 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23335 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23336 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23337 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23338 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23339 queue processing times.
23340 .endlist
23341
23342 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23343 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23344 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23345 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23346 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23347 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23348 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23349 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23350 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23351 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23352 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23353 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23354
23355 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23356 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23357 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23358 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23359 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23360 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23361 time.
23362
23363 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23364 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23365 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23366 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23367 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23368 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23369 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23370 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23371 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23372 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23373 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23374 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23375
23376 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23377 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23378 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23379 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23380 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23381 deliveries that have been deferred.
23382
23383
23384 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23385 Here are some example retry rules:
23386 .code
23387 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23388 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23389 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23390 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23391 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
23392 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23393 .endd
23394 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23395 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23396 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23397 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23398 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23399 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23400 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23401 days.
23402
23403 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23404 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23405 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23406 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23407 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23408
23409 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23410 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23411 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23412 were not obtained from an MX record.
23413
23414 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23415 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23416 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23417 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
23418 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23419
23420
23421
23422 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23423 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23424 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23425 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23426 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23427 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23428 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23429 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23430 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23431 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23432 failing for the first time.
23433
23434 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23435 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23436 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23437 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23438
23439 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23440 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23441 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23442
23443
23444
23445
23446 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23447 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23448 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23449 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23450 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23451 default retry rule:
23452 .code
23453 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23454 .endd
23455 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23456 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23457 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23458
23459 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23460 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23461 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23462 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23463 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23464
23465 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23466 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23467 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23468
23469 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23470 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23471 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23472 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23473 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23474 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23475 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23476 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23477
23478 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23479 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23480 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23481 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23482 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23483 notice.
23484
23485 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23486 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23487 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23488 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23489 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23490 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23491 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23492 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23493 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23494 true.
23495
23496 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23497 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23498 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23499 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23500 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23501 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23502 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23503 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23504 reached.
23505
23506 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23507 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23508 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23509 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23510 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23511 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23512 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23513 time out the address.
23514
23515 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23516 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23517 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23518 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23519 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23520 considered immediately.
23521 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23522 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23523
23524
23525
23526
23527
23528
23529 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23531
23532 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23533 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23534 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23535 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23536 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23537 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23538 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23539 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23540 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23541 other.
23542
23543 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23544 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23545
23546 .ilist
23547 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23548 the client's EHLO command.
23549 .next
23550 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23551 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23552 .next
23553 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23554 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23555 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23556 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23557 with the AUTH command.
23558 .next
23559 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23560 .next
23561 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23562 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23563 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23564 connection.
23565 .next
23566 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23567 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23568 unauthenticated connection.
23569 .endlist
23570
23571 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23572 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23573 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23574 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23575 .display
23576 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23577 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23578 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23579 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
23580 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23581 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23582 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23583 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23584 &`250-PIPELINING`&
23585 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
23586 &`250 HELP`&
23587 .endd
23588 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23589 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23590 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23591 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23592 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23593 included by setting
23594 .code
23595 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
23596 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23597 .new
23598 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
23599 AUTH_GSASL=yes
23600 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
23601 .wen
23602 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
23603 AUTH_SPA=yes
23604 .endd
23605 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23606 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23607 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
23608 .new
23609 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
23610 work via a socket interface.
23611 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
23612 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
23613 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
23614 supporting setting a server keytab.
23615 The sixth can be configured to support
23616 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23617 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
23618 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23619 .wen
23620
23621 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23622 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23623 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23624 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23625 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23626 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23627 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23628
23629 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23630 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23631 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23632 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23633 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23634 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23635 .code
23636 cram:
23637 driver = cram_md5
23638 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23639 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23640 client_name = ph10
23641 client_secret = secret2
23642 .endd
23643 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23644 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23645
23646 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23647 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23648 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23649 in Exim.
23650
23651 .new
23652 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
23653 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
23654 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
23655 authenticating data.
23656
23657 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
23658 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
23659 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
23660 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
23661 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
23662 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
23663 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
23664 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
23665 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
23666 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
23667 choose to honour.
23668
23669 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
23670 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
23671 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
23672 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
23673 .wen
23674
23675
23676
23677 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23678 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23679 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23680
23681 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23682 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23683 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23684 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23685 encrypted by a setting such as:
23686 .code
23687 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23688 .endd
23689 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23690 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23691 cipher used for the delivery.)
23692
23693
23694 .option driver authenticators string unset
23695 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23696 authenticators is to be used.
23697
23698
23699 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23700 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23701 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23702 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23703 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23704 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23705
23706
23707 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23708 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23709 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23710 mechanism is not advertised.
23711 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23712 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23713 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23714
23715
23716 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23717 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23718 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23719 for details.
23720
23721 .new
23722 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
23723 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
23724 .wen
23725
23726 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23727 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23728 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23729 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23730 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23731 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23732 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23733 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23734 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23735 the error text.
23736
23737
23738 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23739 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23740 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23741 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23742 out the values of variables.
23743 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23744 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23745
23746
23747 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23748 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23749 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23750 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23751 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23752 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23753 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23754 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23755 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23756
23757
23758 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23759 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23760 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23761 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23762 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23763 remembered for later use.
23764 How it is used is described in the following section.
23765
23766
23767
23768
23769
23770 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23771 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23772 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23773 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23774 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23775 message:
23776
23777 .ilist
23778 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23779 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23780 .next
23781 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23782 .next
23783 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23784 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23785 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23786 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23787 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23788 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23789 given for the MAIL command.
23790 .next
23791 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23792 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23793 authenticated.
23794 .next
23795 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23796 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23797 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23798 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23799 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23800 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23801 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23802 message.
23803 .endlist
23804
23805
23806 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23807 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23808 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23809 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23810
23811 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23812 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23813 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23814 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23815 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23816 ACL is run.
23817
23818
23819
23820 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23821 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23822 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23823 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23824 conditions:
23825
23826 .ilist
23827 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23828 .next
23829 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23830 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23831 .endlist
23832
23833 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23834 the mechanisms are advertised.
23835
23836 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23837 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23838 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23839 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23840 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23841 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23842 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23843 .code
23844 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23845 .endd
23846 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23847
23848 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23849 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23850 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23851 such as:
23852 .code
23853 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23854 .endd
23855 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23856 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23857 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23858
23859 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23860 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23861 command. This is the case if
23862
23863 .ilist
23864 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23865 .next
23866 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23867 .next
23868 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23869 server authenticators.
23870 .endlist
23871
23872
23873 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23874 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23875 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23876
23877 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23878 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23879 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23880 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23881 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23882 rejected with a 504 error.
23883
23884 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23885 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23886 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23887 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23888 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23889 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23890 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23891 no successful authentication.
23892
23893
23894
23895
23896 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23897 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23898 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23899 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23900 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23901 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23902 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23903 script:
23904 .code
23905 use MIME::Base64;
23906 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23907 .endd
23908 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23909 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23910 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23911 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23912 command line to run this script on such data might be
23913 .code
23914 encode '\0user\0password'
23915 .endd
23916 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23917 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23918 whose code value is zero.
23919
23920 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23921 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23922 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23923 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23924
23925 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23926 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23927 example, a command such as
23928 .code
23929 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23930 .endd
23931 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23932
23933 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23934 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23935 .code
23936 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23937 .endd
23938 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23939 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23940 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23941 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23942
23943
23944
23945 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23946 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23947 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23948 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23949 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23950 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23951
23952 .ilist
23953 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23954 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23955 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23956 of the authenticator.
23957 .next
23958 .vindex "&$host$&"
23959 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23960 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23961 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23962 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23963 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23964 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23965 delivery to be deferred.
23966 .next
23967 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23968 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23969 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23970 usual way.
23971 .next
23972 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23973 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23974 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23975 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23976 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23977 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23978 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23979 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23980 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23981 .endlist
23982
23983 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23984 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23985 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23986 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23987 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23988 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23989 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23990 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23991 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23992 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23993 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23994 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23995 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23996
23997
23998
23999
24000
24001
24002 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24003 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24004
24005 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24006 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24007 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24008 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24009 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24010 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24011 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24012 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24013 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24014 connections as you do for login accounts.
24015
24016 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24017 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24018 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24019
24020 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24021 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24022 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24023
24024 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24025 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24026 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24027 given.
24028
24029 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24030 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24031 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24032 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24033 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24034 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24035 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24036
24037 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24038 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24039 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24040 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24041 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24042 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24043 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24044
24045 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24046 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24047 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24048 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24049
24050 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24051 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24052 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24053
24054 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24055 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24056 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24057 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24058 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24059 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24060 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24061 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24062 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24063 string as the error text.
24064
24065 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24066 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24067 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24068
24069
24070
24071 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24072 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24073 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24074 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24075 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24076 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24077 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24078 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24079
24080 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24081 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24082 configured as follows:
24083 .code
24084 fixed_plain:
24085 driver = plaintext
24086 public_name = PLAIN
24087 server_prompts = :
24088 server_condition = \
24089 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24090 server_set_id = $auth2
24091 .endd
24092 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24093 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24094 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24095 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24096
24097 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24098 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24099 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24100 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24101 .code
24102 250-AUTH PLAIN
24103 .endd
24104 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24105 .code
24106 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24107 .endd
24108 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24109 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24110 .code
24111 AUTH PLAIN
24112 .endd
24113 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24114 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24115
24116 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24117 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24118 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24119 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24120 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24121
24122 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24123 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24124 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24125
24126 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24127 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24128 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24129 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24130 This is an incorrect example:
24131 .code
24132 server_condition = \
24133 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24134 .endd
24135 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24136 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24137 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24138 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24139 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24140 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24141 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24142 .code
24143 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24144 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24145 .endd
24146 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24147 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24148 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24149 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24150 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24151
24152
24153 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24154 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24155 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24156 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24157 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24158 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24159 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24160 .code
24161 fixed_login:
24162 driver = plaintext
24163 public_name = LOGIN
24164 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24165 server_condition = \
24166 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24167 server_set_id = $auth1
24168 .endd
24169 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24170 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24171 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24172 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24173
24174 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24175 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24176 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24177 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24178 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24179 .code
24180 login:
24181 driver = plaintext
24182 public_name = LOGIN
24183 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24184 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24185 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
24186 ldapauth{\
24187 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24188 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24189 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24190 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24191 .endd
24192 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24193 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24194 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24195 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24196 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24197 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24198 uninterpreted string.
24199
24200
24201 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24202 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24203 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24204 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24205 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24206 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
24207
24208
24209
24210
24211 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24212 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24213 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24214
24215 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24216 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24217 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24218 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24219 usual.
24220
24221 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24222 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24223 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24224 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24225 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24226 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24227 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24228 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24229 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24230 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24231 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24232 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24233
24234 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24235 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24236
24237 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24238 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24239 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24240 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24241 the string.
24242
24243 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24244 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24245 .code
24246 fixed_plain:
24247 driver = plaintext
24248 public_name = PLAIN
24249 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24250 .endd
24251 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24252 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24253 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24254 .code
24255 fixed_login:
24256 driver = plaintext
24257 public_name = LOGIN
24258 client_send = : username : mysecret
24259 .endd
24260 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24261 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24262 prompts.
24263 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24264 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24265
24266
24267
24268
24269 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24270 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24271
24272 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24273 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24274 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24275 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24276 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24277 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24278 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24279 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24280 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24281 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24282 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24283 available in plain text at either end.
24284
24285
24286 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24287 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24288 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24289 authenticator as a server:
24290
24291 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24292 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24293 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24294 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24295 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24296 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24297 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24298 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24299 returned to the client.
24300
24301 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24302 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24303 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24304 numeric variables for other things.
24305
24306 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24307 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24308 user name, authentication fails.
24309 .code
24310 fixed_cram:
24311 driver = cram_md5
24312 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24313 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24314 server_set_id = $auth1
24315 .endd
24316 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24317 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24318 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24319 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24320 .code
24321 lookup_cram:
24322 driver = cram_md5
24323 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24324 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24325 {$value}fail}
24326 server_set_id = $auth1
24327 .endd
24328 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24329 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24330
24331 .new
24332 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24333 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24334 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24335 realm, with:
24336 .code
24337 cyrusless_crammd5:
24338 driver = cram_md5
24339 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24340 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24341 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24342 server_set_id = $auth1
24343 .endd
24344 .wen
24345
24346 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24347 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24348 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24349
24350
24351
24352 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24353 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24354 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24355
24356
24357 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24358 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24359 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24360
24361
24362 .vindex "&$host$&"
24363 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24364 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24365 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24366 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24367 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24368 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24369 send the message to the current server.
24370
24371 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24372 strings, is:
24373 .code
24374 fixed_cram:
24375 driver = cram_md5
24376 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24377 client_name = ph10
24378 client_secret = secret
24379 .endd
24380 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24381 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24382
24383
24384
24385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24387
24388 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24389 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24390 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24391 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24392 .cindex "Kerberos"
24393 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24394 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24395
24396 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24397 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24398 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24399 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24400 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24401
24402 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24403 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24404 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24405 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24406
24407 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24408 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24409 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24410 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24411 depending on the driver you are using.
24412
24413 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24414 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24415 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24416 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24417 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24418 implementation.
24419 .new
24420 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24421 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24422 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24423 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24424 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24425 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24426 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24427 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24428 .wen
24429
24430
24431 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24432 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24433 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24434 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24435 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24436 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24437 things.
24438
24439
24440 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24441 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24442 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24443 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24444
24445
24446 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24447 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24448 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24449 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24450 example:
24451 .code
24452 sasl:
24453 driver = cyrus_sasl
24454 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24455 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24456 server_set_id = $auth1
24457 .endd
24458
24459 .new
24460 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
24461 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24462 .wen
24463
24464
24465 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24466 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24467
24468
24469 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24470 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24471 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24472 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24473 .code
24474 sasl_cram_md5:
24475 driver = cyrus_sasl
24476 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24477 server_set_id = $auth1
24478
24479 sasl_plain:
24480 driver = cyrus_sasl
24481 public_name = PLAIN
24482 server_set_id = $auth2
24483 .endd
24484 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
24485 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
24486 but it is present in many binary distributions.
24487 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
24488 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
24489
24490
24491
24492
24493 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24494 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24495 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
24496 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
24497 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
24498 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24499 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24500 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24501 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24502 authenticator only. There is only one option:
24503
24504 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
24505
24506 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24507 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24508 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24509 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24510 .code
24511 dovecot_plain:
24512 driver = dovecot
24513 public_name = PLAIN
24514 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24515 server_set_id = $auth2
24516
24517 dovecot_ntlm:
24518 driver = dovecot
24519 public_name = NTLM
24520 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24521 server_set_id = $auth1
24522 .endd
24523 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24524 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24525 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24526 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24527 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24528 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24529 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24530 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24531
24532
24533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24534 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24535 .new
24536 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
24537 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
24538 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
24539 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
24540 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
24541 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24542 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24543 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
24544 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
24545 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
24546 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
24547 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
24548 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
24549 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.78 release
24550 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
24551 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
24552 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
24553 without code changes in Exim.
24554
24555
24556 .option server_channelbinding gsasl bool false
24557 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
24558 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
24559 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
24560 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
24561 context.
24562
24563 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
24564 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
24565 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
24566
24567 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
24568 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
24569 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
24570
24571 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
24572 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
24573 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
24574
24575
24576 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
24577 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24578 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24579 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24580
24581
24582 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
24583 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24584 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24585 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24586 example:
24587 .code
24588 sasl:
24589 driver = gsasl
24590 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24591 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24592 server_set_id = $auth1
24593 .endd
24594
24595
24596 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
24597 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
24598 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
24599 the password itself.
24600
24601 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
24602 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
24603 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
24604 if available, else the empty string.
24605 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
24606 else the empty string.
24607
24608 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
24609
24610 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
24611 option to be simply "true".
24612
24613
24614 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
24615 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24616 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24617
24618
24619 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
24620 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24621 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24622 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24623
24624
24625 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
24626 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24627 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24628 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24629
24630
24631 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
24632 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24633 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24634
24635
24636 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
24637 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24638 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
24639 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
24640
24641 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
24642 meanings for these variables:
24643
24644 .ilist
24645 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24646 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
24647 .next
24648 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24649 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
24650 .next
24651 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
24652 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
24653 .endlist
24654
24655 On a per-mechanism basis:
24656
24657 .ilist
24658 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24659 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
24660 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24661 .next
24662 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24663 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
24664 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24665 .next
24666 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24667 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
24668 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
24669 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24670 .endlist
24671
24672 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
24673 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
24674 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
24675
24676
24677 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
24678 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
24679 .code
24680 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
24681 driver = gsasl
24682 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24683 server_realm = imap.example.org
24684 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
24685 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
24686 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
24687 server_condition = yes
24688 .endd
24689
24690 .wen
24691
24692 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24694
24695 .new
24696 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
24697 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
24698 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
24699 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24700 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
24701 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
24702 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
24703 reliably.
24704
24705 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
24706 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
24707 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
24708 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24709
24710 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
24711 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
24712 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
24713 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
24714
24715 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
24716 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
24717 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
24718 from the keytab.
24719
24720
24721 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
24722 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
24723 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
24724 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
24725
24726 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
24727 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
24728 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
24729 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
24730
24731 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24732 .ilist
24733 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24734 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
24735 .next
24736 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24737 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
24738 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
24739 GSS Display Name.
24740 .endlist
24741
24742 .wen
24743
24744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24745 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24746
24747 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
24748 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
24749 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
24750 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
24751 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
24752 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
24753 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
24754 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
24755 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
24756 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
24757 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
24758 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
24759 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
24760 follows:
24761
24762 .ilist
24763 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
24764 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
24765 .next
24766 The server sends back a challenge.
24767 .next
24768 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
24769 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
24770 .endlist
24771
24772 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
24773
24774
24775
24776 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
24777 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
24778 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
24779
24780 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
24781 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
24782 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
24783 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
24784 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
24785 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
24786 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
24787 for other things. For example:
24788 .code
24789 spa:
24790 driver = spa
24791 public_name = NTLM
24792 server_password = \
24793 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24794 .endd
24795 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24796 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24797
24798
24799
24800
24801
24802 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24803 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24804 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24805
24806
24807
24808 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24809 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24810
24811
24812 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
24813 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
24814
24815
24816 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
24817 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
24818 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24819 &'msn.com'&:
24820 .code
24821 msn:
24822 driver = spa
24823 public_name = MSN
24824 client_username = msn/msn_username
24825 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24826 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24827 .endd
24828 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
24829 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
24830
24831
24832
24833
24834
24835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24836 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24837
24838 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24839 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24840 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24841 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24842 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24843 .cindex "OpenSSL"
24844 .cindex "GnuTLS"
24845 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24846 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24847 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24848 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24849 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24850 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24851 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24852 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24853 certificates are used.
24854
24855 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24856 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24857 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24858 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24859 between them is encrypted.
24860
24861 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24862 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24863 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24864 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24865 encryption state.
24866
24867 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24868 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24869 in order to get TLS to work.
24870
24871
24872
24873 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24874 "SECID284"
24875 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24876 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24877 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24878 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24879 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24880 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24881 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24882 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24883 allocated for this purpose.
24884
24885 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24886 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24887 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24888 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24889 .code
24890 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24891 .endd
24892 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24893 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24894 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24895 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24896 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24897 defined elsewhere.
24898
24899 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24900 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24901
24902
24903
24904
24905
24906
24907 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24908 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24909 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24910 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24911 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24912 .code
24913 USE_GNUTLS=yes
24914 .endd
24915 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24916 .code
24917 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
24918 .endd
24919 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24920 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24921
24922 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24923
24924 .ilist
24925 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24926 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24927 .next
24928 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24929 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24930 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24931 .next
24932 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24933 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24934 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24935 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24936 .next
24937 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24938 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24939 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24940 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24941 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24942 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24943 option).
24944 .next
24945 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24946 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24947 .new
24948 .next
24949 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
24950 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
24951 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
24952 implementation, then patches are welcome.
24953 .wen
24954 .endlist
24955
24956
24957 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24958 .new
24959 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24960 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24961 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24962 &_gnutls-params-normal_&.
24963 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24964 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
24965 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24966 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24967 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24968 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24969 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24970
24971 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24972 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24973 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24974 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24975 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24976 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24977 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24978 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24979
24980 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24981 in &_gnutls-params-normal_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
24982 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24983
24984 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24985 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24986 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24987 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24988 .code
24989 # rm -f new-params
24990 # touch new-params
24991 # chown exim:exim new-params
24992 # chmod 0600 new-params
24993 # certtool --generate-dh-params >>new-params
24994 # chmod 0400 new-params
24995 # mv new-params gnutls-params-normal
24996 .endd
24997 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24998 stalling is removed.
24999
25000 The filename changed in Exim 4.78, to gain the -normal suffix, corresponding
25001 to the GnuTLS constant &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, defining the number of
25002 bits to include. At time of writing, NORMAL corresponds to 2432 bits for D-H.
25003 .wen
25004
25005
25006 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25007 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25008 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25009 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25010 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25011 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25012 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25013 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25014 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25015
25016 .ilist
25017 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25018 .next
25019 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25020 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25021 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25022 SSL v3 algorithms.
25023 .next
25024 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25025 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25026 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25027 algorithms.
25028 .endlist
25029
25030 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25031 &`-`& or &`+`&.
25032 .ilist
25033 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25034 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25035 stated.
25036 .next
25037 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25038 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25039 .next
25040 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25041 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25042 .endlist
25043
25044 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25045 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25046 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25047 not be moved to the end of the list.
25048 .endlist
25049
25050
25051
25052 .new
25053 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25054 "SECTreqciphgnu"
25055 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25056 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25057 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25058 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25059 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25060 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25061 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25062 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25063 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25064 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25065
25066 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25067
25068 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25069 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25070 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25071 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25072 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25073 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25074
25075 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25076 "Priority strings". This is online as
25077 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html).
25078
25079 Prior to Exim 4.78, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25080 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25081 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25082 .wen
25083
25084
25085 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25086 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25087 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25088 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25089 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25090 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25091 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25092 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25093
25094 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25095 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25096 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25097 with the error
25098 .code
25099 554 Security failure
25100 .endd
25101 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25102 rejected with a 554 error code.
25103
25104 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25105 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25106 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25107 without some further configuration at the server end.
25108
25109 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25110 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25111 .code
25112 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25113 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25114 .endd
25115 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25116 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25117 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25118 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25119 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25120 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25121 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25122 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25123 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25124 the server's certificate.
25125
25126 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25127 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25128 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25129
25130 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25131 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25132 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25133 transport.
25134
25135 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25136 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25137 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25138 .code
25139 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25140 .endd
25141 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25142 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
25143 suites that the server supports. See the command
25144 .code
25145 openssl dhparam
25146 .endd
25147 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
25148 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
25149
25150 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25151 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25152 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25153 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25154 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25155
25156 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25157 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25158 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
25159 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25160 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25161 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25162 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25163 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25164 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25165 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
25166 &<<SECID185>>&.)
25167
25168 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25169 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25170 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25171 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25172 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25173 documentation for more details.
25174
25175
25176 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25177 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25178 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25179 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25180 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25181 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25182 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25183 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25184 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25185 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25186 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25187 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25188
25189 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25190 directory is used
25191 (OpenSSL only),
25192 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25193 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25194 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25195 .code
25196 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25197 .endd
25198 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25199
25200 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25201 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25202 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25203 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25204 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25205 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25206 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25207 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25208 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25209 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25210
25211 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
25212 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25213 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25214 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25215
25216 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25217 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25218 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25219 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25220 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25221 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
25222
25223
25224 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25225 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25226 .cindex "revocation list"
25227 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25228 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25229 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25230 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25231 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25232 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25233 CRL in PEM format.
25234
25235
25236 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25237 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25238 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25239 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25240 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25241 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25242 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25243 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25244 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25245
25246 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25247 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25248 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25249 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25250 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25251
25252 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25253 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25254 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25255 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25256 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25257 usual way.
25258
25259 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25260 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25261 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25262 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25263 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25264 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25265 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25266 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25267 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25268 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25269 unencrypted.
25270
25271 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25272 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25273 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25274 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25275
25276 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25277 must name a file or,
25278 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25279 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25280 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25281 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25282
25283 If
25284 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25285 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25286 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25287 alternative hosts, if any.
25288
25289 &*Note*&:
25290 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25291 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25292 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25293 client.
25294
25295 .vindex "&$host$&"
25296 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25297 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25298 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25299 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25300 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25301
25302 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25303 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25304 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25305 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25306 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25307 &$tls_bits$&, &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25308 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25309 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25310 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25311 outgoing connection.
25312
25313
25314
25315 .new
25316 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
25317 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25318 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25319 .oindex "&%tls_sni%&"
25320 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
25321 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
25322 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
25323 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
25324 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
25325 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
25326 for this session.
25327
25328 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
25329 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
25330 address.
25331
25332 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
25333 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
25334 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
25335 be of limited use in that environment.
25336
25337 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
25338 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
25339 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
25340 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
25341 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
25342
25343 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
25344 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
25345 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
25346 only point of caution. The &$tls_sni$& variable will be set to this string
25347 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
25348
25349 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_sni$& is set then it is a string
25350 received from a client.
25351 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
25352
25353 If the string &`tls_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
25354 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
25355 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
25356
25357 .ilist
25358 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
25359 &%tls_certificate%&
25360 .next
25361 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
25362 &%tls_crl%&
25363 .next
25364 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
25365 &%tls_privatekey%&
25366 .next
25367 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
25368 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
25369 .endlist
25370
25371 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
25372 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
25373 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
25374 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
25375
25376 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
25377 are re-expanded.
25378
25379 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
25380 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
25381 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
25382 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
25383
25384 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
25385 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
25386 built, then you have SNI support).
25387 .wen
25388
25389
25390
25391 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
25392 "SECTmulmessam"
25393 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
25394 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25395 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
25396 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
25397 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
25398 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
25399 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
25400 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
25401 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
25402 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
25403 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
25404
25405 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
25406 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
25407 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
25408 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
25409 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
25410 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
25411 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
25412 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
25413 and delay other deliveries to that host.
25414
25415 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
25416 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
25417 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
25418 information is recorded.
25419
25420 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
25421 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
25422 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
25423
25424
25425
25426
25427 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
25428 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
25429 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
25430 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
25431 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
25432 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
25433 to Apache, currently at
25434 .display
25435 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
25436 .endd
25437 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
25438 links to further files.
25439 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
25440 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
25441 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
25442 .display
25443 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
25444 .endd
25445
25446
25447 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
25448 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
25449 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
25450 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
25451 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
25452 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
25453 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
25454 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
25455 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
25456 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
25457 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
25458 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
25459 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
25460
25461
25462 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
25463 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
25464 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
25465 with OpenSSL, like this:
25466 .code
25467 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
25468 -days 9999 -nodes
25469 .endd
25470 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
25471 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
25472 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
25473 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
25474 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
25475 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
25476 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
25477
25478 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
25479 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
25480 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
25481
25482 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
25483 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
25484 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
25485 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
25486 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
25487 signed with that self-signed certificate.
25488
25489 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
25490 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
25491 Open-source PKI book, available online at
25492 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
25493 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
25494 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
25495
25496
25497
25498 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25499 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25500
25501 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
25502 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
25503 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
25504 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
25505 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
25506 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
25507 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
25508 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
25509 one very small ACL:
25510 .code
25511 begin acl
25512 small_acl:
25513 accept hosts = one.host.only
25514 .endd
25515 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
25516 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
25517
25518 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
25519 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
25520 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
25521 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
25522 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
25523 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
25524 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
25525 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
25526
25527
25528 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
25529 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
25530 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
25531 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
25532 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
25533
25534
25535
25536 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
25537 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
25538 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
25539 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
25540 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
25541 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25542 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
25543 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
25544 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25545 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25546 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
25547 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25548 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
25549 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
25550 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
25551 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25552 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25553 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
25554
25555 .table2 140pt
25556 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
25557 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
25558 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
25559 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
25560 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
25561 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
25562 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
25563 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
25564 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
25565 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
25566 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
25567 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
25568 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
25569 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
25570 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
25571 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
25572 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
25573 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
25574 .endtable
25575
25576 For example, if you set
25577 .code
25578 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
25579 .endd
25580 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
25581 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
25582 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
25583 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
25584 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
25585 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
25586 testing as possible at RCPT time.
25587
25588
25589 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
25590 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25591 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
25592 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
25593 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
25594 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
25595 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
25596 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
25597 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
25598 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
25599 in any of these ACLs.
25600
25601 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
25602 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
25603 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
25604 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
25605 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
25606 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
25607 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
25608 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
25609 .code
25610 control = suppress_local_fixups
25611 .endd
25612 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
25613 run, it is too late.
25614
25615 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25616 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25617
25618 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
25619 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
25620 temporary error for these kinds of message.
25621
25622
25623 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
25624 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25625 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
25626 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
25627 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
25628 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
25629 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
25630 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
25631 &%smtp_banner%& option.
25632
25633
25634 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
25635 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25636 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25637 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
25638 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
25639 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
25640 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
25641 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
25642 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
25643
25644 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
25645 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
25646 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
25647 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
25648 an EHLO response.
25649
25650
25651 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
25652 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25653 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
25654 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
25655 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
25656 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
25657 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
25658 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
25659 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
25660 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
25661
25662 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
25663 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
25664 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
25665 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
25666 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
25667 associated with the DATA command.
25668
25669 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
25670 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
25671 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
25672 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
25673 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
25674 your resources.
25675
25676
25677 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
25678 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
25679 enabled (which is the default).
25680
25681 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
25682 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
25683 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
25684
25685 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHID12>>&.
25686
25687
25688 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
25689 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25690 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25691
25692
25693 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
25694 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25695 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
25696 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
25697 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
25698 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
25699
25700 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
25701 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
25702 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
25703 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
25704
25705 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
25706 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
25707
25708 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
25709 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
25710 response to QUIT.
25711
25712 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
25713 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
25714 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
25715 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
25716 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
25717
25718
25719 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
25720 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
25721 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
25722 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
25723 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
25724 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
25725 situation even worse.
25726
25727 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
25728 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
25729 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
25730 and &%warn%&.
25731
25732 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
25733 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
25734 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
25735 connection. The possible values are:
25736 .table2
25737 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
25738 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
25739 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
25740 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
25741 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
25742 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
25743 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
25744 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
25745 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
25746 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
25747 .endtable
25748 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
25749 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
25750 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
25751 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
25752 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
25753 used.
25754
25755
25756 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
25757 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
25758 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
25759 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
25760 .code
25761 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
25762 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
25763 .endd
25764 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
25765 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
25766 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
25767 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
25768 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
25769
25770 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
25771 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
25772 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
25773
25774 .ilist
25775 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
25776 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
25777 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
25778 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
25779 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
25780 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
25781 .code
25782 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
25783 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
25784 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
25785 .endd
25786 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
25787 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
25788 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
25789 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
25790 .next
25791 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
25792 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
25793 matches the string.
25794 .next
25795 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
25796 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
25797 want to have something like
25798 .code
25799 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
25800 .endd
25801 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
25802 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
25803 .endlist
25804
25805
25806
25807
25808 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
25809 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
25810 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
25811 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
25812 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
25813 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
25814 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
25815 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
25816 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
25817
25818 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
25819 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
25820 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
25821
25822
25823 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
25824 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
25825 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
25826 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
25827
25828 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
25829 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
25830 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
25831 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
25832 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
25833 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
25834 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
25835
25836
25837 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
25838 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
25839 recipients; it may create new recipients.
25840
25841
25842
25843 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
25844 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
25845 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
25846 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
25847 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
25848 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
25849
25850 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
25851 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
25852 used to accept or reject anything.
25853
25854 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
25855 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
25856 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
25857 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
25858
25859 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
25860 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
25861 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
25862 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
25863 configuration file.
25864
25865
25866
25867
25868 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
25869 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
25870 .vindex &$domain$&
25871 .vindex &$local_part$&
25872 .vindex &$sender_address$&
25873 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
25874 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25875 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
25876 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
25877 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
25878 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
25879 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
25880 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25881
25882 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
25883 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
25884 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
25885 how it is used.
25886
25887 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
25888 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
25889 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
25890 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
25891 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
25892 received).
25893
25894 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
25895 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
25896 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
25897 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
25898 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
25899 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
25900 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
25901 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
25902
25903
25904
25905
25906
25907 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25908 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25909 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25910 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25911 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25912 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25913 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25914 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25915 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25916 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25917 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25918 unencrypted connections.
25919 .code
25920 acl_check_auth:
25921 accept encrypted = *
25922 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25923 {CRAM-MD5}}
25924 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25925 .endd
25926 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25927 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25928 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25929 option to do this.)
25930
25931
25932
25933 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25934 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25935 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25936 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25937 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25938 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25939 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25940
25941 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25942 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25943 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25944 example:
25945 .code
25946 deny dnslists = list1.example
25947 dnslists = list2.example
25948 .endd
25949 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25950 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25951 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25952 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25953 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25954
25955
25956 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25957 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25958
25959 .ilist
25960 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25961 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25962 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25963 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25964 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25965 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25966 check a RCPT command:
25967 .code
25968 accept domains = +local_domains
25969 endpass
25970 verify = recipient
25971 .endd
25972 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25973 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25974 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25975 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25976 &%endpass%&.
25977
25978 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25979 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25980 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25981 configuration.
25982
25983 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25984 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25985 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25986 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25987 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25988 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25989 .display
25990 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25991 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25992 .endd
25993 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25994 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25995 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25996
25997 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25998 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25999 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26000 of &%endpass%&.
26001
26002
26003 .next
26004 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26005 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26006 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26007 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26008 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26009 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26010 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26011
26012
26013 .next
26014 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26015 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26016 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26017 example,
26018 .code
26019 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26020 .endd
26021 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26022
26023
26024 .next
26025 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26026 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26027 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26028 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26029 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26030 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26031 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26032 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26033 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26034
26035 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26036 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26037 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26038
26039
26040 .next
26041 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26042 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26043 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26044 .code
26045 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26046 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26047 .endd
26048 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26049 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26050
26051 .next
26052 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26053 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26054 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26055 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26056 .code
26057 require message = Sender did not verify
26058 verify = sender
26059 .endd
26060 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26061 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26062 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26063 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26064
26065 .next
26066 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26067 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26068 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26069 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26070 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26071 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26072 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26073
26074 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26075 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26076 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
26077 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26078 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26079
26080 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26081 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26082 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26083 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26084 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26085 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26086 onwards.
26087
26088
26089 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26090 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26091 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26092 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26093 .code
26094 warn !verify = sender
26095 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26096 .endd
26097 .endlist
26098
26099 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26100
26101 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26102 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26103 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26104 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26105 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26106
26107
26108
26109 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26110 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26111 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26112 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26113 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26114 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26115 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26116 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26117 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26118 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26119 .ilist
26120 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26121 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26122 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26123 on the same SMTP connection.
26124 .next
26125 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26126 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26127 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26128 .endlist
26129
26130 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26131 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26132 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26133 .code
26134 accept hosts = whatever
26135 set acl_m4 = some value
26136 accept authenticated = *
26137 set acl_c_auth = yes
26138 .endd
26139 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26140 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26141 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26142
26143 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26144 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26145 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26146 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26147 error is generated.
26148
26149 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26150 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26151
26152
26153 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26154 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26155 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26156 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26157 .code
26158 deny domains = *.dom.example
26159 !verify = recipient
26160 .endd
26161 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26162 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26163 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26164 two statements are equivalent:
26165 .code
26166 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26167 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26168 .endd
26169 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26170 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26171
26172 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26173 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26174 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26175 .code
26176 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26177 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26178 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26179 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26180 .endd
26181 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26182 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26183 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26184 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26185 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26186 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26187 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26188
26189 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26190 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26191 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26192 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26193 message is handled.
26194
26195 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
26196 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26197 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26198 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26199 .code
26200 require message = Can't verify sender
26201 verify = sender
26202 message = Can't verify recipient
26203 verify = recipient
26204 message = This message cannot be used
26205 .endd
26206 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26207 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26208 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26209 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26210 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26211 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26212
26213 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26214 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26215 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26216 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26217 .code
26218 deny hosts = ...
26219 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26220 message = Invalid sender from client host
26221 .endd
26222 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26223 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26224
26225
26226
26227 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26228 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26229 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26230
26231 .vlist
26232 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26233 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26234 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26235 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26236
26237 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26238 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26239 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26240 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26241 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26242 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26243 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26244 write rather ugly lines like this:
26245 .display
26246 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26247 .endd
26248 Instead, all you need is
26249 .display
26250 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26251 .endd
26252
26253 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26254 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26255 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26256 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26257 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26258 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26259 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26260 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26261
26262 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26263 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26264 in several different ways. For example:
26265
26266 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26267 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26268 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26269 . ==== way.
26270
26271 .ilist
26272 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26273 .code
26274 accept ...some conditions
26275 control = queue_only
26276 .endd
26277 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26278 other words, when the conditions are all true.
26279
26280 .next
26281 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26282 .code
26283 accept ...some conditions...
26284 control = queue_only
26285 ...some more conditions...
26286 .endd
26287 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26288 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26289 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26290 to be relevant.
26291
26292 .next
26293 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26294 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26295 example:
26296 .code
26297 warn ...some conditions...
26298 control = freeze
26299 accept ...
26300 .endd
26301 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26302 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26303 log entry.
26304
26305 .next
26306 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26307 &%require%& verb. For example:
26308 .code
26309 require control = no_multiline_responses
26310 .endd
26311 .endlist
26312
26313 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26314 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26315 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
26316 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
26317 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
26318 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
26319 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
26320 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
26321 flushed before the delay is imposed.
26322
26323 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26324 example:
26325 .code
26326 deny ...some conditions...
26327 delay = 30s
26328 .endd
26329 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26330 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
26331 .code
26332 deny delay = 30s
26333 ...some conditions...
26334 .endd
26335 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26336 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26337 .code
26338 warn ...some conditions...
26339 delay = 2m
26340 control = freeze
26341 accept ...
26342 .endd
26343
26344 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
26345 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
26346 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
26347 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
26348 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
26349 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
26350 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
26351
26352
26353 .vitem &*endpass*&
26354 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
26355 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
26356 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
26357 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
26358 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
26359 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
26360 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
26361
26362
26363 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26364 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
26365 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
26366 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
26367 .code
26368 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
26369 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
26370 .endd
26371 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
26372 example:
26373 .display
26374 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
26375 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
26376 .endd
26377 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
26378 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
26379 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
26380 message.
26381
26382 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
26383 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
26384 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
26385 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
26386 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
26387 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
26388 ignored.
26389
26390 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26391 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
26392 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
26393 error message.
26394
26395 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
26396 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
26397 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
26398 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
26399 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
26400 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
26401
26402 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
26403 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
26404 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
26405 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
26406 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
26407 logging rejections.
26408
26409
26410 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
26411 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
26412 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
26413 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
26414 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
26415 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
26416 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
26417 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
26418 .display
26419 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
26420 &` log_reject_target =`&
26421 .endd
26422 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
26423 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
26424 current ACL.
26425
26426
26427 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26428 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
26429 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
26430 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
26431 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
26432 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
26433 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
26434 ACLs. For example:
26435 .display
26436 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
26437 &` control = freeze`&
26438 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
26439 .endd
26440 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
26441 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
26442 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
26443 example:
26444 .code
26445 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
26446 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
26447 .endd
26448
26449
26450 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26451 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26452 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
26453 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
26454 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
26455 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
26456 &%accept%& for details.)
26457
26458 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
26459 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
26460 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
26461 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
26462 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
26463 .code
26464 require message = Host not recognized
26465 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
26466 .endd
26467 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
26468 processed.)
26469
26470 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
26471 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
26472 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
26473 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
26474 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
26475 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
26476 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
26477 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
26478 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
26479 EHLO options.
26480
26481 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
26482 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
26483 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
26484 .code
26485 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
26486 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
26487 .endd
26488 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
26489 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
26490 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
26491 2&'xx'&.
26492
26493 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
26494 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
26495
26496 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
26497 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
26498 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
26499 response.
26500
26501 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26502 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
26503 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
26504 However, the original message is available in the variable
26505 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
26506 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
26507 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
26508 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
26509
26510 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
26511 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
26512 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
26513 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
26514 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
26515 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
26516 effect.
26517
26518
26519 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
26520 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
26521 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
26522 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
26523 .endlist
26524
26525
26526
26527
26528
26529 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
26530 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26531 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
26532
26533 .vlist
26534 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
26535 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
26536 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
26537 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
26538 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
26539 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
26540 not work without it. For example:
26541 .code
26542 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
26543 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
26544 .endd
26545 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
26546 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
26547 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
26548 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
26549 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
26550
26551
26552 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
26553 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
26554 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
26555 .cindex "case of local parts"
26556 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26557 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
26558 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
26559 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
26560 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
26561 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
26562 is encountered.
26563
26564 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
26565 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
26566 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
26567 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
26568 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
26569
26570 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
26571 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
26572 spam score:
26573 .code
26574 warn control = caseful_local_part
26575 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
26576 $acl_m4 + \
26577 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
26578 }
26579 control = caselower_local_part
26580 .endd
26581 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
26582 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
26583
26584
26585 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
26586 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
26587 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
26588 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
26589 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
26590 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
26591 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
26592 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
26593 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
26594 contexts):
26595 .code
26596 control = debug
26597 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
26598 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
26599 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
26600 .endd
26601
26602
26603 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
26604 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
26605 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
26606 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
26607 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
26608 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
26609 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
26610 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
26611
26612 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26613 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
26614 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
26615 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
26616 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
26617 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
26618 work with.
26619
26620
26621 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
26622 .cindex "fake defer"
26623 .cindex "defer, fake"
26624 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
26625 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
26626 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
26627 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
26628 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
26629
26630 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
26631 .cindex "fake rejection"
26632 .cindex "rejection, fake"
26633 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
26634 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
26635 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
26636 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
26637 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26638 the same SMTP connection.
26639
26640 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
26641 message is supplied, the following is used:
26642 .code
26643 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
26644 550-kept for evaluation.
26645 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
26646 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
26647 .endd
26648 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
26649
26650 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
26651 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
26652 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26653 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26654 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
26655 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
26656 SMTP connection.
26657
26658 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
26659 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
26660 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
26661 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
26662
26663 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
26664 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
26665 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
26666 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26667 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
26668 disables such output flushing.
26669
26670 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
26671 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
26672 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
26673 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26674 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
26675 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
26676
26677 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
26678 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
26679 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
26680 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
26681 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
26682 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
26683 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26684 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
26685 to be useful in production.
26686
26687 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
26688 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
26689 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
26690 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
26691 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
26692
26693 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
26694 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
26695 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
26696 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
26697 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
26698 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
26699
26700 .ilist
26701 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
26702 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
26703 verification failed"&) is sent.
26704 .next
26705 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
26706 line is output.
26707 .endlist
26708
26709 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
26710 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
26711
26712 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
26713 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
26714 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
26715 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
26716 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
26717 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
26718 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
26719
26720 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
26721 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
26722 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
26723 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26724 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26725 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
26726 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
26727 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
26728 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
26729 same SMTP connection.
26730
26731 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
26732 .cindex "message" "submission"
26733 .cindex "submission mode"
26734 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
26735 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
26736 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
26737 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
26738 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
26739 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
26740 late (the message has already been created).
26741
26742 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
26743 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
26744 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
26745 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
26746 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
26747
26748 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
26749 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
26750 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
26751 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
26752 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
26753
26754 .ilist
26755 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
26756 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
26757 .next
26758 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
26759 .next
26760 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
26761 .endlist ilist
26762
26763 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
26764 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
26765 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
26766 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
26767 data is read.
26768
26769 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
26770 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
26771 .endlist vlist
26772
26773
26774 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
26775 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
26776
26777 .ilist
26778 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
26779 .next
26780 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
26781 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
26782 .next
26783 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
26784 .next
26785 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
26786 .endlist
26787
26788
26789
26790 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
26791 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
26792 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
26793 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26794 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
26795 to an incoming message, as in this example:
26796 .code
26797 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26798 dialup.mail-abuse.org
26799 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
26800 .endd
26801 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
26802 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
26803 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
26804 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
26805 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
26806 RCPT ACL).
26807
26808 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
26809 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
26810 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
26811 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
26812
26813 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
26814 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
26815 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
26816 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
26817 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
26818 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
26819 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
26820 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
26821 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
26822 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
26823 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
26824
26825 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
26826 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
26827 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
26828 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
26829 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
26830 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
26831 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
26832 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
26833 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
26834
26835 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
26836 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
26837 .display
26838 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26839 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
26840
26841 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
26842 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26843 .endd
26844 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
26845 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
26846 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
26847 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
26848 honoured.
26849
26850 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26851 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
26852 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
26853 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
26854 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
26855 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
26856 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
26857 specifications.
26858
26859 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
26860 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
26861 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
26862 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
26863 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
26864
26865 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
26866 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
26867 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
26868 to be a header name first.) For example:
26869 .code
26870 warn add_header = \
26871 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
26872 .endd
26873 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
26874 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
26875 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
26876 up in reverse order.
26877
26878 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
26879 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
26880 system filter or in a router or transport.
26881
26882
26883
26884
26885 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
26886 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
26887 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
26888 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
26889 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
26890 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26891
26892 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
26893 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
26894 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
26895 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
26896 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
26897 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
26898 The conditions are as follows:
26899
26900
26901 .vlist
26902 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
26903 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
26904 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
26905 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
26906 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
26907 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
26908 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
26909 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
26910 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
26911 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
26912 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
26913
26914 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
26915 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
26916 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
26917 conditions are tested.
26918
26919 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
26920 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
26921 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
26922 for different local users or different local domains.
26923
26924 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26925 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26926 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26927 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26928 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26929 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26930 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26931 .code
26932 authenticated = *
26933 .endd
26934
26935 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26936 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26937 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26938 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26939 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26940 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26941 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26942 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26943 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26944 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26945 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26946 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26947 negative.
26948
26949 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26950 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26951 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26952 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26953 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26954 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26955 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26956 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26957
26958 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26959 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26960 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26961 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26962 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26963
26964 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26965 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26966 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26967 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26968 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26969 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26970 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26971 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26972 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26973 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26974
26975 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26976 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26977 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26978 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26979 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26980 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26981 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26982 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26983 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26984 &%domains%& test.
26985
26986 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26987 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26988
26989
26990 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26991 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26992 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26993 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26994 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26995 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26996 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26997 .code
26998 encrypted = *
26999 .endd
27000
27001
27002 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
27003 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27004 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27005 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27006 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27007 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27008 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27009 .code
27010 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27011 .endd
27012 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27013 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27014 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27015
27016 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27017 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27018 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27019 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27020 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27021 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27022
27023 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27024 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27025 .code
27026 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27027 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27028 .endd
27029 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27030 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27031 statement can then check the IP address.
27032
27033 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27034 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27035 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27036 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27037 .code
27038 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27039 message = $host_data
27040 .endd
27041 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27042
27043 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27044 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27045 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27046 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27047 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27048 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27049 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27050 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27051 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27052 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27053
27054 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27055 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27056 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27057 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27058 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27059 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27060 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27061
27062 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27063 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27064 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27065 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27066 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27067 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27068 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27069 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27070
27071 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27072 .cindex "rate limiting"
27073 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27074 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27075
27076 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27077 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27078 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27079 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27080 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27081 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27082
27083 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27084 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27085 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27086 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27087 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27088 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27089 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27090
27091 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27092 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27093 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27094 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27095 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27096 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27097 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27098 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27099 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27100 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27101 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27102 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27103 influence the sender checking.
27104
27105 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27106 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27107
27108 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27109 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27110 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27111 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27112 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27113 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27114 .code
27115 senders = :
27116 .endd
27117 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27118 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27119
27120 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
27121 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
27122 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
27123 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27124 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
27125 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27126
27127 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
27128 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27129 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27130 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27131 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
27132 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
27133 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
27134 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
27135 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
27136 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27137
27138 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
27139 .cindex "CSA verification"
27140 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
27141 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
27142 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
27143
27144 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
27145 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27146 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
27147 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
27148 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
27149 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
27150 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27151 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27152 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
27153 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
27154 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
27155 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
27156 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
27157 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
27158 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
27159
27160 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
27161 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
27162 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
27163 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
27164 .code
27165 deny senders = :
27166 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
27167 !verify = header_sender
27168 .endd
27169
27170 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
27171 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27172 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
27173 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27174 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27175 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27176 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27177 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27178 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27179 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27180 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27181 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27182 appropriate.
27183
27184 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27185 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
27186 .code
27187 To: @
27188 .endd
27189 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
27190 common as they used to be.
27191
27192 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
27193 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27194 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
27195 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
27196 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
27197 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
27198 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
27199 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
27200 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
27201 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
27202 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
27203 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
27204 independently of this condition.
27205
27206 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
27207 option), this condition is always true.
27208
27209
27210 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
27211 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
27212 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
27213 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
27214 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
27215 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
27216 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
27217 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
27218 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
27219
27220 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
27221 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
27222
27223
27224 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
27225 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27226 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
27227 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
27228 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
27229 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27230 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
27231 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
27232 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
27233 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
27234 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
27235 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
27236 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
27237 value for the child address.
27238
27239 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
27240 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27241 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
27242 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
27243 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
27244 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
27245 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
27246 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
27247 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
27248 original IP address.
27249
27250 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
27251 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
27252
27253 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
27254 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27255 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
27256 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
27257 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
27258 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
27259 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
27260 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
27261 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
27262
27263 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27264 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
27265 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
27266 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
27267 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
27268 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
27269 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
27270
27271 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
27272 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
27273 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
27274
27275 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
27276 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27277 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
27278 verified as a sender.
27279 .endlist
27280
27281
27282
27283 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
27284 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27285 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27286 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27287 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
27288 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
27289 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
27290 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
27291 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
27292 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
27293 .code
27294 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
27295 dialups.mail-abuse.org
27296 .endd
27297 the following records are looked up:
27298 .code
27299 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27300 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
27301 .endd
27302 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
27303 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
27304 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
27305 use two separate conditions:
27306 .code
27307 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27308 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27309 .endd
27310 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
27311 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
27312 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
27313 processed.
27314
27315 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
27316 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
27317 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
27318 following special items in the list:
27319 .display
27320 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
27321 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
27322 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
27323 .endd
27324 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
27325 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
27326 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
27327 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
27328 .code
27329 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
27330 .endd
27331 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
27332 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
27333 .code
27334 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27335 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
27336 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27337 .endd
27338 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
27339 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
27340 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
27341 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
27342
27343
27344
27345 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
27346 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
27347 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
27348 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
27349 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
27350 .code
27351 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
27352 .endd
27353 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
27354 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
27355 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
27356 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
27357
27358
27359
27360
27361 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
27362 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
27363 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
27364 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
27365 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
27366 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
27367 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
27368 .code
27369 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
27370 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27371 .endd
27372 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
27373 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
27374 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
27375 up by this example is
27376 .code
27377 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
27378 .endd
27379 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
27380 addresses. For example:
27381 .code
27382 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27383 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27384 .endd
27385 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
27386 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
27387
27388
27389
27390
27391 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
27392 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
27393 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
27394 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
27395 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
27396 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
27397 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
27398 either to double the separators like this:
27399 .code
27400 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
27401 .endd
27402 or to change the separator character, like this:
27403 .code
27404 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
27405 .endd
27406 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
27407 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
27408 occurs. Consider this condition:
27409 .code
27410 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
27411 .endd
27412 The DNS lookups that occur are:
27413 .code
27414 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
27415 a.domain.black.list.tld
27416 .endd
27417 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
27418 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
27419 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
27420 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
27421 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
27422 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
27423 error for a previous item.
27424
27425 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
27426 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
27427 .code
27428 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
27429 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
27430 .endd
27431 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
27432 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
27433 .code
27434 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
27435 $sender_address_domain \
27436 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
27437 see $dnslist_text.
27438 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
27439 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
27440 $sender_address_domain} }} }
27441 .endd
27442 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
27443 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
27444 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
27445 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
27446 .code
27447 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
27448 .endd
27449 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
27450 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
27451
27452 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
27453 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
27454
27455
27456
27457
27458 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
27459 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
27460 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
27461 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
27462 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
27463 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
27464 .display
27465 127.1.0.1 RBL
27466 127.1.0.2 DUL
27467 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
27468 127.1.0.4 RSS
27469 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
27470 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
27471 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
27472 .endd
27473 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
27474 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
27475 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
27476
27477
27478 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
27479 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
27480 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
27481 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
27482 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
27483 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
27484 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
27485 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
27486 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
27487 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
27488 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
27489 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
27490 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
27491 cases, for example:
27492 .code
27493 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
27494 .endd
27495 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
27496 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
27497 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
27498 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
27499 .code
27500 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
27501 .endd
27502 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
27503 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
27504
27505 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
27506 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
27507 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
27508 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
27509 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
27510 information.
27511
27512 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
27513 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
27514 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
27515 .code
27516 deny hosts = !+local_networks
27517 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
27518 at $dnslist_domain
27519 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
27520 .endd
27521
27522
27523
27524 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
27525 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
27526 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
27527 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
27528 For example,
27529 .code
27530 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
27531 .endd
27532 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
27533 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
27534 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
27535 describes how multiple records are handled.
27536
27537 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
27538 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
27539 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
27540 .code
27541 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27542 .endd
27543 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
27544 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
27545 first. For example:
27546 .code
27547 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
27548 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
27549 .endd
27550
27551 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
27552 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
27553 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
27554 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
27555 tested. For example:
27556 .code
27557 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
27558 .endd
27559 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
27560 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
27561 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
27562 .code
27563 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27564 .endd
27565 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
27566 an odd number.
27567
27568
27569
27570 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
27571 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
27572 condition. Whereas
27573 .code
27574 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27575 .endd
27576 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27577 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
27578 .code
27579 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27580 .endd
27581 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27582 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
27583 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
27584 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
27585
27586 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
27587 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
27588
27589 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
27590 previous example is precisely equivalent to
27591 .code
27592 deny dnslists = a.b.c
27593 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27594 .endd
27595 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
27596 Consider this example:
27597 .code
27598 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27599 list.dsbl.org : \
27600 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
27601 relays.ordb.org
27602 .endd
27603 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
27604 .code
27605 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27606 list.dsbl.org
27607 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
27608 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
27609 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
27610 .endd
27611 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
27612
27613
27614
27615
27616 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
27617 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
27618 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
27619 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
27620 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
27621 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
27622 .code
27623 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
27624 .endd
27625 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
27626 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
27627 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
27628 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
27629 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
27630 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
27631
27632 .ilist
27633 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
27634 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
27635 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27636 .next
27637 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
27638 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
27639 changed to:
27640 .code
27641 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
27642 .endd
27643 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27644 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
27645 .code
27646 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
27647 .endd
27648 for the condition to be true.
27649 .endlist
27650
27651 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
27652 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
27653 .ilist
27654 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
27655 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
27656 .code
27657 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
27658 .endd
27659 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27660 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27661 .next
27662 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
27663 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
27664 .code
27665 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
27666 .endd
27667 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27668 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
27669 .code
27670 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27671 .endd
27672 for the condition to be false.
27673 .endlist
27674 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
27675 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
27676
27677
27678
27679
27680 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
27681 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
27682 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
27683 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
27684 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
27685 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
27686 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
27687 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
27688 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
27689 lists.
27690
27691 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
27692 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
27693 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
27694 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
27695 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
27696 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
27697 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
27698 .code
27699 reject message = \
27700 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
27701 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
27702 dnslists = \
27703 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
27704 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27705 .endd
27706 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
27707 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
27708 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
27709 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
27710 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
27711 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
27712
27713 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
27714 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
27715 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
27716 .code
27717 reject dnslists = \
27718 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
27719 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
27720 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
27721 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27722 .endd
27723 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
27724 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
27725 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
27726
27727
27728
27729 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
27730 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
27731 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
27732 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
27733 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
27734 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
27735 .code
27736 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
27737 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27738 .endd
27739 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
27740 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
27741 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
27742 .code
27743 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
27744 .endd
27745 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
27746 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
27747
27748 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
27749 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
27750 .code
27751 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
27752 dnslists = some.list.example
27753 .endd
27754
27755 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
27756 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
27757 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
27758 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
27759 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
27760 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
27761 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
27762 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
27763 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
27764 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
27765 .display
27766 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
27767 .endd
27768 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
27769 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
27770
27771 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
27772 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
27773 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
27774 of &'p'&.
27775
27776 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
27777 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
27778 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
27779 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
27780 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
27781 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
27782 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
27783 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
27784 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
27785
27786 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
27787 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
27788 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
27789 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
27790
27791 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
27792 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
27793 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
27794 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
27795 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
27796 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
27797 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
27798 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
27799 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
27800 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
27801
27802 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
27803 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
27804 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
27805 ACL.
27806
27807 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
27808 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
27809 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
27810 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
27811 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
27812 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
27813
27814 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
27815 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
27816 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
27817 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
27818 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
27819 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
27820 the &%count=%& option.
27821
27822
27823 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
27824 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
27825 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
27826 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
27827 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
27828
27829 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
27830 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
27831 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
27832 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
27833
27834 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
27835 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
27836 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
27837 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
27838 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
27839 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
27840 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
27841
27842 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
27843 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27844 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
27845 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
27846 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
27847 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
27848 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
27849
27850 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
27851 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
27852 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
27853 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
27854 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
27855
27856 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
27857 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
27858 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
27859 multiple different commands.
27860
27861 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
27862 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
27863 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
27864 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
27865 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
27866
27867 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
27868
27869
27870 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
27871 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
27872 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
27873 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
27874 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
27875
27876 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
27877 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
27878
27879 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
27880 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
27881 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
27882 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
27883 new rate.
27884 .code
27885 acl_check_connect:
27886 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
27887 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27888 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27889 # ...
27890 acl_check_mail:
27891 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
27892 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27893 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27894 .endd
27895
27896 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
27897 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
27898 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
27899 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
27900 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
27901 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
27902 checks.
27903
27904 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
27905 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
27906 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
27907 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
27908 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
27909
27910
27911 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
27912 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
27913 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
27914 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
27915 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
27916 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
27917 rest of the ACL.
27918
27919 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
27920 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
27921 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
27922 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
27923 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
27924 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
27925 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
27926 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
27927 from getting any email through.
27928
27929 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
27930 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
27931 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
27932 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
27933 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
27934 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
27935 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
27936 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
27937 .code
27938 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
27939 .endd
27940
27941
27942 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
27943 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
27944 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
27945 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
27946 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
27947 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
27948 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
27949 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
27950 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
27951
27952 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
27953 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
27954 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
27955 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
27956 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
27957 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
27958
27959 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
27960 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
27961 rate.
27962
27963 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
27964 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
27965 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
27966 required increases with larger limits.
27967
27968 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
27969 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
27970 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
27971 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
27972 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
27973 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
27974 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
27975 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
27976 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
27977 as intended.
27978
27979
27980 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
27981 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
27982 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
27983 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
27984 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
27985 message. For example:
27986 .code
27987 # Log all senders' rates
27988 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
27989 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
27990
27991 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
27992 # at the decimal point.
27993 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
27994 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
27995 $sender_rate_limit }s
27996
27997 # Keep authenticated users under control
27998 deny authenticated = *
27999 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28000
28001 # System-wide rate limit
28002 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28003 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28004
28005 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28006 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28007 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28008 messages per $sender_rate_period
28009 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28010 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28011 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28012 .endd
28013 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28014 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28015 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28016 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28017 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28018 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28019 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28020
28021
28022
28023 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28024 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28025 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28026 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28027 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28028 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28029 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28030 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28031 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28032 .code
28033 verify = sender/callout
28034 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28035 .endd
28036 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28037 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28038 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28039 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28040 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28041 The available options are as follows:
28042
28043 .ilist
28044 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28045 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28046 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28047 .next
28048 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28049 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28050 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28051 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28052 .next
28053 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28054 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28055 .next
28056 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28057 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28058 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28059 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28060 .endlist
28061
28062 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28063 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28064 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28065 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28066 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28067 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28068 coding like this:
28069 .code
28070 warn !verify = sender
28071 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28072 .endd
28073 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28074 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28075 verification failure.
28076
28077 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28078 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28079
28080 .ilist
28081 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28082 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28083 .next
28084 &%route%&: Routing failed.
28085 .next
28086 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28087 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28088 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28089 .next
28090 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28091 .next
28092 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28093 .endlist
28094
28095 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28096 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28097
28098
28099
28100
28101 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28102 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28103 .cindex "callout" "verification"
28104 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28105 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28106 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28107 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28108 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28109 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28110 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28111 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28112 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28113 sender's domain.
28114
28115 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28116 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28117 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
28118 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
28119 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
28120 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
28121
28122 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
28123 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
28124 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
28125 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
28126 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
28127
28128 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
28129 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
28130 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
28131 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
28132 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
28133 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
28134 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
28135 supplies a host list.
28136
28137 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
28138 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
28139 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
28140 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
28141 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
28142 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
28143 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
28144
28145 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
28146 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
28147 following SMTP commands are sent:
28148 .display
28149 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
28150 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
28151 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
28152 &`QUIT`&
28153 .endd
28154 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
28155 set to &"lmtp"&.
28156
28157 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
28158 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
28159 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
28160 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
28161 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
28162 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
28163
28164 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
28165 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
28166 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
28167 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
28168 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
28169
28170 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28171 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
28172 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
28173 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28174 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28175
28176
28177
28178
28179 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28180 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28181 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28182 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28183 .code
28184 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
28185 .endd
28186 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
28187 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
28188 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
28189
28190
28191 .vlist
28192 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
28193 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
28194 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
28195 For example:
28196 .code
28197 verify = sender/callout=5s
28198 .endd
28199 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
28200 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
28201 the &%connect%& parameter.
28202
28203
28204 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28205 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
28206 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
28207 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
28208 .code
28209 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
28210 .endd
28211 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
28212
28213 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
28214 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
28215 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
28216 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
28217 updated in this circumstance.
28218
28219 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
28220 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
28221 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
28222 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
28223 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
28224 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
28225
28226
28227 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28228 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
28229 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
28230 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
28231 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
28232 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
28233 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
28234 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
28235 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
28236 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
28237 .code
28238 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
28239 .endd
28240 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
28241
28242
28243 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28244 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
28245 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
28246 For example:
28247 .code
28248 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
28249 .endd
28250 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
28251 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
28252 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
28253 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
28254 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
28255
28256
28257 .vitem &*no_cache*&
28258 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
28259 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
28260 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
28261
28262 .vitem &*postmaster*&
28263 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
28264 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
28265 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
28266 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
28267 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
28268 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
28269 made, until the cache record expires.
28270
28271 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28272 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
28273 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
28274 For example:
28275 .code
28276 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
28277 .endd
28278 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
28279 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
28280 .code
28281 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
28282 .endd
28283 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
28284 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
28285 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
28286 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
28287
28288
28289 .vitem &*random*&
28290 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
28291 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
28292 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
28293 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
28294 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
28295 .code
28296 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
28297 .endd
28298 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
28299 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
28300 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
28301 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
28302 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
28303
28304 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
28305 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
28306 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28307 .code
28308 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
28309 .endd
28310 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
28311 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
28312 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
28313 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
28314 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
28315
28316 .vitem &*use_sender*&
28317 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28318 .code
28319 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
28320 .endd
28321 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
28322 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
28323 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
28324 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
28325 usefulness of callout caching.
28326 .endlist
28327
28328 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
28329 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
28330 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
28331 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
28332 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
28333 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
28334 these circumstances.
28335
28336 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
28337 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
28338 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
28339 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
28340 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
28341 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
28342 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
28343
28344 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
28345 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
28346 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
28347 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
28348
28349
28350
28351
28352 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
28353 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
28354 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
28355 .cindex "caching" "callout"
28356 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
28357 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
28358 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
28359 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
28360 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
28361 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
28362
28363 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
28364 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
28365 is not available.
28366
28367 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
28368 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
28369 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
28370
28371 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
28372 commands up to and including
28373 .code
28374 MAIL FROM:<>
28375 .endd
28376 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
28377 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
28378 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
28379 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
28380 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
28381 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
28382 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
28383
28384 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
28385 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
28386 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
28387 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
28388 will eventually be noticed.
28389
28390 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
28391 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
28392 behaviour will be the same.
28393
28394
28395
28396 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
28397 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
28398 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
28399 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
28400 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
28401 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
28402 you might see:
28403 .code
28404 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
28405 250 OK
28406 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
28407 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
28408 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
28409 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
28410 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
28411 550 Sender verification failed
28412 .endd
28413 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
28414 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
28415 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
28416 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
28417 example:
28418 .code
28419 verify = sender/no_details
28420 .endd
28421
28422 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
28423 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
28424 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
28425 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
28426 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
28427 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
28428 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
28429
28430 .ilist
28431 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
28432 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
28433 verification also fails.
28434 .next
28435 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
28436 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
28437 .endlist
28438
28439 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
28440 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
28441 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
28442 .code
28443 A.Wol: aw123
28444 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
28445 .endd
28446 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
28447 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
28448 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
28449 verification to succeed.
28450
28451 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
28452 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
28453 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
28454 option. For example:
28455 .code
28456 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
28457 .endd
28458 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
28459 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
28460
28461 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
28462 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
28463 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
28464 address and a report is output for each of them.
28465
28466
28467
28468 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
28469 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
28470 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
28471 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
28472 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
28473 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
28474 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
28475 .code
28476 verify = csa
28477 .endd
28478 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
28479 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
28480 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
28481 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
28482 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
28483 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
28484
28485 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
28486 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
28487 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
28488 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
28489
28490 .ilist
28491 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
28492 .next
28493 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
28494 .next
28495 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
28496 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
28497 .next
28498 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
28499 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
28500 .endlist
28501
28502 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
28503 use for the DNS query. The default is:
28504 .code
28505 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
28506 .endd
28507 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
28508 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
28509 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
28510 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
28511 meaningful to say:
28512 .code
28513 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
28514 .endd
28515 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
28516 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
28517 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
28518
28519 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
28520 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
28521 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
28522 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
28523 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
28524 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
28525 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
28526 of legitimate HELO domains.
28527
28528 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
28529 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
28530 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
28531 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
28532 lookup such as:
28533 .code
28534 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
28535 .endd
28536 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
28537 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
28538 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
28539
28540
28541
28542
28543 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
28544 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
28545 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
28546 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
28547 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
28548 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
28549 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
28550 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
28551
28552 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
28553 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
28554 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
28555 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
28556 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
28557 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
28558 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
28559
28560 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
28561 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
28562 like this:
28563 .code
28564 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
28565 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
28566 }{$value}}
28567 .endd
28568 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
28569 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
28570 use this:
28571 .code
28572 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
28573 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
28574 senders = :
28575 recipients = +batv_senders
28576
28577 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
28578 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
28579 senders = :
28580 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
28581 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
28582 !condition = $prvscheck_result
28583 .endd
28584 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
28585 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
28586 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
28587 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
28588 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
28589
28590 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
28591 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
28592 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
28593 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
28594 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
28595 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
28596 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
28597
28598 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
28599 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
28600 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
28601 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
28602 .code
28603 batv_redirect:
28604 driver = redirect
28605 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
28606 .endd
28607 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
28608 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
28609 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
28610 local addresses.
28611
28612 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
28613 can be used:
28614 .code
28615 external_smtp_batv:
28616 driver = smtp
28617 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
28618 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
28619 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
28620 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
28621 {$value}fail}}}
28622 .endd
28623 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
28624
28625
28626
28627 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
28628 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
28629 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
28630 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
28631 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
28632 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
28633 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
28634 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
28635 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
28636 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
28637
28638 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
28639 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
28640 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
28641 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
28642 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
28643 same host is fulfilling both functions,
28644 . ///
28645 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
28646 . ///
28647 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
28648 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
28649 system to arbitrary domains.
28650
28651
28652 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
28653 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
28654 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
28655 example, suppose you want to do the following:
28656
28657 .ilist
28658 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
28659 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
28660 &'my.dom2.example'&.
28661 .next
28662 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
28663 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
28664 .next
28665 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
28666 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
28667 .endlist
28668
28669
28670 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
28671 .code
28672 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
28673 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
28674 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
28675 .endd
28676 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
28677 command:
28678 .code
28679 acl_check_rcpt:
28680 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
28681 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
28682 .endd
28683 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
28684 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
28685 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
28686 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
28687 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
28688 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
28689 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28690
28691
28692
28693 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
28694 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
28695 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
28696 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
28697 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28698
28699 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
28700 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
28701 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
28702 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
28703 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
28704 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
28705 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
28706 .ecindex IIDacl
28707
28708
28709
28710 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28712
28713 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
28714 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
28715 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
28716 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
28717 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
28718 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
28719 specification.
28720
28721 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
28722 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
28723 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
28724 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
28725 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
28726
28727 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
28728 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
28729 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
28730
28731 .ilist
28732 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
28733 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
28734 .next
28735 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
28736 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
28737 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
28738 .next
28739 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
28740 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
28741 .next
28742 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
28743 conditions.
28744 .next
28745 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
28746 .endlist
28747
28748 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
28749 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
28750 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
28751
28752 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
28753 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
28754 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
28755 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
28756 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
28757 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
28758
28759 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
28760 temporarily created in a file called:
28761 .display
28762 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
28763 .endd
28764 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
28765 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
28766 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
28767 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
28768 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
28769 .code
28770 control = no_mbox_unspool
28771 .endd
28772 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
28773 same directory by default.
28774
28775
28776
28777 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
28778 .cindex "virus scanning"
28779 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
28780 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
28781 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
28782 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
28783 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
28784 in memory and thus are much faster.
28785
28786
28787 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
28788 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
28789 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
28790 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
28791 .display
28792 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
28793 .endd
28794 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
28795 .code
28796 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
28797 .endd
28798 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
28799 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
28800
28801 .vlist
28802 .vitem &%aveserver%&
28803 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28804 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
28805 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
28806 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
28807 example:
28808 .code
28809 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
28810 .endd
28811
28812
28813 .vitem &%clamd%&
28814 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
28815 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
28816 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
28817 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
28818 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
28819 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
28820 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
28821 .code
28822 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
28823 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
28824 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
28825 .endd
28826 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
28827 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
28828 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
28829 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
28830 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
28831 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
28832 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
28833 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
28834 contributing the code for this scanner.
28835
28836 .vitem &%cmdline%&
28837 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
28838 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
28839 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
28840 type takes 3 mandatory options:
28841
28842 .olist
28843 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
28844 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
28845
28846 .next
28847 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
28848 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
28849 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
28850 the &"trigger"& expression.
28851
28852 .next
28853 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
28854 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
28855 &"name"& expression.
28856 .endlist olist
28857
28858 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
28859 .code
28860 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
28861 .endd
28862 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
28863 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
28864 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
28865 configuration setting:
28866 .code
28867 av_scanner = cmdline:\
28868 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
28869 found in file:'(.+)'
28870 .endd
28871 .vitem &%drweb%&
28872 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
28873 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
28874 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
28875 separated by white space, as in these examples:
28876 .code
28877 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
28878 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
28879 .endd
28880 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
28881 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
28882
28883 .vitem &%fsecure%&
28884 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
28885 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
28886 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
28887 .code
28888 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
28889 .endd
28890 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
28891 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
28892
28893 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
28894 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28895 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
28896 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
28897 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
28898 For example:
28899 .code
28900 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
28901 .endd
28902 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
28903
28904 .vitem &%mksd%&
28905 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
28906 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
28907 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
28908 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
28909 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
28910 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
28911 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
28912 .code
28913 av_scanner = mksd:2
28914 .endd
28915 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
28916
28917 .vitem &%sophie%&
28918 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
28919 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
28920 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
28921 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
28922 client communication. For example:
28923 .code
28924 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
28925 .endd
28926 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
28927 the option.
28928 .endlist
28929
28930 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
28931 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
28932 ACL.
28933
28934 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
28935 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
28936 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
28937 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
28938 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
28939 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
28940 message.
28941
28942 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
28943 use. It can then be one of
28944
28945 .ilist
28946 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
28947 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
28948 recommended usage.
28949 .next
28950 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
28951 the condition fails immediately.
28952 .next
28953 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
28954 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
28955 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
28956 .endlist
28957
28958 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
28959 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
28960 causes the ACL to defer.
28961
28962 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
28963 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
28964 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
28965 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
28966 logging data.
28967
28968 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
28969 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
28970 &%malware%& condition.
28971
28972 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
28973 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
28974
28975 Here is a very simple scanning example:
28976 .code
28977 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28978 demime = *
28979 malware = *
28980 .endd
28981 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
28982 .code
28983 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28984 demime = *
28985 malware = */defer_ok
28986 .endd
28987 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
28988 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
28989 .code
28990 av_scanner = $acl_m0
28991 .endd
28992 in the main Exim configuration.
28993 .code
28994 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28995 set acl_m0 = sophie
28996 malware = *
28997
28998 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28999 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29000 malware = *
29001 .endd
29002
29003
29004 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29005 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29006 .cindex "spam scanning"
29007 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29008 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29009 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29010 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29011 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29012 .code
29013 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29014 .endd
29015 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29016 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29017 nicely, however.
29018
29019 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29020 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29021 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29022 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29023 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29024 .code
29025 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29026 .endd
29027 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29028 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29029 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29030 address/port pair:
29031 .code
29032 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29033 .endd
29034 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29035 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29036 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29037 option, separated with colons:
29038 .code
29039 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29040 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29041 192.168.2.12 783
29042 .endd
29043 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29044 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29045 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29046 condition defers.
29047
29048 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29049 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29050
29051 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29052 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29053 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29054 expansion.
29055
29056 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29057 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29058 .code
29059 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29060 spam = joe
29061 .endd
29062 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29063 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29064 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29065 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29066 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29067
29068 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29069 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29070 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29071 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29072 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29073 are not set.
29074
29075 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29076 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29077 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29078
29079
29080 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29081 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29082 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29083 example:
29084 .code
29085 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29086 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29087 spam = nobody
29088 .endd
29089
29090 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29091 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
29092 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
29093 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
29094
29095 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
29096 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
29097 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
29098 available for use at delivery time.
29099
29100 .vlist
29101 .vitem &$spam_score$&
29102 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
29103 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
29104
29105 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
29106 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
29107 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
29108 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
29109 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
29110
29111 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
29112 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
29113 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
29114 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
29115 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
29116
29117 .vitem &$spam_report$&
29118 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
29119 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
29120 .endlist
29121
29122 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
29123 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
29124 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
29125
29126 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
29127 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
29128 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
29129 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
29130 spam condition, like this:
29131 .code
29132 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29133 spam = joe/defer_ok
29134 .endd
29135 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
29136
29137 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
29138 condition:
29139 .code
29140 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
29141 warn spam = nobody:true
29142 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
29143 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
29144
29145 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
29146 # is over threshold
29147 warn spam = nobody
29148 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
29149
29150 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
29151 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
29152 spam = nobody:true
29153 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
29154 .endd
29155
29156
29157
29158 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
29159 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
29160 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29161 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
29162 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
29163 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
29164 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
29165 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
29166 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
29167 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
29168 cases.
29169
29170 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
29171 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
29172 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
29173 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29174 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29175 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29176 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29177
29178 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29179 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29180 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29181 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29182 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29183
29184 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
29185 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
29186 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
29187 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
29188 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
29189 syntax is:
29190 .display
29191 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
29192 .endd
29193 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
29194 the value can be:
29195
29196 .olist
29197 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
29198 .next
29199 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
29200 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
29201 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
29202 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
29203 .next
29204 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
29205 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
29206 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
29207 the full path and file name.
29208 .next
29209 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
29210 filename, and the default path is then used.
29211 .endlist
29212 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
29213 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
29214 a file with its original, proposed filename using
29215 .code
29216 decode = $mime_filename
29217 .endd
29218 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
29219 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
29220 automatically unlinked.
29221
29222 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
29223 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
29224 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
29225 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
29226 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
29227
29228 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
29229 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
29230 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
29231
29232 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
29233 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
29234 available in the MIME ACL:
29235
29236 .vlist
29237 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
29238 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
29239 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
29240 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
29241 contains the empty string.
29242
29243 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
29244 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
29245 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
29246 .code
29247 us-ascii
29248 gb2312 (Chinese)
29249 iso-8859-1
29250 .endd
29251 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
29252 case-insensitively.
29253
29254 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
29255 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
29256 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
29257 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
29258 only used for display purposes.
29259
29260 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
29261 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
29262 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
29263
29264 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
29265 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
29266 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
29267
29268 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
29269 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29270 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
29271 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
29272 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
29273
29274 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
29275 This variable contains the normalized content of the
29276 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
29277 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
29278
29279 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
29280 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
29281 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
29282 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
29283 .code
29284 text/plain
29285 text/html
29286 application/octet-stream
29287 image/jpeg
29288 audio/midi
29289 .endd
29290 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
29291 empty string.
29292
29293 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
29294 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29295 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
29296 containing the decoded data.
29297 .endlist
29298
29299 .cindex "RFC 2047"
29300 .vlist
29301 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
29302 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
29303 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
29304 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
29305 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
29306 found, this variable contains the empty string.
29307
29308 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
29309 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
29310 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
29311 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
29312
29313 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
29314 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
29315 follows:
29316
29317 .olist
29318 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
29319
29320 .next
29321 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
29322 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
29323
29324 .next
29325 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
29326 and the rest are attachments.
29327
29328 .next
29329 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
29330 .endlist olist
29331
29332 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
29333 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
29334 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
29335 .code
29336 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
29337 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
29338 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
29339 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
29340 .endd
29341 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
29342 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
29343 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
29344 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
29345 want to carry out specific actions on them.
29346
29347 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
29348 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
29349 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
29350 decoding is fully recursive.
29351
29352 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
29353 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
29354 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
29355 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
29356 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
29357 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
29358 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
29359 .endlist
29360
29361
29362
29363 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
29364 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
29365 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
29366 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
29367 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
29368
29369 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
29370 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
29371 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
29372 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
29373 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
29374
29375 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
29376 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
29377 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
29378 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
29379 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
29380 32K characters are checked.
29381
29382 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
29383 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
29384 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
29385 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
29386 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
29387 .code
29388 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
29389 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
29390 .endd
29391 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
29392 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
29393 matching regular expression.
29394
29395 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
29396 CPU-intensive.
29397
29398
29399
29400
29401 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
29402 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
29403 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29404 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
29405 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
29406 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
29407 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
29408 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
29409 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
29410 use the &%demime%& condition.
29411
29412 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
29413 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
29414 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
29415 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
29416 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
29417 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
29418
29419 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
29420 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
29421 example:
29422 .code
29423 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
29424 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
29425 .endd
29426 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
29427 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
29428 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
29429 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
29430
29431 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
29432 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
29433 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
29434
29435 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
29436
29437 .vlist
29438 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
29439 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
29440 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
29441 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
29442 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
29443 zero, no error occurred.
29444
29445 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
29446 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
29447 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
29448 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
29449 .endlist
29450
29451 .vlist
29452 .vitem &$found_extension$&
29453 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
29454 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
29455 extension it found.
29456 .endlist
29457
29458 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
29459 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
29460
29461 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
29462 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
29463 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
29464 facility:
29465 .code
29466 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
29467 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
29468 demime = *
29469 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
29470
29471 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
29472 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
29473 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
29474 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
29475
29476 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
29477 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
29478 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
29479 demime = exe:doc
29480 control = freeze
29481 .endd
29482 .ecindex IIDcosca
29483
29484
29485
29486
29487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29489
29490 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
29491 "Local scan function"
29492 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
29493 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
29494 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
29495 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
29496 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
29497
29498 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
29499 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
29500 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
29501 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
29502 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
29503
29504 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
29505 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
29506 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
29507 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
29508
29509 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
29510 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
29511 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
29512 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
29513
29514 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
29515 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
29516 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
29517 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
29518 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
29519 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
29520 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
29521 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
29522 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
29523
29524
29525
29526 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
29527 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
29528 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
29529 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
29530 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
29531 directory, so you might set
29532 .code
29533 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
29534 .endd
29535 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
29536 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
29537 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
29538 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
29539 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
29540 _src/local_scan.c_.
29541
29542 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
29543 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
29544 .code
29545 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29546 .endd
29547 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
29548
29549
29550
29551
29552 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
29553 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
29554 You must include this line near the start of your code:
29555 .code
29556 #include "local_scan.h"
29557 .endd
29558 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
29559 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
29560 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
29561 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
29562 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
29563 strings and pointers to character strings:
29564 .code
29565 #define CS (char *)
29566 #define CCS (const char *)
29567 #define CSS (char **)
29568 #define US (unsigned char *)
29569 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
29570 #define USS (unsigned char **)
29571 .endd
29572 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
29573 .code
29574 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
29575 .endd
29576 The arguments are as follows:
29577
29578 .ilist
29579 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
29580 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
29581 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
29582
29583 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
29584 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
29585 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
29586 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
29587 case this changes in some future version.
29588 .next
29589 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
29590 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
29591 .endlist
29592
29593 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
29594
29595 .vlist
29596 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
29597 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
29598 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
29599 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
29600 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
29601 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
29602
29603 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
29604 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29605 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
29606
29607 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
29608 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29609 queued without immediate delivery.
29610
29611 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
29612 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
29613 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
29614 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
29615 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
29616 used.
29617
29618 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
29619 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
29620 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
29621 problem"& is used.
29622
29623 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29624 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
29625 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
29626 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
29627 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
29628 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
29629 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29630
29631 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29632 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
29633 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29634 .endlist
29635
29636 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
29637 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
29638 &%-oe%& command line options.
29639
29640
29641
29642 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
29643 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
29644 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
29645 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
29646 want to do this, you must have the line
29647 .code
29648 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29649 .endd
29650 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
29651 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
29652 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
29653 to define them.
29654
29655 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
29656 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
29657 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
29658 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
29659 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
29660 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
29661 .code
29662 static int my_integer_option = 42;
29663 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
29664
29665 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
29666 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
29667 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
29668 };
29669
29670 int local_scan_options_count =
29671 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
29672 .endd
29673 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
29674 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
29675 .code
29676 begin local_scan
29677 my_integer = 99
29678 my_string = some string of text...
29679 .endd
29680 The available types of option data are as follows:
29681
29682 .vlist
29683 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
29684 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
29685 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
29686 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
29687 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
29688 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
29689 values.)
29690
29691 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
29692 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
29693 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
29694 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
29695
29696 .vitem &*opt_int*&
29697 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
29698 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
29699 Exim.
29700
29701 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
29702 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
29703 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
29704 printed with the suffix K or M.
29705
29706 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
29707 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
29708 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
29709 always output in octal.
29710
29711 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
29712 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
29713 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
29714
29715 .vitem &*opt_time*&
29716 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
29717 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
29718 .endlist
29719
29720 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
29721 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
29722
29723
29724
29725 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
29726 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
29727 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
29728 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
29729 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
29730 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
29731 C variables are as follows:
29732
29733 .vlist
29734 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
29735 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
29736
29737 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
29738 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
29739
29740 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
29741 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
29742 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
29743 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
29744
29745 .ilist
29746 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
29747 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
29748 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
29749
29750 .next
29751 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
29752 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
29753 of debugging bits.
29754 .endlist ilist
29755
29756 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
29757 selected, you should use code like this:
29758 .code
29759 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29760 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29761 .endd
29762 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
29763 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
29764 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
29765
29766 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
29767 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
29768 discussed below.
29769
29770 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
29771 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
29772
29773 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
29774 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
29775
29776 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
29777 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
29778 &%-bh%& command line option.
29779
29780 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
29781 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
29782 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
29783
29784 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
29785 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
29786 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
29787 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
29788
29789 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
29790 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
29791 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
29792
29793 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
29794 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
29795
29796 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
29797 The number of accepted recipients.
29798
29799 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
29800 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
29801 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
29802 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
29803 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
29804 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
29805 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
29806 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
29807 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
29808 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
29809 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
29810 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
29811
29812 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
29813 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
29814
29815 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
29816 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
29817 locally-submitted messages.
29818
29819 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
29820 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
29821 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
29822
29823 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
29824 The name of the sending host, if known.
29825
29826 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
29827 The port on the sending host.
29828
29829 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
29830 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
29831
29832 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
29833 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
29834
29835 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
29836 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
29837 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
29838 .endlist
29839
29840
29841 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
29842 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
29843 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
29844 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
29845 their type to *.
29846
29847
29848 .vlist
29849 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
29850 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
29851
29852 .vitem &*int&~type*&
29853 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
29854 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
29855 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
29856 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
29857 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
29858 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
29859
29860 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
29861 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
29862 internal newlines.
29863
29864 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
29865 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
29866 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
29867 .endlist
29868
29869
29870
29871 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
29872 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
29873
29874 .vlist
29875 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
29876 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
29877
29878 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
29879 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
29880 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
29881 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
29882
29883 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
29884 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
29885 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
29886 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
29887 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
29888 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
29889 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
29890 is NULL for all recipients.
29891 .endlist
29892
29893
29894
29895 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
29896 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
29897 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
29898 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
29899 release:
29900
29901 .vlist
29902 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
29903 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
29904
29905 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
29906 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
29907 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
29908 for the process in &%newumask%&.
29909
29910 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
29911 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
29912 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
29913 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
29914 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
29915
29916 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
29917
29918 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
29919 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
29920 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
29921 return value is as follows:
29922
29923 .ilist
29924 >= 0
29925
29926 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
29927 ending status.
29928
29929 .next
29930 < 0 and > &--256
29931
29932 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
29933 signal number.
29934
29935 .next
29936 &--256
29937
29938 The process timed out.
29939 .next
29940 &--257
29941
29942 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
29943 .endlist
29944
29945 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
29946 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
29947 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
29948 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
29949 forks a subprocess that is running
29950 .code
29951 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
29952 .endd
29953 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
29954 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
29955 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
29956 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
29957
29958 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
29959 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
29960 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
29961 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
29962
29963
29964 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
29965 *sender_authentication)*&
29966 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
29967 that it runs is:
29968 .display
29969 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
29970 .endd
29971 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
29972
29973
29974 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29975 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
29976 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
29977 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
29978 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
29979 .code
29980 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29981 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29982 .endd
29983
29984 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
29985 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
29986 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
29987 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
29988 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
29989 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
29990 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
29991 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
29992
29993 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
29994 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
29995 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
29996 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
29997 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29998 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29999
30000 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30001 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30002 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30003 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30004
30005 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30006 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30007 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30008 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30009 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30010 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30011 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30012 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30013 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30014 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30015 .code
30016 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30017 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30018 .endd
30019 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30020 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30021
30022
30023 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30024 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30025 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30026 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30027 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30028
30029
30030 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30031 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30032 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30033 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30034 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30035 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30036 .code
30037 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30038 .endd
30039 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30040 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30041 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30042 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30043 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30044 zero-terminated.
30045
30046 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30047 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30048 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30049 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30050 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30051 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30052 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30053 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30054
30055 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30056 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30057 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30058 .display
30059 &`OK `& match succeeded
30060 &`FAIL `& match failed
30061 &`DEFER `& match deferred
30062 .endd
30063 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30064 inability to contact a database.
30065
30066 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30067 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30068 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30069 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30070 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30071
30072 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30073 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30074 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30075 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30076 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30077
30078 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30079 uschar&~*list)*&"
30080 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30081 expected to be
30082 .code
30083 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30084 .endd
30085 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30086 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30087 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30088 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30089 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30090 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30091 failed.
30092
30093 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
30094 *format,&~...)*&"
30095 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
30096 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
30097 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
30098 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
30099 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
30100 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
30101
30102
30103 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
30104 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
30105 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
30106 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
30107
30108 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
30109 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
30110 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
30111 value afterwards. For example:
30112 .code
30113 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
30114 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
30115 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
30116 .endd
30117
30118 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
30119 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
30120 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
30121 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
30122 address.
30123 .endlist
30124
30125
30126 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30127 .vlist
30128 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
30129 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
30130 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
30131 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
30132 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
30133 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
30134 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
30135 binary string is returned with an error message.
30136
30137 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
30138 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
30139 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
30140
30141 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
30142 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
30143 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
30144 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
30145 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
30146
30147 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
30148 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
30149 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
30150
30151 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
30152 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
30153 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
30154 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
30155 with translation.
30156
30157
30158 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
30159 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
30160 below.
30161
30162 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30163 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
30164 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
30165 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
30166 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
30167 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
30168 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
30169 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
30170 is involved.
30171
30172 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
30173 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30174
30175 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30176 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30177 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30178 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30179 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30180 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30181 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30182 .code
30183 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30184 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
30185 .endd
30186 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
30187 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
30188 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
30189 multiple output lines.
30190
30191 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
30192 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
30193 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
30194 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
30195 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
30196 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
30197 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
30198 is an error.
30199
30200 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
30201 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
30202 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
30203 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30204
30205 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
30206 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
30207 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30208
30209 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
30210 See below.
30211
30212 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
30213 See below.
30214
30215 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
30216 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
30217 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
30218 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
30219 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
30220 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
30221 more discussion.
30222 .endlist
30223
30224
30225
30226 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
30227 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
30228 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
30229 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
30230 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
30231 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
30232 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
30233 terminates.
30234
30235 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
30236 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
30237 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
30238 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
30239
30240 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
30241 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
30242 .code
30243 store_pool = POOL_PERM
30244 .endd
30245 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
30246 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
30247 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
30248 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
30249
30250 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
30251 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
30252 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
30253 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
30254 &%store_pool%&.
30255 .ecindex IIDlosca
30256
30257
30258
30259
30260 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30261 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30262
30263 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
30264 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
30265 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
30266 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
30267 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
30268 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
30269 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
30270 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
30271
30272 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
30273 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
30274 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
30275 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
30276 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
30277
30278 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
30279 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
30280 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
30281 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
30282 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
30283 prevent it happening on retries.
30284
30285 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30286 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30287 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
30288 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
30289 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
30290 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
30291 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
30292 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
30293
30294
30295 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
30296 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
30297 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
30298 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
30299 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
30300 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
30301 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
30302 .code
30303 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
30304 system_filter_user = exim
30305 .endd
30306 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
30307 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
30308 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
30309 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
30310 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
30311 by the &%reply%& command.
30312
30313
30314 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
30315 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
30316 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
30317 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
30318
30319 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
30320 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
30321
30322
30323
30324 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
30325 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
30326 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
30327 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
30328 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
30329 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
30330 they cause errors.
30331
30332 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
30333 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
30334 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
30335 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
30336 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
30337 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
30338 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
30339
30340 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
30341 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
30342 succeed, it will not be tried again.
30343 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
30344 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
30345
30346 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
30347 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
30348 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
30349 to which users' filter files can refer.
30350
30351
30352
30353 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
30354 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
30355 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
30356 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
30357 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
30358
30359
30360
30361 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
30362 .cindex "freezing messages"
30363 .cindex "message" "freezing"
30364 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
30365 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
30366 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
30367 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
30368 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
30369 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
30370 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
30371 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
30372 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
30373 .code
30374 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
30375 .endd
30376 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
30377
30378 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
30379 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
30380 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
30381 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
30382 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
30383 run.
30384
30385 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
30386 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
30387 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
30388 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
30389
30390 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
30391 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
30392 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
30393 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
30394 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
30395 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
30396 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
30397 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
30398 message. For example:
30399 .code
30400 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
30401 because it contains attachments that we are \
30402 not prepared to receive."
30403 .endd
30404
30405 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
30406 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
30407 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
30408 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
30409 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
30410 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
30411 use, for example
30412 .code
30413 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
30414 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
30415 .endd
30416 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
30417 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
30418 generated by the filter.
30419
30420 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
30421 &%defer%&,
30422 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
30423 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
30424 as
30425 .code
30426 mail ...
30427 freeze
30428 .endd
30429 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
30430 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
30431 take place.
30432
30433
30434
30435 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
30436 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
30437 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
30438 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
30439 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
30440 .code
30441 headers add <string>
30442 headers remove <string>
30443 .endd
30444 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
30445 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
30446 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
30447 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
30448 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
30449
30450 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
30451 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
30452 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
30453 example:
30454 .code
30455 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
30456 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
30457 X-header-2: ...."
30458 .endd
30459 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
30460 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
30461 space after input continuations is ignored.
30462
30463 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
30464 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
30465 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
30466 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
30467 header with the same name, they are all removed.
30468
30469 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
30470 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
30471 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
30472 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
30473 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
30474 used for all recipients of the message.
30475
30476 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
30477 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
30478 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
30479 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
30480 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
30481 until the message is actually being written (see section
30482 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
30483
30484 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
30485 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
30486 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
30487 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
30488 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
30489 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
30490 modified more than once.
30491
30492 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
30493 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
30494 For example:
30495 .code
30496 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
30497 headers remove "Subject"
30498 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
30499 headers remove "Old-Subject"
30500 .endd
30501
30502
30503
30504 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
30505 .cindex "envelope sender"
30506 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
30507 .code
30508 errors_to <some address>
30509 .endd
30510 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
30511 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
30512 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
30513 might use
30514 .code
30515 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
30516 .endd
30517 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
30518 address if its delivery failed.
30519
30520
30521
30522 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
30523 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30524 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30525 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
30526 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
30527 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
30528 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
30529 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
30530 which implements such a filter:
30531 .code
30532 central_filter:
30533 check_local_user
30534 driver = redirect
30535 domains = +local_domains
30536 file = /central/filters/$local_part
30537 no_verify
30538 allow_filter
30539 allow_freeze
30540 .endd
30541 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
30542 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
30543 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
30544 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
30545
30546 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
30547 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
30548 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
30549 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
30550 normal way.
30551 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
30552 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
30553 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
30554
30555
30556
30557
30558
30559
30560 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30562
30563 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
30564 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
30565 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
30566 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
30567 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
30568 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
30569 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
30570 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
30571
30572 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
30573 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
30574 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
30575 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
30576 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
30577
30578 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
30579 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
30580 loopback interface specially in any way.
30581
30582 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
30583 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
30584
30585
30586
30587
30588 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
30589 .cindex "message" "submission"
30590 .cindex "submission mode"
30591 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
30592 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
30593 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
30594 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
30595 .code
30596 control = submission
30597 .endd
30598 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
30599 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
30600 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
30601 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
30602 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
30603 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
30604 .code
30605 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
30606 control = submission
30607 .endd
30608 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
30609 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
30610 is used to separate options. For example:
30611 .code
30612 control = submission/sender_retain
30613 .endd
30614 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
30615 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
30616 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
30617 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
30618 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
30619 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
30620 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
30621
30622 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
30623 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
30624 example:
30625 .code
30626 control = submission/domain=some.domain
30627 .endd
30628 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
30629 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
30630 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
30631 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
30632 .code
30633 accept authenticated = *
30634 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
30635 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
30636 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
30637 .endd
30638 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
30639 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
30640 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
30641 .code
30642 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
30643 .endd
30644 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
30645 line would be:
30646 .code
30647 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
30648 .endd
30649 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
30650 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
30651 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
30652 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
30653
30654 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
30655 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
30656 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
30657 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
30658 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
30659 spoof another's address.
30660
30661 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
30662 .cindex "line endings"
30663 .cindex "carriage return"
30664 .cindex "linefeed"
30665 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
30666 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
30667 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
30668 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
30669 use CRLF or just CR.
30670
30671 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
30672 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
30673 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
30674 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
30675 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
30676 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
30677 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
30678 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
30679 follows:
30680
30681 .ilist
30682 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
30683 .next
30684 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
30685 is ignored.
30686 .next
30687 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
30688 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
30689 terminator.
30690 .next
30691 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
30692 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
30693 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
30694 people trying to play silly games.
30695 .next
30696 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
30697 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
30698 line.
30699 .endlist
30700
30701
30702
30703
30704
30705 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
30706 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
30707 .cindex "address" "qualification"
30708 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
30709 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
30710 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
30711 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
30712 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
30713
30714 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
30715 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
30716 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
30717 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
30718 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
30719
30720 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
30721 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
30722 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
30723 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
30724 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
30725 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
30726 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
30727 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
30728
30729
30730
30731
30732 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
30733 .cindex "&""From""& line"
30734 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
30735 .cindex "sender" "address"
30736 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
30737 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
30738 .cindex "envelope sender"
30739 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30740 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
30741 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
30742 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
30743 .code
30744 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
30745 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
30746 .endd
30747 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
30748 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
30749 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
30750 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
30751 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
30752 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
30753 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
30754 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
30755 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
30756
30757 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
30758 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
30759 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
30760 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
30761 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
30762 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
30763 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
30764
30765 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
30766 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
30767 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
30768
30769 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
30770 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
30771 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
30772 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
30773
30774
30775
30776 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
30777 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
30778 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
30779 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
30780 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
30781 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
30782 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
30783
30784 .blockquote
30785 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
30786 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
30787 .endblockquote
30788
30789 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
30790 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
30791 follows:
30792
30793 .ilist
30794 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
30795 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
30796 .next
30797 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
30798 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
30799 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
30800 .next
30801 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
30802 also removed.
30803 .next
30804 For a locally-submitted message,
30805 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
30806 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
30807 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
30808 included in log lines in this case.
30809 .next
30810 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
30811 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
30812 .endlist
30813
30814
30815
30816
30817 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
30818 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
30819 includes the header line:
30820 .code
30821 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
30822 .endd
30823
30824 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
30825 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
30826 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
30827 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
30828 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
30829 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
30830
30831
30832 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
30833 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
30834 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
30835 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
30836 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
30837
30838 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
30839 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
30840 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
30841 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
30842 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
30843 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
30844 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
30845 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
30846 messages.
30847
30848
30849 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
30850 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
30851 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
30852 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
30853 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
30854 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
30855 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
30856 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
30857 messages.
30858
30859
30860 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
30861 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
30862 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30863 .cindex "message" "submission"
30864 .cindex "submission mode"
30865 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
30866 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
30867
30868 .ilist
30869 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
30870 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
30871 .next
30872 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30873 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
30874 .olist
30875 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30876 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30877 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30878 .next
30879 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
30880 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30881 .next
30882 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30883 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30884 .endlist
30885 .endlist
30886
30887 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
30888
30889 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
30890 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
30891 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
30892 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30893 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
30894 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
30895 &%qualify_domain%&.
30896
30897 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
30898 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
30899 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
30900 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30901
30902
30903 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
30904 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
30905 .cindex "message" "submission"
30906 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
30907 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
30908 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
30909 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
30910 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
30911 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
30912 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
30913 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
30914 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
30915 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
30916
30917
30918 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
30919 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
30920 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
30921 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
30922 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
30923
30924 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
30925 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
30926 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
30927 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
30928
30929 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
30930 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
30931 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
30932
30933
30934 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
30935 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
30936 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
30937 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
30938 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
30939 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
30940 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
30941 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
30942 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
30943 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
30944 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
30945
30946
30947
30948 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
30949 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
30950 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
30951 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
30952 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
30953 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
30954 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
30955 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
30956
30957
30958
30959 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
30960 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
30961 .cindex "message" "submission"
30962 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
30963 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
30964 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
30965 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30966 control setting.
30967
30968 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
30969 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30970 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
30971 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
30972 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
30973 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
30974 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
30975 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
30976 line is added to the message.
30977
30978 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
30979 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
30980 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
30981 options true at the same time.
30982
30983 .cindex "submission mode"
30984 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
30985 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
30986 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
30987 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
30988
30989 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30990 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
30991 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
30992 created as follows:
30993
30994 .ilist
30995 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30996 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30997 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30998 .next
30999 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31000 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31001 .next
31002 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31003 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31004 .endlist
31005
31006 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31007 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31008 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31009 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31010
31011 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31012 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31013 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31014 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31015
31016
31017
31018 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31019 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31020 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31021 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31022 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31023 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31024 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31025 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31026 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31027
31028 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31029 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31030 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31031 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31032 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31033 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31034
31035 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31036 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31037 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31038
31039 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31040 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31041 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31042 .code
31043 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31044 X-added-second: another added header line
31045 .endd
31046 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31047
31048 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31049 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31050 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31051 not part of the names. For example:
31052 .code
31053 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31054 .endd
31055 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31056 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31057 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31058 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31059 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31060
31061 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
31062 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31063 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31064 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31065
31066 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31067 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31068 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31069 requirements.
31070
31071 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31072 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31073 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31074 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31075 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31076 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31077 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31078
31079 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31080 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
31081 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
31082 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
31083
31084 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
31085 the following consequences:
31086
31087 .ilist
31088 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
31089 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
31090 to it, at all times.
31091 .next
31092 Header lines that are added by a router's
31093 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
31094 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
31095 .next
31096 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
31097 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
31098 .next
31099 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
31100 a later router or by a transport.
31101 .next
31102 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
31103 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
31104 .code
31105 headers_remove = subject
31106 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
31107 .endd
31108 .endlist
31109
31110 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
31111 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
31112
31113
31114
31115
31116
31117 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
31118 .cindex "address" "constructed"
31119 .cindex "constructed address"
31120 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
31121 the form
31122 .display
31123 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
31124 .endd
31125 For example:
31126 .code
31127 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
31128 .endd
31129 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
31130 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
31131 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
31132 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
31133 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
31134 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
31135 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
31136 there is no password file entry.
31137
31138 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31139 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
31140 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
31141 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
31142 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
31143 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
31144 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
31145 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
31146 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
31147
31148
31149
31150 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
31151 .cindex "case of local parts"
31152 .cindex "local part" "case of"
31153 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
31154 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
31155 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
31156 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
31157 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
31158 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
31159 router option.
31160
31161 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
31162 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
31163 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
31164 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
31165 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
31166 .code
31167 correct_case:
31168 driver = redirect
31169 domains = +local_domains
31170 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
31171 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31172 @$domain
31173 .endd
31174 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31175 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
31176 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
31177 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
31178 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
31179
31180
31181
31182 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
31183 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
31184 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
31185 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
31186 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
31187 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
31188 empty components for compatibility.
31189
31190
31191
31192 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
31193 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
31194 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
31195 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
31196 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
31197 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
31198
31199 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
31200 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
31201 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
31202 example, a header such as
31203 .code
31204 To: hare@teaparty
31205 .endd
31206 might get rewritten as
31207 .code
31208 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
31209 .endd
31210 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
31211 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
31212 been routed.
31213
31214 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
31215 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
31216 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
31217 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
31218 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
31219 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
31220 .ecindex IIDmesproc
31221
31222
31223
31224 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31225 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31226
31227 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
31228 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
31229 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
31230 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
31231 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
31232 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
31233 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
31234
31235 .ilist
31236 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
31237 .next
31238 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
31239 .next
31240 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
31241 .endlist
31242
31243 For mail delivery, the following are available:
31244
31245 .ilist
31246 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
31247 .next
31248 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
31249 &"lmtp"&);
31250 .next
31251 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
31252 transport);
31253 .next
31254 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
31255 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
31256 .endlist
31257
31258 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
31259 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
31260 used to contain the envelope information.
31261
31262
31263
31264 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
31265 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
31266 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
31267 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
31268 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
31269 .cindex "EHLO"
31270 .cindex "HELO"
31271 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31272 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
31273 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
31274 processing is the same in both cases.
31275
31276 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
31277 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
31278 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
31279 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
31280 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
31281 .cindex "transport" "filter"
31282 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
31283 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
31284 suppressed.
31285
31286 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
31287 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
31288 required for the transaction.
31289
31290 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
31291 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
31292 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
31293
31294 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
31295 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
31296 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
31297
31298 .cindex "carriage return"
31299 .cindex "linefeed"
31300 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31301 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
31302 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31303 line terminator.
31304
31305 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
31306 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
31307 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
31308 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
31309 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
31310 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
31311 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
31312 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
31313 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
31314
31315 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
31316 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
31317 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
31318 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
31319
31320 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
31321 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
31322 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
31323 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
31324
31325 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31326 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
31327 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
31328 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
31329 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
31330 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
31331 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
31332 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
31333 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
31334 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
31335
31336 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
31337 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
31338
31339 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
31340 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
31341 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
31342 square bracket of the IP address.
31343
31344
31345
31346
31347 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
31348 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
31349 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
31350 .cindex "host" "error"
31351 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
31352 message errors, and recipient errors.
31353
31354 .vlist
31355 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
31356 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
31357 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
31358
31359 .ilist
31360 Connection refused or timed out,
31361 .next
31362 Any error response code on connection,
31363 .next
31364 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
31365 .next
31366 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
31367 .next
31368 I/O errors at any time,
31369 .next
31370 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
31371 the &"."& at the end of the data.
31372 .endlist ilist
31373
31374 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
31375 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
31376 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
31377 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
31378 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
31379 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
31380 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
31381 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
31382
31383 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
31384 .cindex "message" "error"
31385 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
31386 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
31387 message errors are:
31388
31389 .ilist
31390 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
31391 the data,
31392 .next
31393 Timeout after MAIL,
31394 .next
31395 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
31396 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
31397 connection at any other time.
31398 .endlist ilist
31399
31400 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
31401 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
31402 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
31403 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
31404 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
31405 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
31406 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
31407 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
31408 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
31409 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
31410
31411 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
31412 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
31413 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
31414 response to MAIL.
31415
31416 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
31417 .cindex "recipient" "error"
31418 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
31419 recipient errors are:
31420
31421 .ilist
31422 Any error response to RCPT,
31423 .next
31424 Timeout after RCPT.
31425 .endlist
31426
31427 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
31428 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
31429 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
31430 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
31431 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
31432 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
31433 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
31434 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
31435 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
31436 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
31437 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
31438 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
31439 the retry clock is reset.
31440
31441 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
31442 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
31443 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
31444 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
31445 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
31446 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
31447 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
31448 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
31449 recipient's retry time.
31450 .endlist
31451
31452 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
31453 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
31454 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
31455 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
31456 until the next delivery attempt.
31457
31458 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
31459 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
31460 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
31461 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
31462 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
31463 is created.
31464
31465 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
31466 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
31467 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
31468 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
31469 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
31470 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
31471 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
31472
31473 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
31474 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
31475 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
31476 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
31477 then to be treated as a host error.
31478
31479 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
31480 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
31481 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
31482 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
31483 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
31484
31485
31486
31487
31488 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
31489 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
31490 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
31491 .cindex "inetd"
31492 .cindex "daemon"
31493 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
31494 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
31495 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
31496 .code
31497 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
31498 .endd
31499 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
31500 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
31501 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
31502 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
31503 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
31504 stream and exits with an error code.
31505
31506 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
31507 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
31508 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
31509 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
31510
31511 .cindex "carriage return"
31512 .cindex "linefeed"
31513 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31514 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
31515 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31516 line terminator.
31517 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
31518 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
31519 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
31520
31521 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
31522 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
31523 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
31524 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
31525 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
31526 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
31527 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
31528 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
31529
31530 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31531 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
31532 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
31533 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
31534 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
31535 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
31536 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
31537 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
31538 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
31539
31540 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
31541 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
31542 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
31543
31544 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
31545 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
31546 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
31547 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
31548 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
31549
31550 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
31551 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
31552 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
31553 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
31554 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
31555 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
31556 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
31557
31558 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
31559 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
31560 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
31561 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
31562 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
31563
31564 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
31565 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
31566 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
31567 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
31568 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
31569 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
31570 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
31571 a delivery process.
31572
31573 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
31574 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
31575 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
31576 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
31577 however, available with &'inetd'&.
31578
31579 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
31580 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
31581 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
31582 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
31583
31584 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
31585 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
31586 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
31587
31588
31589
31590 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
31591 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
31592 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
31593 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
31594 the error response to the last command. The default value for
31595 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
31596 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
31597 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
31598
31599
31600 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
31601 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
31602 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
31603 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
31604 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
31605 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
31606 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
31607 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
31608 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
31609 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
31610 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
31611
31612
31613
31614 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
31615 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
31616 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
31617 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
31618 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
31619 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
31620 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
31621 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
31622
31623 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
31624 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
31625 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
31626 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
31627 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
31628 counted.
31629
31630 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
31631 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
31632 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
31633
31634 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
31635 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
31636 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
31637 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
31638 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
31639
31640
31641
31642
31643 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
31644 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
31645 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
31646 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
31647 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31648
31649 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
31650 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
31651 called with the &%-bv%& option.
31652
31653 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
31654 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
31655 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
31656 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
31657 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
31658 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
31659 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
31660 RCPT failures.
31661
31662
31663
31664 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
31665 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
31666 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
31667 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
31668 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
31669 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
31670 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31671
31672 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
31673 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
31674 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
31675 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
31676 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
31677 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
31678 argument. For example,
31679 .code
31680 ETRN #brigadoon
31681 .endd
31682 runs the command
31683 .code
31684 exim -R brigadoon
31685 .endd
31686 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
31687 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
31688 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
31689 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
31690 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
31691
31692 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
31693 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
31694 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
31695 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
31696 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
31697 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
31698 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
31699 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
31700
31701 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
31702 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
31703 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
31704 whatever the form of its argument. For
31705 example:
31706 .code
31707 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
31708 $sender_host_address
31709 .endd
31710 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31711 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
31712 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
31713 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
31714 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
31715 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
31716 for it to change them before running the command.
31717
31718
31719
31720 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
31721 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
31722 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
31723 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
31724 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
31725 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
31726 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
31727 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
31728 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
31729 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
31730 runs for RCPT commands:
31731 .code
31732 accept hosts = :
31733 .endd
31734 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
31735
31736
31737
31738 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
31739 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
31740 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
31741 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
31742 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
31743 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
31744 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
31745 envelope along with the message.
31746
31747 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
31748 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
31749 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
31750 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
31751 can be used to specify it.
31752
31753 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
31754 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
31755 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
31756 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
31757 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
31758
31759 .vindex "&$host$&"
31760 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
31761 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
31762 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
31763 router:
31764 .code
31765 begin routers
31766 route_append:
31767 driver = manualroute
31768 transport = smtp_appendfile
31769 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
31770
31771 begin transports
31772 smtp_appendfile:
31773 driver = appendfile
31774 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
31775 batch_max = 1000
31776 use_bsmtp
31777 user = exim
31778 .endd
31779 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
31780 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
31781 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
31782
31783
31784
31785 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
31786 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
31787 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
31788 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
31789 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
31790 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
31791 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
31792 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
31793 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
31794 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
31795
31796 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
31797 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
31798
31799 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
31800 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
31801 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
31802 make some use of automatically, for example:
31803 .code
31804 554 Unexpected end of file
31805 Transaction started in line 10
31806 Error detected in line 14
31807 .endd
31808 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
31809 file, for example:
31810 .code
31811 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
31812 The error message was:
31813
31814 501 '>' missing at end of address
31815
31816 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
31817 The error was detected in line 12.
31818 The SMTP command at fault was:
31819
31820 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
31821
31822 1 previous message was successfully processed.
31823 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
31824 .endd
31825 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
31826 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
31827 accepted.
31828 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
31829 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
31830
31831
31832
31833 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31834 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31835
31836 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
31837 "Customizing messages"
31838 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
31839 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
31840 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
31841 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
31842 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
31843
31844 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
31845 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
31846 option. Exim also adds the line
31847 .code
31848 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
31849 .endd
31850 to all warning and bounce messages,
31851
31852
31853 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
31854 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
31855 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
31856 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
31857 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
31858 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
31859 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
31860
31861 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
31862 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
31863 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
31864 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
31865 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
31866 item.
31867
31868 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
31869 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
31870 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
31871 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
31872 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
31873 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
31874 option, rounded to a whole number.
31875
31876 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
31877
31878 .ilist
31879 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31880 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31881 .next
31882 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
31883 failing addresses with their error messages.
31884 .next
31885 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
31886 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
31887 .next
31888 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
31889 as part of the error report.
31890 .next
31891 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
31892 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
31893 .next
31894 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
31895 .endlist
31896
31897 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
31898 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
31899 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
31900 .code
31901 Subject: Mail delivery failed
31902 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31903 {: returning message to sender}}
31904 ****
31905 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31906
31907 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31908 {that you sent }{sent by
31909
31910 <$sender_address>
31911
31912 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
31913 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
31914 ****
31915 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
31916 ****
31917 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
31918 ------
31919 ****
31920 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
31921 only the first
31922 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
31923 ****
31924 .endd
31925 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
31926 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
31927 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
31928 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
31929 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
31930 text sections:
31931
31932 .ilist
31933 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31934 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31935 .next
31936 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
31937 the delayed addresses.
31938 .next
31939 The third item then ends the message.
31940 .endlist
31941
31942 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
31943 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
31944 .code
31945 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
31946 $warn_message_delay
31947 ****
31948 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31949
31950 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
31951 {that you sent }{sent by
31952
31953 <$sender_address>
31954
31955 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
31956 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
31957
31958 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
31959 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
31960 The date of the message is: $h_date
31961
31962 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
31963 ****
31964 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
31965 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
31966 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
31967 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
31968 the message will be returned to you.
31969 .endd
31970 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
31971 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
31972 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
31973 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
31974 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
31975 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
31976 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
31977 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
31978 handled them.
31979
31980
31981
31982
31983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31985
31986 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
31987 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
31988 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
31989
31990
31991
31992 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
31993 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
31994 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
31995 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
31996 routing explicitly:
31997 .code
31998 send_to_smart_host:
31999 driver = manualroute
32000 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32001 transport = remote_smtp
32002 .endd
32003 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32004 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32005 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32006 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32007 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32008
32009
32010
32011
32012 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32013 .cindex "mailing lists"
32014 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32015 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32016 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32017
32018 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32019 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32020 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32021 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32022 .code
32023 lists:
32024 driver = redirect
32025 domains = lists.example
32026 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32027 forbid_pipe
32028 forbid_file
32029 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32030 no_more
32031 .endd
32032 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32033 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32034 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32035 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32036
32037 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32038 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32039 a mailing list.
32040
32041 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32042 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32043 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32044 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32045 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32046
32047 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32048 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32049 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32050 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32051 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32052 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32053 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32054 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32055 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32056
32057
32058
32059 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32060 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32061 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32062 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32063 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32064 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32065 addresses are not rigorously checked.
32066
32067 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32068 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32069 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32070 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32071 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32072
32073
32074
32075 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32076 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32077 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32078 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
32079 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
32080 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
32081 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
32082 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
32083 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
32084 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
32085
32086 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
32087 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
32088 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
32089 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
32090 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
32091 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
32092 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
32093 pre-existing messages.
32094
32095 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
32096 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
32097 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
32098 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
32099 one level of expansion anyway.
32100
32101
32102
32103 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
32104 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
32105 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
32106 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
32107 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
32108 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
32109
32110 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
32111 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
32112 .code
32113 lists_request:
32114 driver = redirect
32115 domains = lists.example
32116 local_part_suffix = -request
32117 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
32118 no_more
32119
32120 lists_post:
32121 driver = redirect
32122 domains = lists.example
32123 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
32124 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
32125 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32126 forbid_pipe
32127 forbid_file
32128 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32129 no_more
32130
32131 lists_closed:
32132 driver = redirect
32133 domains = lists.example
32134 allow_fail
32135 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
32136 .endd
32137 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
32138 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
32139 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
32140 mailing list.
32141
32142 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
32143 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
32144 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
32145 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
32146 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
32147 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
32148 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
32149 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
32150 &"unrouteable address"& error.
32151
32152 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
32153 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
32154 the address, giving a suitable error message.
32155
32156
32157
32158
32159 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
32160 .cindex "VERP"
32161 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
32162 .cindex "envelope sender"
32163 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
32164 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
32165 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
32166 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
32167 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
32168 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
32169
32170 .oindex &%errors_to%&
32171 .oindex &%return_path%&
32172 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
32173 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
32174 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
32175 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
32176 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
32177 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
32178 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
32179 .code
32180 verp_smtp:
32181 driver = smtp
32182 max_rcpt = 1
32183 return_path = \
32184 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32185 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32186 .endd
32187 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
32188 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
32189 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
32190 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
32191 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
32192 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
32193 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
32194 rewritten as
32195 .code
32196 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
32197 .endd
32198 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32199 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
32200 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
32201 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
32202 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
32203 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
32204
32205 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
32206 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
32207 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
32208 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
32209 .code
32210 dnslookup:
32211 driver = dnslookup
32212 domains = ! +local_domains
32213 transport = \
32214 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32215 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
32216 no_more
32217 .endd
32218 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
32219 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
32220 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
32221 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
32222 address.
32223
32224 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
32225 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
32226 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
32227 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
32228 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
32229 .code
32230 verp_dnslookup:
32231 driver = dnslookup
32232 domains = ! +local_domains
32233 transport = remote_smtp
32234 errors_to = \
32235 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
32236 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32237 no_more
32238 .endd
32239 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
32240 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
32241 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
32242 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
32243 them.
32244
32245 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
32246 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
32247 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
32248 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
32249 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
32250 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
32251 used).
32252
32253
32254
32255
32256
32257
32258 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
32259 .cindex "virtual domains"
32260 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
32261 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
32262 meanings:
32263
32264 .ilist
32265 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
32266 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
32267 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
32268 .next
32269 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
32270 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
32271 have login accounts on that host.
32272 .endlist
32273
32274 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
32275 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
32276 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
32277 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
32278 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
32279 to a router of this form:
32280 .code
32281 virtual:
32282 driver = redirect
32283 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
32284 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
32285 no_more
32286 .endd
32287 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
32288 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
32289 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
32290 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
32291 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
32292 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
32293
32294 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
32295 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
32296 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
32297 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
32298
32299 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
32300 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
32301 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
32302 .code
32303 my_domains:
32304 driver = accept
32305 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
32306 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
32307 transport = my_mailboxes
32308 .endd
32309 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
32310 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
32311 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
32312 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
32313 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
32314 follows:
32315 .code
32316 my_mailboxes:
32317 driver = appendfile
32318 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
32319 user = mail
32320 .endd
32321 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
32322 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
32323
32324 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
32325 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
32326 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
32327 information about the domains.
32328
32329
32330
32331 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
32332 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
32333 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
32334 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
32335 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
32336 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
32337 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
32338 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
32339 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
32340 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
32341 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
32342 example, consider this router:
32343 .code
32344 userforward:
32345 driver = redirect
32346 check_local_user
32347 file = $home/.forward
32348 local_part_suffix = -*
32349 local_part_suffix_optional
32350 allow_filter
32351 .endd
32352 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
32353 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
32354 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
32355 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
32356 .code
32357 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
32358 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
32359 endif
32360 .endd
32361 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
32362 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
32363 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
32364 control over which suffixes are valid.
32365
32366 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
32367 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
32368 another MTA:
32369 .code
32370 userforward:
32371 driver = redirect
32372 check_local_user
32373 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
32374 local_part_suffix = -*
32375 local_part_suffix_optional
32376 allow_filter
32377 .endd
32378 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
32379 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
32380 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
32381 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
32382 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
32383
32384
32385
32386 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
32387 .cindex "vacation processing"
32388 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
32389 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
32390 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
32391 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
32392 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
32393
32394 .ilist
32395 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
32396 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
32397 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
32398 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
32399 .code
32400 spqr, vacation-spqr
32401 .endd
32402 .next
32403 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
32404 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
32405 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
32406 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
32407 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
32408 message.
32409 .endlist
32410
32411 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
32412 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
32413
32414
32415
32416 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
32417 .cindex "message" "copying every"
32418 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
32419 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
32420 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
32421 each day's messages.
32422
32423 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
32424 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
32425 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
32426 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
32427
32428
32429
32430 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
32431 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
32432 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
32433 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
32434 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
32435 permanently connected.
32436
32437 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
32438 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
32439 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
32440
32441
32442 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
32443 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
32444 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
32445 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
32446 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
32447 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
32448 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
32449 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
32450
32451 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
32452 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
32453 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
32454 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
32455 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
32456 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
32457 if required.
32458
32459 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
32460 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
32461 intermittent host. For example:
32462 .code
32463 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
32464 .endd
32465 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
32466 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
32467 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
32468 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
32469 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
32470 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
32471 immediately.
32472
32473 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
32474 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
32475 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
32476 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
32477 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
32478 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
32479 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
32480
32481
32482
32483 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
32484 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
32485 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
32486 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
32487 delivered immediately.
32488
32489 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32490 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
32491 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
32492 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
32493 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
32494 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
32495 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
32496 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
32497 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
32498 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
32499 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
32500 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
32501 single SMTP connection.
32502
32503
32504
32505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32507
32508 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
32509 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
32510 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
32511 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
32512 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
32513 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
32514 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
32515 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
32516 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
32517 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
32518 messages this way.
32519
32520 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
32521 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
32522 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
32523 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
32524 email is not desirable.
32525
32526 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
32527 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
32528 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
32529 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
32530 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
32531 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
32532 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
32533
32534 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
32535 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
32536 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
32537 before sending a message to the smart host.
32538
32539 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
32540 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
32541 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
32542
32543 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
32544 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
32545 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
32546 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
32547 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
32548 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
32549 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
32550
32551 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
32552 following ways:
32553
32554 .ilist
32555 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
32556 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
32557 .next
32558 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
32559 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
32560 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
32561 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
32562 successful, a zero return code is given.
32563 .next
32564 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
32565 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
32566 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
32567 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
32568 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
32569 are.
32570 .next
32571 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
32572 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
32573 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
32574 .next
32575 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
32576 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
32577 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
32578 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
32579 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
32580 .next
32581 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
32582 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
32583 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
32584 .next
32585 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
32586 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
32587 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
32588 are ever generated.
32589 .next
32590 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
32591 .next
32592 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
32593 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
32594 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
32595 .endlist
32596
32597 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
32598 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
32599 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
32600 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
32601 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
32602 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
32603
32604
32605
32606
32607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32609
32610 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
32611 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
32612 .cindex "log" "types of"
32613 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
32614 and the panic log:
32615
32616 .ilist
32617 .cindex "main log"
32618 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
32619 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
32620 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
32621 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
32622 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
32623 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
32624 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
32625 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
32626 .next
32627 .cindex "reject log"
32628 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
32629 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
32630 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
32631 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
32632 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
32633 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
32634 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
32635 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
32636 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
32637 false.
32638 .next
32639 .cindex "panic log"
32640 .cindex "system log"
32641 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
32642 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
32643 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
32644 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
32645 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
32646 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
32647 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
32648 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
32649 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
32650 .endlist
32651
32652 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
32653 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
32654 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
32655 .code
32656 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
32657 by QUIT
32658 .endd
32659 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
32660 ways of changing this:
32661
32662 .ilist
32663 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
32664 you set
32665 .code
32666 timezone = UTC
32667 .endd
32668 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
32669 .next
32670 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
32671 example:
32672 .code
32673 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
32674 .endd
32675 .endlist
32676
32677 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32678 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32679 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
32680 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
32681 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
32682 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
32683
32684
32685
32686
32687 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
32688 .cindex "log" "destination"
32689 .cindex "log" "to file"
32690 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
32691 .cindex "syslog"
32692 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
32693 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
32694 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
32695 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
32696 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
32697 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
32698 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
32699
32700 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
32701 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
32702 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
32703 references to the host name:
32704 .code
32705 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
32706 .endd
32707 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
32708 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
32709 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
32710 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
32711 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
32712 log at all.
32713
32714 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
32715 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
32716 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
32717 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
32718 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
32719 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
32720 implying the use of a default path.
32721
32722 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
32723 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
32724 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
32725 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
32726 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
32727 equivalent to the setting:
32728 .code
32729 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
32730 .endd
32731 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
32732 logs are written.
32733
32734 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
32735 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
32736
32737 Here are some examples of possible settings:
32738 .display
32739 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
32740 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
32741 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
32742 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
32743 .endd
32744 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
32745 error is logged.
32746
32747
32748
32749 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
32750 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32751 .cindex "cycling logs"
32752 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32753 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
32754 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
32755 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
32756 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
32757 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
32758 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
32759
32760 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
32761 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
32762 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
32763 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
32764 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
32765 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
32766 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
32767 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
32768 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
32769 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
32770 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
32771 renamed.
32772
32773
32774
32775 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
32776 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
32777 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
32778 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
32779 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
32780 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
32781 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
32782 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
32783 .code
32784 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
32785 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
32786 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
32787 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
32788 .endd
32789 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
32790 examples of names generated by the above examples:
32791 .code
32792 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
32793 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
32794 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
32795 /var/log/exim/main.200212
32796 .endd
32797 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
32798 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
32799 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
32800 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
32801
32802 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
32803 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
32804 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
32805 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
32806 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
32807 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
32808 log names:
32809 .code
32810 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
32811 /var/log/exim-panic.log
32812 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
32813 /var/log/exim/panic
32814 .endd
32815
32816
32817 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
32818 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
32819 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
32820 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
32821 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
32822 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
32823 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
32824 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
32825 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
32826 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
32827 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
32828 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
32829 the time and host name to each line.
32830 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
32831
32832 .ilist
32833 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
32834 .next
32835 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
32836 .next
32837 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
32838 .endlist
32839
32840 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
32841 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
32842 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
32843 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
32844
32845 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
32846 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
32847 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
32848 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
32849 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
32850 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
32851 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
32852 RFC 3164, you should set
32853 .code
32854 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
32855 .endd
32856 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
32857 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
32858
32859 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
32860 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
32861 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
32862 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
32863 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
32864 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
32865 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
32866 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
32867 name, and pid as added by syslog:
32868 .code
32869 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
32870 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
32871 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
32872 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
32873 [5/5] mple>)
32874 .endd
32875 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
32876 (LOG_NOTICE):
32877 .code
32878 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
32879 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
32880 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
32881 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
32882 [5\18] .example>)
32883 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
32884 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
32885 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
32886 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
32887 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
32888 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
32889 [12\18] F From: <>
32890 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
32891 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
32892 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
32893 [16\18] le>
32894 [17\18] B Bcc:
32895 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
32896 .endd
32897 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
32898 without modification.
32899
32900 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
32901 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
32902 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
32903 where it is.
32904
32905
32906
32907 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
32908 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
32909 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
32910 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
32911 timestamp. The flags are:
32912 .display
32913 &`<=`& message arrival
32914 &`=>`& normal message delivery
32915 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
32916 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
32917 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
32918 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
32919 .endd
32920
32921
32922 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
32923 .cindex "log" "reception line"
32924 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32925 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
32926 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
32927 .code
32928 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
32929 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
32930 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
32931 .endd
32932 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
32933 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
32934 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
32935 .code
32936 R=<message id>
32937 .endd
32938 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
32939
32940 .cindex "HELO"
32941 .cindex "EHLO"
32942 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
32943 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
32944 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
32945 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
32946 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
32947 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
32948 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
32949 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
32950 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
32951 name in parentheses.
32952
32953 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
32954 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
32955 the log containing text like these examples:
32956 .code
32957 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
32958 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
32959 .endd
32960 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
32961 on.
32962
32963 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
32964 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
32965 of Exim.
32966
32967 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
32968 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
32969 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
32970 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
32971 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
32972 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
32973 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
32974 suite that was used.
32975
32976 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
32977 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
32978 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
32979 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
32980 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
32981 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
32982 authenticator name.
32983
32984 .cindex "size" "of message"
32985 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
32986 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
32987 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
32988 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
32989 other).
32990
32991 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32992 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32993
32994
32995
32996 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
32997 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
32998 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32999 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33000 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33001 to fit it on the page:
33002 .code
33003 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33004 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33005 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33006 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33007 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33008 .endd
33009 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33010 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33011 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33012 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33013 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33014
33015 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33016 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33017 .display
33018 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33019 .endd
33020 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33021 parentheses afterwards.
33022
33023 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33024 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33025 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33026 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33027 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33028 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33029
33030 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33031 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33032
33033 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33034 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33035
33036
33037 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33038 .cindex "discarded messages"
33039 .cindex "message" "discarded"
33040 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33041 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33042 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33043 .code
33044 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33045 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33046 .endd
33047 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33048 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33049 .code
33050 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33051 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33052 .endd
33053
33054
33055 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33056 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33057 .code
33058 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33059 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33060 .endd
33061 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
33062 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
33063 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
33064 .code
33065 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
33066 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
33067 .endd
33068 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
33069 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
33070 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
33071
33072
33073
33074 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
33075 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
33076 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
33077 following form is logged:
33078 .code
33079 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
33080 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
33081 .endd
33082 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
33083 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
33084 .code
33085 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
33086 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
33087 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
33088 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
33089 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
33090 .endd
33091 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
33092 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
33093 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
33094 flagged with &`**`&.
33095
33096
33097
33098 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
33099 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
33100 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
33101 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
33102 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
33103
33104
33105
33106 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
33107 A line of the form
33108 .code
33109 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
33110 .endd
33111 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
33112 at the end of its processing.
33113
33114
33115
33116
33117 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
33118 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
33119 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
33120 the following table:
33121 .display
33122 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
33123 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
33124 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33125 &`CV `& certificate verification status
33126 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33127 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
33128 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
33129 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
33130 &`H `& host name and IP address
33131 &`I `& local interface used
33132 &`id `& message id for incoming message
33133 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
33134 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
33135 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
33136 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
33137 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
33138 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
33139 &`S `& size of message
33140 &`ST `& shadow transport name
33141 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
33142 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
33143 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
33144 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
33145 .endd
33146
33147
33148 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
33149 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
33150 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
33151
33152 .ilist
33153 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
33154 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
33155 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
33156 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
33157 during the first delivery attempt.
33158 .next
33159 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
33160 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
33161 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
33162 .next
33163 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
33164 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
33165 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
33166 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
33167 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
33168 doing.
33169 .next
33170 .cindex "error" "ignored"
33171 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
33172 message:
33173 .olist
33174 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
33175 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
33176 .next
33177 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
33178 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33179 .next
33180 A delivery set up by a router configured with
33181 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
33182 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
33183 .code
33184 errors_to = <>
33185 .endd
33186 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33187 .endlist olist
33188 .endlist ilist
33189
33190
33191
33192
33193
33194 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
33195 .cindex "log" "selectors"
33196 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
33197 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
33198 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
33199 example:
33200 .code
33201 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
33202 .endd
33203 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
33204 selection marked by asterisks:
33205 .display
33206 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
33207 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
33208 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
33209 &` arguments `& command line arguments
33210 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
33211 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
33212 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
33213 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
33214 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
33215 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
33216 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
33217 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
33218 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
33219 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
33220 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
33221 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
33222 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
33223 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
33224 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
33225 &` pid `& Exim process id
33226 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
33227 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
33228 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
33229 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
33230 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
33231 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
33232 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
33233 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
33234 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
33235 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
33236 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
33237 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
33238 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
33239 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
33240 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
33241 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
33242 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
33243 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
33244 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
33245 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
33246 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
33247
33248 &` all `& all of the above
33249 .endd
33250 More details on each of these items follows:
33251
33252 .ilist
33253 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
33254 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
33255 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
33256 this log selector is set.
33257 .next
33258 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
33259 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
33260 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
33261 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
33262 such users cannot access the log).
33263 .next
33264 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
33265 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
33266 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
33267 parentheses between them.
33268 .next
33269 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
33270 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
33271 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
33272 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
33273 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
33274 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
33275 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
33276 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
33277 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
33278 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
33279 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
33280 between the caller and Exim.
33281 .next
33282 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
33283 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
33284 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
33285 .next
33286 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
33287 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
33288 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
33289 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
33290 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
33291 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
33292 .next
33293 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
33294 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
33295 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
33296 .next
33297 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
33298 .cindex "size" "of message"
33299 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
33300 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
33301 .next
33302 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
33303 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
33304 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33305 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
33306 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
33307 .next
33308 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
33309 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
33310 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
33311 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
33312 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
33313 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
33314 .next
33315 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
33316 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
33317 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
33318 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
33319 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
33320 .next
33321 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
33322 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
33323 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
33324 client's ident port times out.
33325 .next
33326 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
33327 .cindex "interface" "logging"
33328 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
33329 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
33330 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
33331 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
33332 rejection lines.
33333 .next
33334 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
33335 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
33336 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
33337 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
33338 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
33339 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
33340 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
33341 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
33342 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
33343 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
33344 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
33345 .next
33346 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
33347 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
33348 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
33349 .next
33350 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
33351 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
33352 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
33353 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
33354 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
33355 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
33356 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
33357 .next
33358 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33359 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33360 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
33361 immediately after the time and date.
33362 .next
33363 .cindex "log" "queue run"
33364 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
33365 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
33366 .next
33367 .cindex "log" "queue time"
33368 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
33369 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
33370 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
33371 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
33372 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
33373 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
33374 message has been successfully received.
33375 .next
33376 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
33377 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
33378 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
33379 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
33380 .next
33381 .cindex "log" "recipients"
33382 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
33383 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
33384 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
33385 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
33386 has taken place.
33387 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
33388 in the list.
33389 .next
33390 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
33391 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
33392 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
33393 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
33394 .next
33395 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
33396 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
33397 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
33398 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
33399 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
33400 .next
33401 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
33402 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
33403 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
33404 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
33405 attempt.
33406 .next
33407 .cindex "log" "return path"
33408 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
33409 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
33410 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
33411 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
33412 .next
33413 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
33414 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
33415 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
33416 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
33417 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
33418 .next
33419 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
33420 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
33421 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
33422 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
33423 detail is lost.
33424 .next
33425 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
33426 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
33427 it is too big.
33428 .next
33429 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
33430 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
33431 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
33432 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
33433 it.
33434 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
33435 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
33436 .next
33437 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
33438 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
33439 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
33440 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
33441 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
33442 response.
33443 .next
33444 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
33445 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
33446 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
33447 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
33448 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
33449 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
33450 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
33451 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
33452 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
33453 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
33454
33455 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
33456 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
33457 reset if the daemon is restarted.
33458 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
33459 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
33460 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
33461 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
33462 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
33463 .next
33464 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
33465 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
33466 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
33467 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
33468 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
33469 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
33470 .next
33471 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
33472 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
33473 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
33474 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
33475 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
33476 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
33477 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
33478 already have their own log lines.
33479
33480 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
33481 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
33482 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
33483 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
33484 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
33485 the same logging options.
33486
33487 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
33488 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
33489 .code
33490 C=EHLO,QUIT
33491 .endd
33492 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
33493 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
33494 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
33495 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
33496 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
33497 .next
33498 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
33499 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
33500 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
33501 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
33502 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
33503 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
33504 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
33505 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
33506 .next
33507 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
33508 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
33509 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
33510 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
33511 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
33512 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
33513 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
33514 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
33515 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
33516 .next
33517 .cindex "log" "subject"
33518 .cindex "subject, logging"
33519 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
33520 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
33521 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
33522 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
33523 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
33524 .next
33525 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
33526 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
33527 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
33528 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
33529 .next
33530 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
33531 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
33532 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33533 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
33534 .next
33535 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
33536 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
33537 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33538 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
33539 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
33540 .next
33541 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
33542 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
33543 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
33544 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
33545 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
33546 .next
33547 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
33548 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
33549 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
33550 .endlist
33551
33552
33553 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
33554 .cindex "message" "log file for"
33555 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
33556 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
33557 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
33558 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
33559 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
33560 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
33561 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
33562 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
33563 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
33564 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
33565 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
33566
33567 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
33568 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
33569 &%message_logs%& option false.
33570 .ecindex IIDloggen
33571
33572
33573
33574
33575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33577
33578 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
33579 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
33580 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
33581 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
33582 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
33583
33584 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
33585 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
33586 "list what Exim processes are doing"
33587 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
33588 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
33589 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
33590 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
33591 various criteria"
33592 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
33593 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
33594 "extract statistics from the log"
33595 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
33596 "check address acceptance from given IP"
33597 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
33598 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
33599 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
33600 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
33601 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
33602 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
33603 .endtable
33604
33605 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
33606 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
33607 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
33608
33609
33610
33611
33612 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
33613 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
33614 .cindex "process, querying"
33615 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
33616 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
33617 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
33618 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
33619 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
33620 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
33621 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
33622 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
33623 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
33624
33625 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
33626 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
33627 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
33628
33629
33630 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
33631 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
33632 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
33633 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
33634 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
33635 options:
33636 .display
33637 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
33638 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
33639 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
33640 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
33641 .endd
33642 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
33643 .code
33644 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
33645 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
33646 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
33647 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
33648 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
33649 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
33650 .endd
33651 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
33652 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
33653
33654
33655
33656 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
33657 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
33658 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
33659 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
33660 .code
33661 exim -bpu
33662 .endd
33663 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
33664 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
33665 options are available:
33666
33667 .vlist
33668 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
33669 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
33670 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
33671 .code
33672 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
33673 .endd
33674 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
33675 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
33676 brackets.
33677
33678 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
33679 Match against the size field.
33680
33681 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33682 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
33683
33684 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33685 Match messages that are older than the given time.
33686
33687 .vitem &*-z*&
33688 Match only frozen messages.
33689
33690 .vitem &*-x*&
33691 Match only non-frozen messages.
33692 .endlist
33693
33694 The following options control the format of the output:
33695
33696 .vlist
33697 .vitem &*-c*&
33698 Display only the count of matching messages.
33699
33700 .vitem &*-l*&
33701 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
33702 the default.
33703
33704 .vitem &*-i*&
33705 Display message ids only.
33706
33707 .vitem &*-b*&
33708 Brief format &-- one line per message.
33709
33710 .vitem &*-R*&
33711 Display messages in reverse order.
33712 .endlist
33713
33714 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
33715
33716
33717
33718 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
33719 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
33720 .cindex "queue" "summary"
33721 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
33722 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
33723 running a command such as
33724 .code
33725 exim -bp | exiqsumm
33726 .endd
33727 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
33728 it, as in the following example:
33729 .code
33730 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
33731 .endd
33732 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
33733 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
33734 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
33735 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
33736
33737 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
33738 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
33739 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
33740 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
33741 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
33742 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
33743 sender.
33744
33745 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
33746 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
33747 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
33748 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
33749 level"& addresses).
33750
33751
33752
33753
33754 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
33755 "SECTextspeinf"
33756 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
33757 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
33758 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
33759 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
33760 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
33761 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
33762 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
33763 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
33764 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
33765 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
33766 .display
33767 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
33768 .endd
33769 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
33770
33771 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
33772 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
33773 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
33774
33775 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
33776 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
33777 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
33778 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
33779 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
33780
33781 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
33782 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
33783 regular expression.
33784
33785 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
33786 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
33787
33788 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
33789 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
33790 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
33791
33792
33793 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
33794 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
33795 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
33796 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
33797 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
33798 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
33799 the &%--help%& option.
33800
33801
33802 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
33803 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33804 .cindex "cycling logs"
33805 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33806 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
33807 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
33808 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
33809 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
33810 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
33811 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
33812 .ilist
33813 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
33814 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
33815 .next
33816 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
33817 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
33818 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
33819 configuration.
33820 .endlist
33821
33822 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
33823 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
33824 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
33825 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
33826 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
33827 logs are handled similarly.
33828
33829 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
33830 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
33831 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
33832 any existing log files.
33833
33834 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
33835 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
33836 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
33837 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
33838 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
33839 .code
33840 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
33841 .endd
33842 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
33843 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
33844
33845
33846
33847 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
33848 .cindex "statistics"
33849 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
33850 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
33851 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
33852 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
33853 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
33854
33855 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
33856 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
33857 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
33858 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
33859 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
33860 .code
33861 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
33862 .endd
33863 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
33864 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
33865 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
33866 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
33867 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
33868 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
33869 also produced per user.
33870
33871 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
33872 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
33873 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
33874 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
33875 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
33876
33877 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
33878 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
33879 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
33880 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
33881 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
33882 an entirely separate message.
33883
33884 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
33885 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
33886 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
33887 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
33888 least one address that failed.
33889
33890 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
33891 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
33892 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
33893 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
33894 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
33895 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
33896 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
33897
33898 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
33899 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
33900 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
33901
33902 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
33903 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
33904 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
33905 .code
33906 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
33907 .endd
33908
33909 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
33910 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
33911 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
33912 .cindex "checking access"
33913 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
33914 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
33915 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
33916 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
33917 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
33918 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
33919
33920 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
33921 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
33922 .code
33923 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
33924 .endd
33925 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
33926 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
33927 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
33928 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
33929 .code
33930 Rejected:
33931 550 Relay not permitted
33932 .endd
33933 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
33934 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
33935 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
33936 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
33937 you can use:
33938 .code
33939 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
33940 -f himself@there.example
33941 .endd
33942 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
33943 mandatory arguments.
33944
33945 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
33946 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
33947 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
33948
33949
33950
33951 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
33952 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
33953 .cindex "building DBM files"
33954 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
33955 .cindex "lower casing"
33956 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
33957 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
33958 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
33959 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
33960 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
33961 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
33962
33963 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
33964 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
33965 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
33966 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
33967 files.
33968
33969 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
33970 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
33971 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
33972 well.
33973
33974 .cindex "USE_DB"
33975 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
33976 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
33977 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
33978 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
33979 .code
33980 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
33981 .endd
33982 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
33983 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
33984
33985 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
33986 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
33987 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
33988 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
33989 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
33990 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
33991
33992 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
33993 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
33994 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
33995 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
33996 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
33997 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
33998 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
33999 return code is 2.
34000
34001
34002
34003
34004 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34005 .cindex "retry" "times"
34006 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
34007 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34008 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34009 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34010 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34011 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34012 output. For example:
34013 .code
34014 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34015 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34016 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34017 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34018 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34019 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34020 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34021 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34022 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34023 past final cutoff time
34024 .endd
34025 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34026 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34027 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34028 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34029 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34030 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34031 run very often.
34032
34033 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34034 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34035 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
34036 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
34037 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
34038 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
34039
34040
34041
34042 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
34043 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
34044 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
34045 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
34046 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
34047 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
34048 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
34049
34050 .ilist
34051 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
34052 .next
34053 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
34054 for remote hosts
34055 .next
34056 &'callout'&: the callout cache
34057 .next
34058 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
34059 .next
34060 &'misc'&: other hints data
34061 .endlist
34062
34063 The &'misc'& database is used for
34064
34065 .ilist
34066 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
34067 .next
34068 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
34069 &(smtp)& transport)
34070 .endlist
34071
34072
34073
34074 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
34075 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
34076 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
34077 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
34078 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
34079 .code
34080 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
34081 .endd
34082 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
34083 .code
34084 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
34085 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
34086 .endd
34087 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
34088 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
34089 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
34090 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
34091 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
34092 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
34093 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
34094 and a textual description of the error.
34095
34096 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
34097 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
34098 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
34099 exceeded.
34100
34101 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
34102 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
34103 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
34104 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
34105 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
34106 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
34107 cross-references.
34108
34109
34110
34111 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
34112 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
34113 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
34114 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
34115 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
34116 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
34117 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
34118 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
34119 updated sufficiently often.
34120
34121 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
34122 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
34123 the retry database:
34124 .code
34125 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
34126 .endd
34127 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
34128 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
34129 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
34130 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
34131 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
34132 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
34133 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
34134 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
34135 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
34136 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
34137 whenever it removes information from the database.
34138
34139 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
34140 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
34141 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
34142 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
34143 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
34144
34145 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
34146 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
34147 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
34148 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
34149 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
34150 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
34151 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
34152 tidied.
34153
34154 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
34155 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
34156
34157
34158
34159
34160 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
34161 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
34162 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
34163 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
34164 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
34165 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
34166 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
34167 displayed.
34168
34169 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
34170 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
34171 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
34172 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
34173 by new data, for example:
34174 .code
34175 > 4 951102:1000
34176 .endd
34177 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
34178 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
34179 used as optional separators.
34180
34181
34182
34183
34184 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
34185 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
34186 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
34187 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
34188 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
34189 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
34190 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
34191 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
34192 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
34193 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
34194 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
34195 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
34196 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
34197
34198 .vlist
34199 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
34200 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
34201
34202 .vitem &%-flock%&
34203 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
34204 supports it.
34205
34206 .vitem &%-interval%&
34207 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
34208 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
34209
34210 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
34211 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
34212
34213 .vitem &%-mbx%&
34214 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
34215
34216 .vitem &%-q%&
34217 Suppress verification output.
34218
34219 .vitem &%-retries%&
34220 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
34221 the lock (default 10).
34222
34223 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
34224 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
34225 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
34226 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
34227 subsequently sees.
34228
34229 .vitem &%-timeout%&
34230 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
34231 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
34232 default), a non-blocking call is used.
34233
34234 .vitem &%-v%&
34235 Generate verbose output.
34236 .endlist
34237
34238 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
34239 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
34240 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
34241 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
34242 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
34243 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
34244 more than 30 minutes old.
34245
34246 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
34247 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
34248 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
34249 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
34250 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
34251 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
34252
34253 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
34254 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
34255 suppresses all output except error messages.
34256
34257 A command such as
34258 .code
34259 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
34260 .endd
34261 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
34262 .display
34263 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
34264 <&'some commands'&>
34265 &`End`&
34266 .endd
34267 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
34268 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
34269 such as
34270 .code
34271 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
34272 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
34273 .endd
34274 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
34275 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
34276 .ecindex IIDutils
34277
34278
34279 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34280 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34281
34282 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
34283 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
34284 .cindex "X-windows"
34285 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
34286 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
34287 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
34288 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
34289 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
34290 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
34291 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
34292 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
34293
34294
34295
34296 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
34297 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
34298 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
34299 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
34300 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
34301 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
34302 parameters are for.
34303
34304 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
34305 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
34306 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
34307 .code
34308 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
34309 .endd
34310 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
34311 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
34312 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
34313 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
34314 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
34315
34316 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
34317 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
34318 .code
34319 Eximon*background: gray94
34320 .endd
34321 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
34322 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
34323 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
34324 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
34325 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
34326 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
34327 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
34328 .code
34329 xrdb -merge <<End
34330 Eximon*highlight: gray
34331 End
34332 .endd
34333 .cindex "admin user"
34334 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
34335 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
34336
34337 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
34338 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
34339 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
34340 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
34341 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
34342
34343 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
34344 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
34345 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
34346 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
34347 different parts of the display.
34348
34349
34350
34351
34352 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
34353 .cindex "stripchart"
34354 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
34355 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34356 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
34357 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
34358 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
34359 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
34360 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
34361 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
34362 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34363
34364 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
34365 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
34366 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
34367 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
34368
34369 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
34370 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
34371 to a single partition.
34372
34373 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
34374 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
34375 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
34376 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
34377 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
34378 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34379 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34380
34381
34382
34383
34384 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
34385 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
34386 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
34387 .cindex "window size"
34388 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
34389 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
34390 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
34391 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
34392 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
34393 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
34394
34395 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
34396 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
34397 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
34398 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
34399
34400 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
34401 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
34402 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
34403 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
34404 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
34405 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34406
34407 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
34408 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
34409 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34410
34411
34412
34413 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
34414 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
34415 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
34416 the main log is maintained.
34417 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
34418 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
34419 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
34420 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
34421 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
34422
34423 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
34424 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
34425 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
34426 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
34427 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
34428 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
34429 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
34430 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
34431 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
34432 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
34433 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34434
34435 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
34436 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
34437 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
34438 It cannot go further back up the log.
34439
34440 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
34441 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
34442 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
34443 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
34444 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
34445 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
34446
34447 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
34448 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
34449 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
34450 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
34451 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
34452 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
34453
34454 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
34455 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
34456 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
34457 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
34458 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
34459 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
34460 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
34461 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
34462 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
34463 window.
34464
34465
34466
34467 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
34468 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
34469 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
34470 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
34471 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
34472 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
34473 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
34474 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
34475 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
34476 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
34477
34478 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
34479 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
34480 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
34481 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
34482 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
34483 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
34484 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
34485
34486 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
34487 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
34488 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
34489 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
34490 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
34491 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
34492 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
34493
34494 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
34495 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
34496 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
34497 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
34498
34499 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
34500 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
34501 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
34502 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
34503 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
34504 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
34505 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
34506 not shown.
34507
34508 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
34509 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
34510
34511 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
34512 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
34513 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
34514 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
34515 display is updated.
34516
34517
34518
34519 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
34520 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
34521 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
34522 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
34523 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
34524 any selected text.
34525
34526 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
34527 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
34528 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
34529 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
34530 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
34531 .code
34532 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
34533 .endd
34534 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
34535 follows:
34536
34537 .ilist
34538 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
34539 in a new text window.
34540 .next
34541 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
34542 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
34543 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
34544 .next
34545 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
34546 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
34547 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
34548 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
34549 .next
34550 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
34551 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
34552 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
34553 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
34554 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
34555 .next
34556 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
34557 that the message be frozen.
34558 .next
34559 .cindex "thawing messages"
34560 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
34561 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
34562 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
34563 that the message be thawed.
34564 .next
34565 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
34566 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
34567 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
34568 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
34569 .next
34570 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
34571 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
34572 message.
34573 .next
34574 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
34575 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34576 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34577 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34578 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
34579 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
34580 which case no action is taken.
34581 .next
34582 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
34583 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34584 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34585 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34586 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
34587 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
34588 case no action is taken.
34589 .next
34590 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
34591 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
34592 .next
34593 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
34594 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
34595 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
34596 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
34597 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
34598 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
34599 the address is qualified with that domain.
34600 .endlist
34601
34602 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
34603 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
34604 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
34605 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
34606 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
34607 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
34608 if no output is generated.
34609
34610 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
34611 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
34612 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
34613 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
34614
34615 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
34616 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
34617 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
34618 .ecindex IIDeximon
34619
34620
34621
34622
34623
34624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34626
34627 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
34628 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
34629 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
34630 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
34631
34632 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
34633 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
34634 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
34635 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
34636 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
34637 its security as compared with other MTAs.
34638
34639 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
34640 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
34641 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
34642 as soon as possible.
34643
34644
34645 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
34646 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
34647 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
34648 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
34649 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
34650 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
34651
34652 .ilist
34653 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
34654 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
34655 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
34656 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
34657 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
34658 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
34659
34660 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
34661 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
34662 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
34663 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
34664 .next
34665
34666 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
34667 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
34668 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
34669 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
34670 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
34671 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
34672 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
34673 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
34674 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
34675 separate commands.
34676
34677 .next
34678 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
34679 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
34680 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
34681 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
34682 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
34683 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
34684 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
34685 .next
34686 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
34687 is disabled.
34688 .next
34689 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
34690 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
34691 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
34692 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
34693 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
34694 .endlist
34695
34696
34697
34698 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
34699 .cindex "setuid"
34700 .cindex "root privilege"
34701 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
34702 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
34703 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
34704 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
34705 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
34706 is required for two things:
34707
34708 .ilist
34709 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
34710 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
34711 not required.
34712 .next
34713 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
34714 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
34715 configuration.
34716 .endlist
34717
34718 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
34719 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
34720 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
34721 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
34722 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
34723 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
34724 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
34725 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
34726
34727 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
34728 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
34729 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
34730
34731 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
34732 uid and gid in the following cases:
34733
34734 .ilist
34735 .oindex "&%-C%&"
34736 .oindex "&%-D%&"
34737 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
34738 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
34739 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
34740 the calling process.
34741 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
34742 option may not be used at all.
34743 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
34744 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
34745 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
34746 .next
34747 .oindex "&%-be%&"
34748 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
34749 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
34750 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
34751 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
34752 calling process.
34753 .next
34754 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
34755 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
34756 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
34757 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
34758 testing address verification
34759 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
34760 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
34761 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
34762 option).
34763 .next
34764 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
34765 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
34766 .endlist
34767
34768 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
34769
34770 .ilist
34771 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
34772 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
34773 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
34774 will be used during message reception.
34775 .next
34776 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
34777 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
34778 .next
34779 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
34780 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
34781 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
34782 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
34783 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
34784 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
34785 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
34786 generating bounce and warning messages.
34787
34788 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
34789 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
34790 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
34791 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
34792 .next
34793 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
34794 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
34795 .endlist
34796
34797
34798
34799
34800 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
34801 .cindex "privilege, running without"
34802 .cindex "unprivileged running"
34803 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
34804 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
34805 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
34806 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
34807 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
34808 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
34809 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
34810 to any other uid.
34811
34812 .cindex SIGHUP
34813 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
34814 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
34815 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
34816 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
34817
34818 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
34819 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
34820 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
34821 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
34822 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
34823
34824 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
34825 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
34826 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
34827 effect.
34828
34829 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
34830 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
34831 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
34832
34833 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
34834 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
34835 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
34836 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
34837 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
34838 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
34839 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
34840 address this problem at this time.
34841
34842 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
34843 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
34844 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
34845 be used in the most straightforward way.
34846
34847 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
34848 number of restrictions on what you can do:
34849
34850 .ilist
34851 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
34852 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
34853 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
34854 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
34855 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
34856 .next
34857 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
34858 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
34859 .next
34860 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
34861 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
34862 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
34863 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
34864 .next
34865 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
34866 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
34867
34868 .olist
34869 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
34870 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
34871 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
34872 .next
34873 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
34874 owned by the Exim user.
34875 .next
34876 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
34877 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
34878 mailboxes need to be created manually.
34879 .endlist olist
34880 .endlist ilist
34881
34882
34883 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
34884 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
34885 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
34886 gives more security at essentially no cost.
34887
34888 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
34889 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
34890
34891
34892
34893
34894 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
34895 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
34896 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
34897
34898
34899
34900 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
34901 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
34902 .cindex "IP source routing"
34903 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
34904 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
34905 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
34906 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
34907
34908
34909
34910 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
34911 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
34912 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
34913
34914
34915
34916
34917 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
34918 .cindex "trusted users"
34919 .cindex "admin user"
34920 .cindex "privileged user"
34921 .cindex "user" "trusted"
34922 .cindex "user" "admin"
34923 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
34924 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
34925 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
34926 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
34927 permit a remote host to be specified.
34928
34929 .oindex "&%-f%&"
34930 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
34931 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
34932 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
34933 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
34934 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
34935 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
34936
34937 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
34938 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
34939 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
34940 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
34941 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
34942
34943 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
34944 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
34945 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
34946 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
34947 includes the contents of files on the spool.
34948
34949 .oindex "&%-M%&"
34950 .oindex "&%-q%&"
34951 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
34952 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
34953 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
34954 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
34955 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
34956 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
34957
34958 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
34959 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
34960 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
34961 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
34962 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
34963 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
34964 files.
34965
34966
34967
34968 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
34969 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
34970 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
34971 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
34972 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
34973 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
34974
34975
34976
34977 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
34978 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
34979 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
34980 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
34981 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
34982 this.
34983
34984
34985
34986 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
34987 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
34988 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
34989 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
34990 converted output.
34991
34992
34993
34994 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
34995 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
34996 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
34997 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
34998 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
34999
35000
35001
35002 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
35003 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
35004 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
35005 loading it.
35006
35007
35008 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
35009 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
35010 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
35011 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
35012 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
35013 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
35014 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
35015
35016 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
35017 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
35018 string.
35019
35020
35021
35022 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
35023 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
35024 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
35025 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
35026
35027
35028
35029 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
35030 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
35031 enough to hold the result.
35032 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
35033
35034
35035
35036
35037 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35038 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35039
35040 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
35041 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
35042 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
35043 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
35044 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
35045 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
35046 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
35047 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
35048 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
35049 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
35050 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
35051 themselves are recoverable.
35052
35053 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
35054 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
35055 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
35056
35057 .ilist
35058 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
35059 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
35060 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
35061 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
35062 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
35063 .next
35064 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
35065 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
35066 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
35067 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
35068 will always be the case.
35069 .next
35070 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
35071 .next
35072 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
35073 signature.
35074 .endlist
35075 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
35076
35077 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
35078 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
35079 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
35080 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
35081 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
35082 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
35083 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
35084 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
35085 attempt.
35086
35087 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
35088 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
35089 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
35090 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
35091 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
35092 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
35093 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
35094 normally the Exim user.
35095
35096 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
35097 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
35098 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
35099 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
35100 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
35101 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
35102 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
35103 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
35104
35105 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
35106 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
35107 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
35108 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
35109
35110 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
35111 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
35112
35113 .vlist
35114 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35115 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
35116 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
35117 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
35118 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
35119 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
35120 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
35121 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
35122 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
35123 newlines.
35124
35125 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35126 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
35127 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
35128 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35129 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35130 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35131
35132 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35133 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
35134 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
35135 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35136 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35137 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35138
35139 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
35140 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
35141 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
35142
35143 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
35144 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
35145 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
35146 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
35147 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35148
35149 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
35150 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
35151 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
35152 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
35153 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35154
35155 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
35156 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
35157 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
35158
35159 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
35160 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
35161 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
35162
35163 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35164 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
35165 present.
35166
35167 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35168 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
35169 present if the number is greater than zero.
35170
35171 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
35172 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
35173 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
35174
35175 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
35176 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
35177 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
35178
35179 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35180 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
35181 command.
35182
35183 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35184 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
35185 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
35186 messages.
35187
35188 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
35189 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
35190 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
35191 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
35192
35193 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
35194 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
35195 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
35196
35197 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35198 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
35199 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
35200 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
35201 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
35202 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
35203
35204 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
35205 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
35206 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
35207 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
35208 supplied by the remote host, if any.
35209
35210 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35211 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
35212 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
35213 generated messages.
35214
35215 .vitem &%-local%&
35216 The message is from a local sender.
35217
35218 .vitem &%-localerror%&
35219 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
35220
35221 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
35222 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
35223 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
35224 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
35225
35226 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
35227 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
35228 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
35229
35230 .vitem &%-N%&
35231 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
35232 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
35233 &%-N%& is assumed.
35234
35235 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
35236 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
35237 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35238
35239 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
35240 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
35241 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
35242
35243 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
35244 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
35245 of &$spam_score_int$&.
35246
35247 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
35248 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
35249 certificate was verified by the server.
35250
35251 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
35252 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
35253 name of the cipher suite that was used.
35254
35255 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
35256 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
35257 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
35258 certificate.
35259 .endlist
35260
35261 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
35262 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
35263 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
35264 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
35265 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
35266 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
35267 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
35268 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
35269 addresses are complete.
35270
35271 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
35272 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
35273 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
35274 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
35275 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
35276 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
35277 .code
35278 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
35279 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
35280 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35281 .endd
35282 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
35283 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
35284 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
35285 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
35286 example:
35287 .code
35288 4
35289 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35290 darcy@austen.fict.example
35291 rdo@foundation
35292 alice@wonderland.fict.example
35293 .endd
35294 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
35295 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
35296 line is of the following form:
35297 .display
35298 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
35299 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
35300 .endd
35301 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
35302 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
35303 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
35304 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
35305 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
35306 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
35307 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
35308 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
35309
35310
35311 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
35312 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
35313 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
35314 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
35315 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
35316 following:
35317
35318 .table2 50pt
35319 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
35320 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
35321 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
35322 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
35323 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
35324 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
35325 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
35326 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
35327 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
35328 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
35329 .endtable
35330
35331 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
35332 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
35333 typical set of headers:
35334 .code
35335 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
35336 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35337 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
35338 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
35339 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
35340 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
35341 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
35342 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35343 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
35344 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35345 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35346 .endd
35347 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
35348 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
35349 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
35350 .ecindex IIDforspo1
35351 .ecindex IIDforspo2
35352 .ecindex IIDforspo3
35353
35354 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35355 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35356
35357 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHID12" &&&
35358 "DKIM Support"
35359 .cindex "DKIM"
35360
35361 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
35362 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
35363 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
35364 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
35365
35366 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
35367 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
35368
35369 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
35370 .olist
35371 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
35372 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
35373 .next
35374 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
35375 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
35376 different signature contexts.
35377 .endlist
35378
35379 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
35380 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
35381 Exim's standard controls.
35382
35383 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
35384 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
35385 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
35386 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
35387 .code
35388 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
35389 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
35390 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
35391 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
35392 .endd
35393 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
35394 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
35395 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
35396 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
35397 senders).
35398
35399
35400 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
35401 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
35402
35403 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
35404 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
35405
35406 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
35407 MANDATORY:
35408 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
35409 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
35410
35411 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
35412 MANDATORY:
35413 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
35414 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
35415 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
35416 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
35417
35418 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
35419 MANDATORY:
35420 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
35421 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
35422 The result can either
35423 .ilist
35424 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
35425 .next
35426 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
35427 the private key.
35428 .next
35429 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
35430 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
35431 is set.
35432 .endlist
35433
35434 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
35435 OPTIONAL:
35436 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
35437 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
35438 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
35439 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
35440
35441 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
35442 OPTIONAL:
35443 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
35444 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
35445 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
35446 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
35447 variables here.
35448
35449 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
35450 OPTIONAL:
35451 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
35452 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
35453 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
35454 used.
35455
35456
35457 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
35458 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
35459
35460 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
35461 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
35462 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
35463
35464 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
35465 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
35466 runtime of the ACL.
35467
35468 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
35469 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
35470 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
35471 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
35472
35473 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
35474 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
35475 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
35476 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
35477 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
35478 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
35479 it defaults as:
35480 .code
35481 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
35482 .endd
35483 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
35484 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
35485 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
35486 .code
35487 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
35488 .endd
35489 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
35490 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
35491 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
35492 .code
35493 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
35494 .endd
35495
35496 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
35497 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
35498
35499
35500 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
35501 available (from most to least important):
35502
35503
35504 .vlist
35505 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
35506 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
35507 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
35508 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
35509 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
35510 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
35511 .ilist
35512 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
35513 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35514 .next
35515 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
35516 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35517 .next
35518 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
35519 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35520 .next
35521 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
35522 .endlist
35523 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
35524 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
35525 "fail" or "invalid". One of
35526 .ilist
35527 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
35528 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
35529 .next
35530 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
35531 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
35532 .next
35533 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
35534 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
35535 means that the message body was modified in transit.
35536 .next
35537 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
35538 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
35539 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
35540 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
35541 .endlist
35542 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
35543 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
35544 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
35545 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35546 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
35547 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
35548 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
35549 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35550 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
35551 The key record selector string.
35552 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
35553 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
35554 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
35555 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35556 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
35557 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35558 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
35559 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
35560 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
35561 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
35562 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
35563 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
35564 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
35565 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
35566 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
35567 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
35568 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
35569 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
35570 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
35571 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
35572 integer size comparisons against this value.
35573 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
35574 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
35575 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
35576 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
35577 .vitem &%$nosubdomains%&
35578 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
35579 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
35580 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35581 in the key record.
35582 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
35583 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35584 in the key record.
35585 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
35586 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
35587 .endlist
35588
35589 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
35590
35591 .vlist
35592 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
35593 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
35594 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
35595 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
35596 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
35597
35598 .code
35599 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
35600 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
35601 sender_domains = gmail.com
35602 dkim_signers = gmail.com
35603 dkim_status = none
35604 .endd
35605
35606 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
35607 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
35608 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
35609 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
35610
35611 .code
35612 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
35613 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
35614 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
35615 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
35616 .endd
35617
35618 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
35619 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
35620 for more information of what they mean.
35621 .endlist
35622
35623 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35625
35626 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
35627 "Adding drivers or lookups"
35628 .cindex "adding drivers"
35629 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
35630 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
35631 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
35632 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
35633
35634 .olist
35635 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
35636 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
35637 .next
35638 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
35639 .display
35640 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
35641 .endd
35642 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
35643 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
35644 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
35645 .next
35646 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
35647 .code
35648 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
35649 .endd
35650 .next
35651 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
35652 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
35653 .next
35654 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
35655 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
35656 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
35657 .next
35658 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
35659 &_src_&.
35660 .next
35661 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
35662 as for other drivers and lookups.
35663 .endlist
35664
35665 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
35666 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
35667 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
35668 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
35669 searched using a binary chop procedure.
35670
35671 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
35672 the interface that is expected.
35673
35674
35675
35676
35677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35679
35680 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35681 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
35682 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
35683 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
35684 . processors.
35685 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35686
35687 .literal xml
35688 <?sdop
35689 format="newpage"
35690 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
35691 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
35692 ?>
35693 .literal off
35694
35695 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
35696 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
35697 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
35698
35699
35700 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35701 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////